pÅêÉÉåmolJff=`çåíêçääÉê rëÉêÛë=dìáÇÉ • • Manual # 26-0505000-00 Revision A pÅêÉÉåmolJff=`çåíêçääÉê==√==rëÉêÛë=dìáÇÉ `çéóêáÖÜí © Barco, Inc. August 3, 2006 All rights reserved. No part of this document may be copied, reproduced or translated. It shall not otherwise be recorded, transmitted or stored in a retrieval system without the prior written consent of Barco. kçíáÅÉ Barco provides this manual “as is” without warranty of any kind, either expressed or implied, including but not limited to the implied warranties or merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose. Barco may make improvements and/or changes to the product(s) and/ or the program(s) described in this publication at any time without notice. This publication could contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made to the information in this publication; these changes are incorporated in new editions of this publication. cÉÇÉê~ä=`çããìåáÅ~íáçåë=`çããáëëáçå=Ec``F=pí~íÉãÉåí This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area may cause harmful interference, in which case the user will be responsible for correcting any interference. dì~ê~åíÉÉ=~åÇ=`çãéÉåë~íáçå Barco provides a guarantee relating to perfect manufacturing as part of the legally stipulated terms of guarantee. On receipt, the purchaser must immediately inspect all delivered goods for damage incurred during transport, as well as for material and manufacturing faults Barco must be informed immediately in writing of any complaints. The period of guarantee begins on the date of transfer of risks, in the case of special systems and software on the date of commissioning, at latest 30 days after the transfer of risks. In the event of justified notice of compliant, Barco can repair the fault or provide a replacement at its own discretion within an appropriate period. If this measure proves to be impossible or unsuccessful, the purchaser can demand a reduction in the purchase price or cancellation of the contract. All other claims, in particular those relating to compensation for direct or indirect damage, and also damage attributed to the operation of software as well as to other services provided by Barco, being a component of the system or independent service, will be deemed invalid provided the damage is not proven to be attributed to the absence of properties guaranteed in writing or due to the intent or gross negligence or part of Barco. If the purchaser or a third party carries out modifications or repairs on goods delivered by Barco, or if the goods are handled incorrectly, in particular if the systems are commissioned operated incorrectly or if, after the transfer of risks, the goods are subject to influences not 2 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide agreed upon in the contract, all guarantee claims of the purchaser will be rendered invalid. Not included in the guarantee coverage are system failures which are attributed to programs or special electronic circuitry provided by the purchaser, e.g. interfaces. Normal wear as well as normal maintenance are not subject to the guarantee provided by Barco either. The environmental conditions as well as the servicing and maintenance regulations specified in this manual must be complied with by the customer. qê~ÇÉã~êâë Brand and product names mentioned in this manual may be trademarks, registered trademarks or copyrights of their respective holders. All brand and product names mentioned in this manual serve as comments or examples and are not to be understood as advertising for the products or their manufactures. `çãé~åó=^ÇÇêÉëë Barco Media and Entertainment 11101 Trade Center Drive Rancho Cordova, California 95670 USA • • • Phone: (916) 859-2500 Fax: (916) 859-2515 Websites: ~ ~ www.folsom.com www.events.barco.com Barco N.V. Noordlaan 5 8520 Kuurne BELGIUM • • • Phone: +32 56.36.82.11 Fax: +32 56.35.16.51 Website: www.barco.com ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3 léÉê~íçêë=p~ÑÉíó=pìãã~êó The general safety information in this summary is for operating personnel. aç=kçí=oÉãçîÉ=`çîÉêë=çê=m~åÉäë There are no user-serviceable parts within the unit. Removal of the top cover will expose dangerous voltages. To avoid personal injury, do not remove the top cover. Do not operate the unit without the cover installed. mçïÉê=pçìêÅÉ This product is intended to operate from a power source that will not apply more than 230 volts rms between the supply conductors or between both supply conductor and ground. A protective ground connection by way of grounding conductor in the power cord is essential for safe operation. dêçìåÇáåÖ=íÜÉ=mêçÇìÅí This product is grounded through the grounding conductor of the power cord. To avoid electrical shock, plug the power cord into a properly wired receptacle before connecting to the product input or output terminals. A protective-ground connection by way of the grounding conductor in the power cord is essential for safe operation. rëÉ=íÜÉ=mêçéÉê=mçïÉê=`çêÇ Use only the power cord and connector specified for your product. Use only a power cord that is in good condition. Refer cord and connector changes to qualified service personnel. rëÉ=íÜÉ=mêçéÉê=cìëÉ To avoid fire hazard, use only the fuse having identical type, voltage rating, and current rating characteristics. Refer fuse replacement to qualified service personnel. aç=kçí=léÉê~íÉ=áå=bñéäçëáîÉ=^íãçëéÜÉêÉë To avoid explosion, do not operate this product in an explosive atmosphere. 4 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide qÉêãë=få=qÜáë=j~åì~ä=~åÇ=bèìáéãÉåí=j~êâáåÖ= t^okfkd Highlights an operating procedure, practice, condition, statement, etc., which, if not strictly observed, could result in injury to or death of personnel. Note Highlights an essential operating procedure, condition or statement. `^rqflk The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. ^sboqfppbjbkq> Le point d´exclamation dans un triangle equilatéral signale à alerter l´utilisateur qu´il y a des instructions d´operation et d´entretien tres importantes dans la litérature qui accompagne l´appareil. slopf`eq Ein Ausrufungszeichen innerhalb eines gleichwinkeligen Dreiecks dient dazu, den Benutzer auf wichtige Bedienungs-und Wartungsanweisungen in der Dem Great beiliegenden Literatur aufmerksam zu machen. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5 `Ü~åÖÉ=eáëíçêó The table below lists the changes to the ScreenPRO-II Controller User’s Guide. Table 0-1. Change History Rev A 6 Date 8/3/06 ECO # 1666 Description Approved By ScreenPRO-II Controller User’s Guide R. Pellicano ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide q~ÄäÉ=çÑ=`çåíÉåíë `Ü~éíÉê=N fåíêçÇìÅíáçå =K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=NR Chapter Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How to Use This Guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Navigating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents and Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Terms and Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A Word About Layers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Combinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dual Destination System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Quadruple Destination System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dual Destination plus Widescreen Destination System . . . . Dual Destination, Dual Aux System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Effect Combinations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mixer Effect 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mixer Effect 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mixer Effect 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mixer Effect 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mixer Effect 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mixer Effect 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Application Questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . `Ü~éíÉê=O e~êÇï~êÉ=lêáÉåí~íáçå =K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=PN In This Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Controller Rear Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Controller Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Use of Color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front Panel Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Touch Screen Menu Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Presets Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination/Aux Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Joystick Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Source Selection Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Layer Functions Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Layer Control Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transition Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . `Ü~éíÉê=P 16 17 17 17 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 27 27 28 28 28 29 30 31 32 34 36 37 38 39 40 42 44 46 48 50 e~êÇï~êÉ=fåëí~ää~íáçå=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=RP In This Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 7 Table of Contents Unpacking and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Site Preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Controller Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cable, Adapter and Accessory Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connection Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connection Chart Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sample Connection Charts — External Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External Routing — Sample Analog Router I/O Chart . . . . . External Routing — Sample Digital Router I/O Chart . . . . . . Widescreen — Sample DVI Connection Chart. . . . . . . . . . . Widescreen — Sample Standard Destination Chart . . . . . . . Widescreen — Sample Auxiliary Destination Chart . . . . . . . Sample Connection Charts — Internal Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Internal Routing — Sample Analog Input Chart . . . . . . . . . . Internal Routing — Sample Digital Input Chart . . . . . . . . . . . Single Screens — Sample DVI Connection Chart . . . . . . . . Single Screens — Sample Standard Destination Chart . . . . Single Screens — Sample Auxiliary Destination Chart . . . . . Blank Connection Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External Routing — Analog Router I/O Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . External Routing — Digital Router I/O Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . Internal Routing — Analog Input Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Internal Routing — Digital Input Chart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DVI Connection Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard Destination Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Auxiliary Destination Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overview of Edge-Blending Technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction to Edge Blending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Content Creation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Video Processing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Projector Setup and System Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Left Justified Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Center Justified Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . `Ü~éíÉê=Q 54 54 54 55 56 56 58 59 59 60 60 61 62 63 63 64 64 65 66 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 76 77 79 79 79 81 82 83 83 jÉåì=lêáÉåí~íáçå=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=UR In This Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Global Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Home Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Input Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Input Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Input Menu Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Input Menu Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Input Sub Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Input Configuration Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Aspect Ratio Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Sizing Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Color Balance Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Output Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 8 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Table of Contents Output Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Menu Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Menu Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Sub Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Genlock Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Settings Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Test Pattern Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wide Screen Settings Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Menu Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Sub Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Reset Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Software Version Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostics Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Network Setup Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Source Patch Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Router Specification Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Comm Setup Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Patch Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous Menu Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous Sub Menus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Console Port Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lockout Code Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EDID DVI Input Format Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keypad Backlight Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LCD Settings Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . User Preference Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Backup/Restore Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Frame Grab Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Frame Grab Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Frame Grab Menu Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Frame Grab Name Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Effects Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Status Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PIP Adjustment Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PIP Adjustment Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PIP Adjustment Menu Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PIP Adjustment Menu Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PIP Adjustment Sub Menus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Border Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shadow Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Image Effects Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key Menu Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key Menu Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Luma Key Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Color Key Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 100 101 102 102 103 104 105 106 108 108 109 110 111 112 113 117 124 125 127 129 132 133 133 134 135 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 142 143 145 146 147 148 148 149 149 150 151 152 153 155 155 156 156 157 157 9 Table of Contents Cut + Fill Key Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key Sub Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Matte Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key Adjustment Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clone Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crop Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Source Adjustment Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Source Adjustment Menu Trees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Source Adjustment Menu Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Source Adjustment Menu Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Background Input Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Background Input Setup Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shared Background Menu Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Background Menu Functions — Matte Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BG Matte Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Background Menu Functions — DVI Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Background Menu Functions — FG Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSK Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSK Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSK Adjustment Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSK Luma Key Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSK Color Key Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSK Input Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LOGO Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . `Ü~éíÉê=R póëíÉã=pÉíìéK=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=KNUP In This Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setup Prerequisites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Setup Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ID Setup and Remote Enable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Power Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Downloading Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Return to Factory Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Touch Screen Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Programming EDID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Restore from Flash Memory Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard Destination Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Router Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AUX Destination Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Aux Destination Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Aux Destination Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ImagePRO or PrePRO-II Aux Destination Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Patching. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Format Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sync Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Genlock Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Projector Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Single Screen Projector Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wide Screen Projector Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Background Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 158 158 159 160 162 164 165 166 167 168 170 171 172 173 174 175 176 177 177 178 178 179 180 182 183 184 185 186 187 188 189 189 190 191 192 193 195 195 196 196 198 199 200 201 202 202 203 205 206 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Table of Contents Standard Input Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Widescreen Phase and Color Balance Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Phase Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Color Balance Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSK Setup Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LOGO Setup Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Saving the Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Backup to Flash Memory Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . `Ü~éíÉê=S 206 209 209 210 211 212 213 213 léÉê~íáçåë =K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=KONR In This Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Prerequisites. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operational Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Monitor Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Touch Screen Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wide Screen Markers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lookahead Preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding Raster Boxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A Word About LOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting User Preferences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding Input File Mapping. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Activating Destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clearing Destinations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Routing Sources to Destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switching Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Background Transitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Understanding Split and Mix Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Split Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mix Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with PIPs in Split Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with PIPs in Mix Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Modifying PIPs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Keys in Split Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Keys in Mix Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Cut & Fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Modifying Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clearing Layers from Program. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Modifying Layers On Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Layer Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing the Layer Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Full Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Clone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Swap Z-Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Freeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Join Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Move. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Programming Moves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Program a Move on Preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 215 216 217 217 217 218 219 220 221 221 221 222 222 223 223 226 226 227 228 228 228 229 229 230 231 232 232 233 234 234 235 235 235 235 236 236 237 237 238 238 238 11 Table of Contents Program a Move on Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pending and Triggering Moves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pend on Preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pend on Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Move Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Transitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wipe. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Manual Transitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transition Notes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A Word About Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Storing Presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recalling Presets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting Presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Next and Previous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preset Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Still Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Still Frame Capture Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Capturing Still Frames from a Background Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Capturing Still Frames from a Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Saving Still Frames in Permanent Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Naming a Saved Still Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Locking and Unlocking the Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Working with Tallies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using Backup and Restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ^ééÉåÇáñ=^= péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåëK=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=KORR In This Appendix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Input Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Output Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . User Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Widescreen Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Physical and Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Communications Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ethernet Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Serial Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tally Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ^ééÉåÇáñ=_= 239 239 239 240 240 241 241 241 241 242 242 243 243 244 244 244 244 245 246 246 247 247 248 249 250 251 252 253 253 253 254 255 256 257 257 258 258 259 260 260 261 262 263 `çåí~Åí=fåÑçêã~íáçå=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=KOST In This Appendix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 12 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Table of Contents Return Material Authorization (RMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 Contact Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 ^ééÉåÇáñ=`= réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉK=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=KOSV In This Appendix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Software Upgrade Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hardware Requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Software Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Downloading Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Via FTP Site. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Via Web Site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Serial Upgrade Method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ethernet Upgrade Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Troubleshooting Ethernet Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . fåÇÉñ 269 270 270 270 271 271 271 272 274 275 =K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=K=KOTT ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 13 Table of Contents 14 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå This chapter is designed to introduce you to the ScreenPRO-II Controller User’s Guide. Areas to be covered are: • • • • • • Chapter Structure How to Use This Guide Conventions Terms and Definitions System Overview Application Questions Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Once you have reviewed all of the sections in this chapter, please continue with Chapter 2, “Hardware Orientation” on page 31. 15 NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå Chapter Structure `Ü~éíÉê=píêìÅíìêÉ The following chapters provide instructions for all aspects of ScreenPRO-II Controller operations: 16 • Chapter 1, “Introduction” provides a system overview, a list of features, and discusses easy ways to use this guide. • Chapter 2, “Hardware Orientation” on page 31 explains the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s front and rear panels in detail. • Chapter 3, “Hardware Installation” on page 53 provides comprehensive system installation instructions. • Chapter 4, “Menu Orientation” on page 85 explains the system’s configuration, setup and adjustment menus, and provides basic menu “navigation” procedures. • Chapter 5, “System Setup” on page 183 outlines procedures for setting up and configuring the ScreenPRO-II Controller. • • Chapter 6, “Operations” on page 215 provides system operating instructions. Appendix A, “Specifications” on page 255 lists the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s input, output, video, mechanical and power specifications, and includes connector pinouts. • Appendix B, “Contact Information” on page 267 lists important RMA, warranty, contact and technical support details. • Appendix C, “Upgrading Software” on page 269 provides a detailed procedure for upgrading ScreenPRO-II Controller software. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå How to Use This Guide eçï=íç=rëÉ=qÜáë=dìáÇÉ Following are important tips for streamlining your use of this User’s Guide in its electronic “PDF” form. k~îáÖ~íáåÖ Use Acrobat Reader’s “bookmarks” to navigate to the desired location. All chapter files have the same bookmark structure for instant navigation to any section. Please note: • • Extensive hyperlinks are provided within the chapters. • Use the “Previous Page” and “Next Page” buttons to go to the previous or next page within a file. • Use Acrobat’s extensive search capabilities, such as the “Find” tool and “Search Index” tool to perform comprehensive searches as required. Use Acrobat’s “Go to Previous View” and “Return to Next View” buttons to trace your complete navigational path. q~ÄäÉ=çÑ=`çåíÉåíë=~åÇ=fåÇÉñ Use the Table of Contents bookmarks to navigate a desired topic. Click any item to instantly jump to that section of the guide. You can also use the Index to jump to specific topics within a chapter. Each page number in the Index is a hyperlink. dÉåÉê~ä=léÉê~íáçåë To ensure trouble-free operation, please follow all procedures as listed below: • For detailed installation instructions, refer to Chapter 3, “Hardware Installation” on page 53. • • For system setup instructions, refer to Chapter 5, “System Setup” on page 183. For operating instructions, refer to Chapter 6, “Operations” on page 215. Should you have any questions regarding the installation or operation of the MatrixPRO ScreenPRO-II Controller, please consult with the factory. Refer to Appendix C, “Upgrading Software” on page 269 for contact information. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 17 NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå Conventions `çåîÉåíáçåë= The following conventions are used throughout this guide: • • • The symbol denotes an operations procedure. The symbol S denotes an example. Entries written in bold-face letters denote physical buttons or rear chassis connectors. S Press Split to ... • When two buttons together are required for an operation or function, the plus (+) sign is used between the buttons. This procedure requires that you hold down the first button, then press the second. S Example: Press Learn + 2 to store the ScreenPRO-II Controller setup in preset register 2. • Button labels on the Touch Screen menus are shown in bold uppercase letters between braces. S Press {BORDER} to … • When a sequence of menu selections is required to complete a given procedure, the ">" symbol is used to divide each successive menu picks. S To access the Genlock Menu, press {HOME} > {OUTPUT} > {GLCK}. 18 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå Terms and Definitions qÉêãë=~åÇ=aÉÑáåáíáçåë The following terms and definitions are used throughout this guide: • A “Background” is an unscaled source, typically originating from a computer. A background source appears at the system’s lowest priority — visually in back of all other sources. • • • The abbreviation “BG” is also used throughout this guide for Background. • A “Layer” is an image display element (such as a PIP, Key or Background) that has an associated visual priority — either in front (or in back) of another layer. • A “LOGO” is a full screen image that is selected from one of three still frames that you can capture with each individual ScreenPRO-II unit. A maximum of 12 still frames can therefore be controlled from the ScreenPRO-II Controller. • A “Mixer” is the electronic circuitry that enables you to transition (and scale) PIPs and Keys over a background. • “M/E” (Mix/Effects) is synonymous with “mixer.” Each individual ScreenPRO-II has one internal M/E that can layer either two PIPs, two keys, or one of each. • • “Operator” refers to the person who uses the system. • • “Screen” and “Menu” both refer to the Touch Screen menus. • The term “Controller” is synonymous with ScreenPRO-II Controller. A “Key” is an electronic (and visual) process whereby one image is electronically superimposed over another source or background. Keys are typically used for titles, logos and banners. “PIP” refers to Picture-in-Picture, an on-screen setup in which one picture (typically of reduced size) is positioned over another background image — or another PIP. PIPs can be reduced, enlarged, bordered, shadowed, and mixed on and off Program. PIPs can overlap each other, depending on their visual priority. “System” refers to the ScreenPRO-II Controller and its associated individual ScreenPRO-II units. A “Scaler” is the electronic circuitry that enables you to reduce or enlarge source images, thus creating PIPs and Keys that can be positioned (and transitioned). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 19 NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview póëíÉã=lîÉêîáÉï The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • ScreenPRO-II Controller A Word About Layers System Combinations Effect Combinations pÅêÉÉåmolJff=`çåíêçääÉê The ScreenPRO-II Controller is a versatile interface that enables users to control up to four individual ScreenPRO-II units and peripheral equipment (such as BlendPRO-II, MatrixPRO routers and ImagePRO). The ScreenPRO-II Controller offers the complete functionality of the ScreenPRO-II front panel, plus many features that are not available on the local panel. Features include: • 20 Enhanced hardware and software features: ~ Control of multiple ScreenPRO-II units as “destinations,” including both single and widescreen configurations. Refer to the “System Combinations” section on page 22 for sample configurations. ~ Support for widescreen applications using two or more ScreenPRO-II units in conjunction with BlendPRO-II. ~ In “internal” routing mode, support for 16 analog inputs and 2 HD-SDI/ SD-SDI inputs. In “external” routing mode, support for 16 inputs, in any combination of analog and digital. ~ Optional Tally board provides eight programmable tallies, which can be assigned to any input source. The board also provides a PS-2 connector, and when a customer-supplied keyboard is connected, users can enter system values and names. ~ 3.8” LCD Touch Screen with eight soft menu buttons and two rotary encoders for menu navigation. ~ ~ 3-Axis Joystick for quick sizing and positioning of PIPs and Keys. ~ ~ ~ Dimmable, flexible light stick (script light) with XLR connector. ~ The Controller’s Flash Memory Card Slot enables users to backup and restore system configuration parameters. The Flash Memory card itself is customer supplied. ~ The “Join” feature allows both layers to be locked together, proportionally. Manipulations to one layer are automatically performed on the other layer, including size, position, moves, PIPs and Keys. Color-coded buttons and layouts match color scheme of Encore and ScreenPRO-II product family. Internal convection-cooled power supply (no fan needed). The programmable Controller Lockout feature allows operators to lock the Controller, thus disabling all button presses. The lockout code is user-programmable. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview • Router control: ~ ~ • Support for internal routers (within individual ScreenPRO-II units). Support for external analog and digital routers, such as MatrixPRO and other third-party router manufacturers. Enhanced transition capability: ~ ~ • Automatic transitions via dedicated AUTO TRANS button. Manual transitions via T-Bar. Preset control: ~ Control of up to 36 user presets in a dedicated “Preset” section (six pages of six preset each). ~ NEXT and PREV (Previous) buttons for convenient preset recall. ^=tçêÇ=^Äçìí=i~óÉêë Just like the individual ScreenPRO-II units, the ScreenPRO-II Controller is a five layer system, as illustrated below: Background Mixer Layer A Mixer Layer B DSK LOGO Figure 1-1. ScreenPRO-II Controller Layers Note Regardless of the number of individual ScreenPRO-II destinations under control, you are still working with individual five layer systems — whether or not the destinations are individual screens or blended widescreens. A layer is defined as an image display element (such as a background, PIP, or Key) with an associated visual priority. The ScreenPRO-II mixer itself has two layers, A and B. For complete flexibility, each layer can be assigned to either PIP or Key functionality. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 21 NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview A typical ScreenPRO-II Controller application is illustrated below. Background PIP Nature Key DSK Wilderness Figure 1-2. Layer Illustration — Background, Mixer and DSK Please note the following important points: • The full screen LOGO is the highest priority layer. The LOGO visually appears “over” all other images, including backgrounds, PIPs, keys and the DSK. • The Downstream Key (DSK) is the second highest priority layer. It visually appears over all PIPs, keys and backgrounds — but it is “under” the LOGO. • The high resolution Background layer has the lowest priority. This layer visually appears “behind” all other PIPs, keys, and the DSK. The controller can transition between two background sources — both of which must be provided at native projector resolution. • A PIP layer appears “over” backgrounds and “under” the DSK and LOGO. Effects include mixes, wipes, linear moves, resizing, adjustable aspect ratio, borders, drop shadows and soft edges. • A Key layer also appears “over” backgrounds and “under” the DSK and LOGO. Key effects include luminance keys, split keys (key alpha and fill), reverse key (key on background), and color key (graphics). • Within the mixer, layer B has priority over layer A, but you can change that priority with the Swap Z-Order button. • Up to eight analog inputs and up to two SD/HD SDI inputs can be scaled to produce PIPs or Keys. póëíÉã=`çãÄáå~íáçåë The ScreenPRO-II Controller can be configured in a variety of different ways, using both single screen and widescreen destinations. You can use up to four ScreenPRO-II units and up to four Aux destinations. The only limitation is one widescreen destination per ScreenPRO-II Controller, comprised of up to four ScreenPRO-II units and a BlendPRO-II. Several sample configurations are listed below, in simplified block diagram format: • • • • 22 Dual Destination System Quadruple Destination System Dual Destination plus Widescreen Destination System Dual Destination, Dual Aux System ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview aì~ä=aÉëíáå~íáçå=póëíÉã The figure below illustrates a dual-destination system comprised of the ScreenPRO-II Controller, two individual ScreenPRO-II units and two single-screen projectors (destinations). Within this system, Ethernet is used for communications between components, and all ScreenPRO-II inputs are received via routers or direct connections. Destination #1 Destination #2 Inputs (from routers and direct sources) ScreenPRO-II Controller ScreenPRO-II Ethernet Hub / Switch Figure 1-3. ScreenPRO-II Controller system with two destinations ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 23 NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview =nì~ÇêìéäÉ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=póëíÉã The figure below illustrates a quadruple-destination system comprised of the ScreenPRO-II Controller, four individual ScreenPRO-II units and four single-screen projectors. Destination #1 Destination #2 Destination #3 Destination #4 Inputs (from routers and direct sources) ScreenPRO-II Controller ScreenPRO-II Ethernet Hub / Switch Figure 1-4. ScreenPRO-II Controller system with four destinations 24 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview aì~ä=aÉëíáå~íáçå=éäìë=táÇÉëÅêÉÉå=aÉëíáå~íáçå=póëíÉã The figure below illustrates a system that includes two single screen destinations and one widescreen destination. Note the use of BlendPRO-II on the outputs of the two ScreenPRO-II units designated as “widescreen.” Single Screen Single Screen Widescreen Destination #1 Destination #2 Destination #3 Inputs (from routers and direct sources) ScreenPRO-II Controller ScreenPRO-II BlendPRO-II Ethernet Hub / Switch Figure 1-5. ScreenPRO-II Controller system with one widescreen destination The BlendPRO-II accepts up to four inputs, thus, widescreen systems can be configured with dual (as shown above), triple or quadruple screen blends. Important ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide For all Widescreen configurations using BlendPRO-II, ensure that you review the “BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections” section on page 77 in Chapter 3. 25 NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview aì~ä=aÉëíáå~íáçåI=aì~ä=^ìñ=póëíÉã The figure below illustrates a system that includes two individual ScreenPRO-II units, two single-screen projectors and two “Aux” destinations: • The “standard” Aux destination is a single monitor that takes its input from one router output (in a single format). • The “PresentationPRO” Aux destination takes its input(s) from multiple routers and sources, in multiple formats. When connected to a single monitor or projector, a scaled signal is provided in one format. Destination #1 Destination #2 Inputs (from routers and direct sources) ScreenPRO-II Controller Ethernet ScreenPRO-II Input sources (single format) Aux Destination #1 Hub / Switch MatrixPRO SDI Router Input sources (multiple formats) (Scaled) Aux Destination #2 PresentationPRO-II Figure 1-6. ScreenPRO-II Controller system with two Aux destinations 26 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview bÑÑÉÅí=`çãÄáå~íáçåë This section illustrates the many (but not all) combinations of image effects that you can create using the ScreenPRO-II Controller. Please note: • In the following illustrations, the specific layers used in creating each effect are labeled (e.g., PIP A, PIP B). • The symbol ↔ denotes a PIP or a key that can transition. For example, PIP A ↔ B indicates that you can dissolve between sources within the PIP. Similar to individual ScreenPRO-II units, the ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to control two backgrounds, two scalable layers in the mixer plus an unscaled DSK and a full screen, unscaled LOGO. The LOGO, DSK and backgrounds are always unscaled. Important If the DSK is in use, the background cannot transition between A and B. This occurs because BG/DSK Input B is shared between the DSK and BG B. jáñÉê=bÑÑÉÅí=N This effect includes a non-transitioning background (either A or B), one transitioning PIP and the DSK. Background PIP A↔B DSK Figure 1-7. Effect 1 Diagram jáñÉê=bÑÑÉÅí=O This transition is similar to effect 1, but because the DSK is not in use, the background can transition from source A to B, and the PIP can transition between layers A and B. Background A ↔B PIP A↔B Figure 1-8. Effect 2 Diagram ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 27 NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview jáñÉê=bÑÑÉÅí=P In this effect, because the DSK is in use, the background cannot transition — you can only use background A. Here, you can independently fade (or cut) one scaled PIP and one scaled key, with complete size and position flexibility. Background A PIP A Key B DSK Figure 1-9. Effect 3 Diagram jáñÉê=bÑÑÉÅí=Q This transition is similar to effect 3, but because the DSK is not in use, the background can transition between sources A and B. You can also independently fade, cut, size and position both the PIP and the key. Background A PIP A ↔B Key B Figure 1-10. Effect 4 Diagram jáñÉê=bÑÑÉÅí=R In this effect, because the DSK is in use, the background cannot transition — you can only use background A. Here, you can independently fade two scaled PIPs up and down — with or without the DSK on screen. Background A PIP A PIP B DSK Figure 1-11. Effect 5 Diagram 28 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå System Overview jáñÉê=bÑÑÉÅí=S This transition is similar to effect 5, but because the DSK is not in use, the background can transition. You can also independently fade the two PIPs. Background A PIP A ↔B PIP B Figure 1-12. Effect 6 Diagram ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 29 NK==fåíêçÇìÅíáçå Application Questions ^ééäáÅ~íáçå=nìÉëíáçåë At Barco, we take pride in offering unique solutions to demanding technical problems. If you have application questions, require further information or would like to discuss your application requirements in more detail, please call (916) 859-2500. Our Customer Support Engineers will be happy to provide you with the support you need. Refer to Appendix B, “Contact Information” on page 267 for contact details. 30 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide OK==e~êÇï~êÉ=lêáÉåí~íáçå få=qÜáë=`Ü~éíÉê This chapter provides detailed information about the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s hardware. The following topics are discussed: • • • • ScreenPRO-II Controller Rear Panel ScreenPRO-II Controller Front Panel Use of Color Front Panel Sections Note For complete details on BlendPRO-II’s hardware, refer to the “BlendPRO-II User’s Guide.” Note Once you have reviewed all of the sections in this chapter, please continue with Chapter 3, “Hardware Installation” on page 53. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 31 2. Hardware Orientation ScreenPRO-II Controller Rear Panel pÅêÉÉåmolJff=`çåíêçääÉê=oÉ~ê=m~åÉä The figure below illustrates the ScreenPRO-II Controller rear panel: 3 4 MEMORY CARD T250V 2A FUSE EXT COMM KEYBOARD 1 TALLY 7 2 CONSOLE ETHERNET 5 6 CAUTION: FOR CONTINUED PROTECTION AGAINST RISK OF FIRE, REPLACE ONLY WITH SAME TYPE AND RATING OF FUSE 7 8 Figure 2-1. ScreenPRO-II Controller Rear Panel 1) Keyboard Port 4) Ext Comm Port 7) Adjustable Feet 2) Tally Connector 5) Console Port 8) AC Connector and Fuse 3) Memory Card Slot 6) Ethernet Port Following are descriptions of each rear panel connector and section. 1) Keyboard Port On the optional Tally board, one standard PS-2 connector is provided for the Keyboard Port. When a customer-supplied keyboard is connected, users can enter system values and names. 2) Tally Connector On the optional Tally board, one 25-pin D connector is provided for issuing tally “relay closure” commands to external devices such as cameras. Eight tally circuits are provided. In Appendix A, refer to the “Tally Connector” section on page 262 for pinout details. 3) Memory Card Slot One Memory Card Slot is provided for a customer supplied Flash Memory Card, which enables users to externally store and recall system configurations — one configuration per card. The minimum size card that the system accepts is 512 MB. The card also enables users to transfer configurations between Controllers as required. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Using Backup and Restore” section on page 253 for instructions. 32 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation ScreenPRO-II Controller Rear Panel 4) Ext Comm Port One 9-pin D Ext Comm connector is provided for RS-232 communications with a serial device, such as a router. The port is configured as follows: ~ DCE, 115K baud, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, no parity bits In Appendix A, refer to the “Serial Connector” section on page 261 for pinouts. 5) Console Port One 9-pin D connector is provided for RS-232 “command line” communications with the ScreenPRO-II Controller, and for downloading code in the field. The port is configured as follows: ~ DCE, 115K baud, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, no parity bits The serial port can be connected to a standard PC serial port with a straight through DB-9 to DB-9 cable. In Appendix A, refer to the “Serial Connector” section on page 261 for pinout details. 6) Ethernet Port One RJ-45 connector is provided for 10/100BaseT Ethernet communications with the ScreenPRO-II Controller. When (optionally) connecting the Controller to peripheral devices (such as BlendPRO-II), a standard Ethernet hub or switch on an isolated network is recommended. The Ethernet port is 10/100 Mbit auto sensing capable, and is configured to run as a DHCP server. A variety of Barco Folsom protocols for communication, control, and code loading are implemented. The Ethernet connector is compatible with: ~ ~ Standard RJ-45 Ethernet cables Neutrik EtherCon® series cables In Appendix A, see the “Ethernet Connector” section on page 260 for pinouts. 7) Adjustable Feet The two rear feet of the ScreenPRO-II Controller are adjustable, enabling you to raise the rear of the Controller for increased Touch Screen visibility. Figure 2-2. Controller Side View, showing adjustable feet retracted and extended 8) AC Connector and Fuse One AC Connector with integral Fuse is provided to connect the ScreenPRO-II Controller to your facility’s AC power source. Please note: ~ ~ The integral switch turns the chassis on and off. The fuse rating is T250V, 2A. For continued protection against risk of fire, replace only with a fuse of the same type and rating. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 33 2. Hardware Orientation ScreenPRO-II Controller Front Panel pÅêÉÉåmolJff=`çåíêçääÉê=cêçåí=m~åÉä The figure below illustrates the ScreenPRO-II Controller front panel: 1 2 3 4 5 6 Adjustment Panel ScreenPRO II Controller INPUT OUTPUT SYSTEM EFFECTS STATUS DISPLAY FRAME GRAB REMOTE CONTROL Source Crop Top Left Bottom Right Reset Fine Adjust Light PRESETS DESTINATIONS / AUX Page 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 Learn Delete Next Clone Swap Z-Order Move Setup Move Mix Source Swap Toggle 5 13 6 14 7 15 8 16 SHIFT SDI 1 SDI 2 Previous Page 1 2 KEY 4 DEST AUX ALL TRANSITIONS LAYER FUNCTIONS PIP 3 Full Screen Freeze WIPE MIX CUT AUTO TRANS SOURCE SELECTION Program Program 1 9 2 10 3 11 4 12 BG A BG B Clear Layer 7 8 LAYER LAYER A B DSK LOGO Split 9 10 Figure 2-1. ScreenPRO-II Controller Front Panel 1) Touch Screen Menu Section 5) Light Adjustment Knob 9) Layer Control Section 2) Presets Section 6) XLR Connector 10) Transition Section 3) Destination/Aux Bus 7) Source Selection Bus 4) Joystick Section 8) Layer Functions Section Following are descriptions of each front panel feature: 1) Touch Screen Menu Section The Touch Screen Menu Section is used for system configuration, setup and operational adjustments — such as PIPs and Keys. Refer to the “Touch Screen Menu Section” heading on page 38 for details. 2) Presets Section The Preset Section enables you to store and recall Controller setups. Each button represents a single “look” of the projected image. Thirty-six presets are available. Refer to the “Presets Section” heading on page 39 for details. 34 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation ScreenPRO-II Controller Front Panel 3) Destination/Aux Bus The Destination/Aux Bus enables you to route the Controller’s output to one or more destinations, such as projectors and Aux (auxiliary) monitors. Four “Projector” and four “Aux” destinations are available. Refer to the “Destination/ Aux Bus” section on page 40 for details. 4) Joystick Section The Joystick Section includes a 3-axis joystick that enables you to adjust PIPs, Keys and additional system parameters. The section also includes dedicated buttons that change the Joystick’s assigned function. Refer to the “Joystick Section” heading on page 42 for details. 5) Light Adjustment Knob The Light Adjustment Knob enables you to control the brightness of the lowvoltage “script” light. 6) XLR Connector One XLR Connector is provided for the low-voltage “script” light. 7) Source Selection Bus The Source Selection Bus allows you to choose the sources that are routed into PIPs and keys. Buttons are provided for up to 16 analog sources and up to two HD-SDI/SD-SDI sources. Refer to the “Source Selection Bus” section on page 44 for details. 8) Layer Functions Section When a layer is active (and blinking) in the Layer Control Section, all buttons in the Layer Functions Section apply to that layer, enabling you to change its mode and manipulate the source. Refer to the “Layer Functions Section” heading on page 46 for details. 9) Layer Control Section The Layer Control Section is the operational heart of the ScreenPRO-II Controller, enabling you to assign sources to PIPs and keys. Here, you control the overall “look” on Preview and Program. Refer to the “Layer Control Section” heading on page 48 for details. 10) Transition Section The Transition Section includes the T-Bar for manually mixing sources on and off Program, plus dedicated buttons for cutting, mixing and wiping. Refer to the “Transition Section” heading on page 50 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 35 2. Hardware Orientation Use of Color rëÉ=çÑ=`çäçê Color plays an important “visual” role with the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s front panel buttons: White buttons are used for sources. 1 PIP Yellow buttons are functions and modes that apply to the active (blinking) layer. Functions include assigning PIPs and keys to the active layer, setting up moves, freezing the active layer and swapping layer priority. Orange buttons are used to control pages of presets, and for special MOVE and MOVE SETUP functions. Page Learn Red buttons are designated “important.” They are used in dual-button sequences such as SHIFT, Learn and Delete, and with important transition functions such as CUT and AUTO TRANS. Green buttons indicate unscaled sources, such as backgrounds and the DSK. DSK Blue buttons indicate scaled sources. LAYER A 36 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections cêçåí=m~åÉä=pÉÅíáçåë This section provides detailed descriptions and illustrations of each front panel section. The following topics are discussed: • • • • • • • • Touch Screen Menu Section Presets Section Destination/Aux Bus Joystick Section Source Selection Bus Layer Functions Section Layer Control Section Transition Section ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 37 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections qçìÅÜ=pÅêÉÉå=jÉåì=pÉÅíáçå The figure below illustrates the Touch Screen Menu Section. A sample menu is shown for reference. PIP ADJUSTMENT H O M E B O R D R H Size < 37.3% > 674 V Size < 58.9% > 452 H Position -34 V Position 70 N A V -----------------------------------S H D O W Move Rate [ 2.0 ] Key Frame Effect [ LINEAR ] A D J OPERATION: E F X JOY Z TO SIZE, X Y TO POSITION 3 TRACK SIZE 1 2 3 Figure 2-2. Touch Screen Menu Section 1) Softkeys 2) Touch Screen 3) Rotary Knobs Following are descriptions of each area: 1) Softkeys Eight un-labeled softkeys are provided — four to the left of the Touch Screen and four below. Softkey labels (when present) appear on the Touch Screen itself. Press the adjacent softkey to access the menu or activate the indicated function. 2) Touch Screen On the Touch Screen, all menus and functions can be accessed in a variety of different ways: ~ Touch the desired button on the Touch Screen itself (for example, the {BORDR} or {SHDOW} buttons) to access the menu as indicated. ~ ~ Press a Softkey that is directly adjacent to a button label. ~ Use the top NAV knob to move the highlight to the desired line, then use the ADJ rotary knob to adjust the value. Touch a particular line to move the highlight to that line, then use the ADJ rotary knob to adjust the value. Important 38 When adjusting parameters, there is no Enter button. If you adjust a value with the knobs or the softkeys, that function, parameter or value is immediately active in Preview. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections 3) Rotary Knobs Two Rotary Knobs are provided to the right of the Touch Screen. Each knob controls or adjusts the function that is labeled on the Touch Screen itself, immediately adjacent to the knob. Please note: ~ The Top Knob is generally assigned to navigating menu fields. For example, turning the knob moves a highlight up and down a list of parameters, allowing you to adjust the highlighted function. This knob also adjusts adjacent parameters. ~ The Bottom Knob is generally assigned to adjusting the highlighted parameter, as labeled on the Touch Screen. mêÉëÉíë=pÉÅíáçå The figure below illustrates the Presets Section: PRESETS Page 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 Learn Delete Next Previous Page Figure 2-3. Presets Section A Preset is a register in which you can store and recall entire Controller setups. One preset represents a single “look” of the Controller — including the current state of all mixers, layers, sources, and the DSK. The Controller provides buttons for 36 Presets (6 pages of 6 presets each). Following are descriptions of each button’s function. Preset Buttons — press to recall a Preset to the Preview bus. If resources are available, the “look” stored with that preset will be recalled. If the button does not light, system resources are not currently available to process the request. 4 When lit, the Red LED above each button indicates the currently selected page. S If LED 3 and button 6 are lit, the 6th Preset on page 3 is active. In Chapter 6, refer to the “A Word About Resources” section on page 243 for additional important information. Learn — hold down Learn, then press the desired Preset button to store the overall look of the Controller into that register. Learn S To store a Controller setup in Preset register 2, press Learn + 2. Delete — hold down Delete, then press the desired Preset button to delete that register from memory. Delete S To delete Preset 5 from memory, press Delete + 5. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 39 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections Next — press to recall the next valid Preset in sequential order. Please note: Next • • • If Preset 2 is lit, pressing Next recalls Preset 3. If Preset 6 is active on page 2, pressing Next advances to Preset 1 on page 3. If a Preset is undefined, it will be skipped when Next is pressed. Previous — this function is currently not implemented. Previous Page — hold down Page, then press the desired Preset button to switch to that page of Presets. The Red LED above the button lights to indicate the selected page. Page S To switch to page 5, press Page + 5. Note The Page button is also used (in conjunction with the ALL button) to lock and unlock the Controller. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Locking and Unlocking the Controller” section on page 252 for details. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Presets” section on page 243 for complete instructions on all Preset modes. aÉëíáå~íáçåL^ìñ=_ìë The figure below illustrates the Destination/Aux Bus: DESTINATIONS / AUX 1 2 3 DEST AUX 4 ALL Figure 2-4. Destination/Aux Bus Each numbered button on the Destination Bus represents a location to which you can route some form of controller (or router) output. The transitions that you perform will affect the selected destinations only, leaving the unselected destinations as they were. The ScreenPRO-II Controller provides eight destinations — four standard (e.g., projectors) and four Aux (auxiliary). Important Operationally, remember that the Destination/Aux Bus is one bus — it is not two separate and independent buses. • • 40 Any source selection will apply to all enabled buses. Any transition will apply to all enabled buses. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections Examples of destinations are listed below: • Single Screen Destination — this is a “single projector” destination that takes its input from a ScreenPRO-II. • Wide Screen Destination — this is a “multiple projector” destination that takes its inputs from two, three or four ScreenPRO-IIs, as routed through a BlendPRO-II. • Aux Destination — this is a single monitor that takes its input from one router output (in a single format). When you select an Aux destination and a source on the Controller, you are talking directly to a specific router output via RS-232 or Ethernet communications — and making a source-to-destination connection. • ImagePRO Aux Destination — this is a standalone ImagePRO that takes its input(s) from multiple routers, in multiple formats. When connected to a single monitor or projector, a scaled output signal is provided — in one format. Whereas an Aux Destination requires a single input format, an ImagePRO Aux Destination accepts inputs in multiple formats. • PresentationPRO-II Aux Destination — similar to an ImagePRO Aux destination, this is a standalone PresentationPRO-II that takes its input(s) from standalone sources or routers, in multiple formats. When connected to a single monitor or projector, a scaled signal is provided in one format. In Chapter 5, refer to the “Standard Destination Setup” section on page 192 for details on all destination setup procedures. Following are descriptions of each button’s function. 1 Destination/Aux Buttons — press to toggle the numbered destination on or off. Any combination of destinations can be selected. The transitions that you perform will affect only the selected destination(s). Please note: • The four destination buttons work in conjunction with the DEST/AUX button. See the description of the DEST/AUX button (immediately below) for details. • Press a numbered destination button by itself to enable that destination and toggle all other destinations off. In this mode, the buttons are mutually exclusive. • Press two or more destination buttons simultaneously to enable a “group” of destinations. In this mode, the selected group is mutually exclusive with any other active destinations: S Destinations 1, 2 and 3 are lit. If you press destinations 1 and 2 simultaneously (to enable them), destination 3 turns off. • DEST AUX Use the All button to turn all destinations on or off. See the description of the All button (below) for details. DEST/AUX — press to switch the bus between standard (projector) destinations and Aux (auxiliary) destinations, such as monitors. • • When DEST/AUX is off, you are selecting standard (projector) destinations. When DEST/AUX is lit, you are selecting Aux (auxiliary) destinations. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 41 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections All — the All button works in conjunction with the currently selected bus (as chosen with the DEST/AUX button): All • • Press All once to turn all “defined” destinations on. Double-punch the All button to turn all “defined” destinations off. Note The All button is also used (in conjunction with the Page button) to lock and unlock the Controller. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Locking and Unlocking the Controller” section on page 252 for details. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Destinations” section on page 222 for complete instructions on all destination modes. gçóëíáÅâ=pÉÅíáçå The figure below illustrates the Joystick Section. Adjustment Panel Source Crop Top Left Bottom Right Reset Fine Adjust Figure 2-5. Joystick Section When a PIP or Key is selected in the Layer Control Section, the controls in the Joystick section are automatically assigned to manipulate that feature on Preview. When none of the six function buttons are lit, the 3-axis Joystick has the following functions: • X-Axis Control — Move the Joystick left and right to move the PIP (or Key) left and right respectively. • Y-Axis Control — Move the Joystick up and down to move the PIP (or Key) up and down on Preview. • Z-Axis Control — Twist the Joystick’s top knob clockwise and counterclockwise to increase or decrease the PIP (or Key) size. Note 42 The Z-Axis Control can also be used to increase or decrease the value of a highlighted parameter, such as a matte color, key clip and gain, border size and much more. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections Descriptions of each button in the Joystick Section are listed below. Source — press to assign the Joystick to sizing and positioning the source image within the PIP or Key boundaries. Please note: Source • In Source mode, the PIP or Key’s placement on screen remains static, while the image is adjusted within. • If a PIP is selected, the Input Source Adjustment Menu appears when Source is enabled. • If a Key is selected, the Key Source Adjustment Menu appears when Source is enabled. To return to normal PIP adjustment, turn the button off. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Source Adjustment Menus” section on page 165 for additional details. Crop Reset Crop — press to re-assign the Joystick to cropping the boundaries of the PIP or Key. When enabled, the Top Left and Bottom Right buttons are also enabled, and the Crop Adjustment Menu appears. To return to normal PIP adjustment, toggle the button off. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Crop Menu” section on page 164 for additional details. Reset — the Reset button is a momentary function. Press to reset the current effect (e.g., PIP, Key, crop, etc.) to a nominal default value. Think of this function as being “context sensitive” — as it resets only the current effect, without affecting other modifications. Top Left — when the Crop button is lit, press to crop the PIP or Key’s top and left edges: Top Left • • Move the Joystick left and right to crop the left edge. Move the Joystick up and down to crop the top edge. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Crop Menu” section on page 164 for additional details. Bottom Right Bottom Right — when the Crop button is lit, press to crop the PIP or Key’s bottom and right edges: • • Move the Joystick left and right to crop the right edge. Move the Joystick up and down to crop the bottom edge. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Crop Menu” section on page 164 for additional details. Fine Adjust Fine Adjust — the Fine Adjust button is a latching function. In any PIP or Key adjustment mode, press to increase the precision of the Joystick’s adjustment range. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Modifying Layers On Program” section on page 234 for additional details on Joystick usage. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 43 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections pçìêÅÉ=pÉäÉÅíáçå=_ìë The figure below illustrates the Source Selection Bus. SOURCE SELECTION Program 1 9 2 10 3 11 4 12 5 13 6 14 7 15 8 16 SHIFT SDI 1 SDI 2 Figure 2-6. Source Selection Bus On the Source Selection Bus, each numbered button represents an input that you can assign to a PIP or Key, or route to an Aux destination. Each input is either a direct connection to a ScreenPRO-II or a router input. Please note: • If you have configured a ScreenPRO-II to use internal routing (on the Destination Setup Menu), both the white buttons (analog sources) and the yellow buttons (HD-SDI/SD-SDI sources) are active. You can assign a maximum of 16 analog and 2 HD-SDI/SD-SDI sources. • If you have configured a ScreenPRO-II to use external routing (on the Destination Setup Menu), only the white buttons are active. You can assign a maximum of 16 sources, comprised of any mix of analog and digital. Important In this mode, with external routing enabled, the two yellow SDI buttons are disabled. Following are descriptions of each button’s function in the Source Selection Bus. Source Buttons — press to assign the source (analog or digital) to the blinking “mixer” button in the Layer Control Section. The following rules apply: 1 9 SDI 1 • When the source button is lit and blinking, the source is on Preview, the associated layer is active for modification, and the associated layer’s raster box blinks on Preview. • When the source button is lit solid, the source is on Preview — but its associated layer is not active for modification. • Multiple source buttons can be lit simultaneously, but only one source button can be blinking — with its associated layer active for modification and the associated raster box blinking on Preview. • When the Red LED above a source button is lit solid, the source is on Program — and its associated destination is enabled. Important 44 The Red LEDs only appear if the route’s associated destination button is enabled. For example, if Source 1 on Destination 1 is on Program, the Red LED above Source 1 will turn off if Destination 1 is cleared. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections • When the Red LED above a source button is blinking: ~ ~ ~ The mixer is set to Mix Mode (the Split button is not lit). The blinking Red LED indicates the layer that is on Program. The alternate layer is enabled for modification on Preview, and its associated raster box blinks. S The Red LED above source 1 is blinking, and the Red LED above Layer A is blinking. This indicates that the mixer is set to Mix Mode, source 1 is on program in Layer A, and Layer B is active for modification on Preview. • Multiple Red LEDs can be lit simultaneously, but only one Red LED can be blinking — indicating a “Mix Mode” association between a source and a layer. • Source buttons cannot be selected if they have not been assigned during the source setup procedure. The button will not light. • Source buttons are also used to route inputs to selected Aux destinations. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Destinations” section on page 222 for details. Note When the Controller is locked, source buttons are used to enter the 4-digit password. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Locking and Unlocking the Controller” section on page 252 for details. Shift — the Shift button is a toggle: press once to light, press again to turn off. When lit, press the desired source button to access the second row of numbered sources (9 - 16). Shift ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 45 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections i~óÉê=cìåÅíáçåë=pÉÅíáçå The figure below illustrates the Layer Functions Section. LAYER FUNCTIONS PIP KEY Full Screen Clone Swap Z-Order Move Setup Move Mix Source Swap Toggle Freeze Figure 2-7. Layer Functions Section The buttons in the Layer Functions Section enable you to change or modify the selected (blinking) layer in the Layer Control Section. PIP PIP — press to change the selected layer (in the Layer Control Section) and its associated source to a PIP. The PIP Adjustment Menu appears on the Touch Screen. In Chapter 4, refer to the “PIP Adjustment Menu” section on page 148 for details. KEY Key — press to change the selected layer (in the Layer Control Section) and its associated source to a Key. The Key Adjustment Menu appears. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Key Menu” section on page 155 for details. Full Screen Full Screen — press to take the active PIP or Key to full screen. In each case, the source’s height is used as the parameter that defines the full screen size. S If a source’s original dimension is 1280 x 1024, pressing Full Screen expands (or reduces) the PIP or Key to fill the output screen vertically. If borders are ON, they will be taken into account so that they are visible. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Using Full Screen” section on page 235 for instructions. Clone Clone — for widescreen configurations only, press to make an exact copy of a layer onto the opposite screen. All parameters of the PIP or Key are cloned, including the source’s shadow, key effects, border and size. Once cloned, you can select between a “mirror” or an “offset” clone. S If Layer A is a PIP on screen 1, press Clone to make an exact copy of the PIP on screen 2. When you adjust the PIP, both the original and the “cloned” copy are adjusted simultaneously. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Using Clone” section on page 235 for instructions. Swap Z-order Swap Z-order — press to change the visual priority (on Preview) of the two mixer layers. The PIPs or Keys remain at their current locations — only the priority changes. S If the PIP on Layer B is visually on top of the PIP on Layer A, press Swap Z-Order to place Layer A’s PIP on top. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Using Swap Z-Order” section on page 236 for instructions. 46 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections Move Setup — two functions are provided: Move Setup • Press Move Setup to set up a “move” for a PIP or Key, enabling you to choose the move’s start and end points. • Double-punch the Move Setup button to un-define (or clear) the “move setup” for the selected layer. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Using Move” section on page 238 for complete instructions. Move — press to pend a “move” for a PIP or Key, enabling you to fly the PIP or Key from one location to another on the next auto transition. Move Mix Source Swap Toggle In Chapter 6, refer to the “Using Move” section on page 238 for complete instructions. Mix Source — in “Mix Mode” (with the Split button off) press Mix Source to co-locate both PIPs in the mixer. Layers A and B will be exactly the same size — in exactly the same position. Mix Source and Swap modes are mutually exclusive. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Understanding Split and Mix Modes” section on page 228 for instructions. Swap — in “Mix Mode” (with the Split button off) press Swap to allow both PIPs in the mixer to be located independently. Layers A and B can be positioned and sized anywhere as desired. Mix Source and Swap modes are mutually exclusive. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Understanding Split and Mix Modes” section on page 228 for instructions. Toggle — press to toggle sources back and forth with each transition. Once a source transitions off Program within a PIP, it “flip-flops” to Preview. Toggle is used with both the Mix Source and Swap modes, and also functions with background transitions. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Understanding Split and Mix Modes” section on page 228 for details. Freeze — enables you to freeze a layer on both Program and Preview. Freeze In Chapter 6, refer to the “Using Freeze” section on page 236 for instructions. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 47 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections i~óÉê=`çåíêçä=pÉÅíáçå The figure below illustrates the Layer Control Section. Program BG A BG B Clear Layer LAYER LAYER A B DSK LOGO Split Figure 2-8. Layer Control Section The buttons in the Layer Control Section enable you to select (on Preview) the sources that will transition to or from Program — including backgrounds, layers, the DSK and the full screen LOGO. When you select a blue “layer” button, you are electronically selecting a scaler that you want to assign as a PIP or key, or modify in some manner. In this way, you control the overall look on Preview before you transition that look to Program. Please note the following important points: • Two background sources, two layers (in the mixer), one DSK and one full screen LOGO are provided — identical to the layers on an individual ScreenPRO-II. • The buttons are arranged left-to-right in order of visual priority — from the backgrounds (at the lowest priority) to the LOGO (at the highest visual priority). • Any combination of backgrounds, layers, DSK and LOGO can be selected on Preview for transition to or from Program. Note In both single and widescreen modes, the only restriction is that BG B and the DSK are mutually exclusive. This occurs because the BG/DSK Input B is shared between the DSK and BG B on all individual ScreenPRO-II units. Following are descriptions of each button’s function. Important Each ScreenPRO-II unit uses a “lookahead” Preview monitor that fully represents how the Program output will appear next. By selecting combinations of PIPs, keys, backgrounds and the DSK, you are composing a Preview image that will appear on Program — after the next transition. A “lit” button does not necessarily mean that the source will transition on or off — it simply means that it is part of the “look” on Preview. Background Buttons — press to select an unscaled background on Preview for transition to or from Program. The button lights when selected. Please note: BG A 48 • • If the Red LED is lit, the background is on Program. If BG A is on Program and BG A is selected in Preview, there will be no change of backgrounds on the next transition. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections • If BG A is on Program and BG B is selected in Preview, BG A will dissolve, cut or wipe to BG B on the next transition. • Toggle mode affects background transitions. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Background Transitions” section on page 227 for complete instructions. Layer Buttons — press to select a layer on Preview for transition to or from Program. • When lit and blinking: ~ ~ ~ Layer A The layer is active for manipulation. A source can be assigned to the layer from the Source Selection Bus. The layer can be assigned as a PIP or Key using the buttons in the Layer Functions Section. • When lit solid, the layer is on Preview, but it is not active for manipulation. It is, however, ready to be transitioned to or from Program. • • When the Red LED above the button is lit, the layer is on Program. To clear a layer from Preview (so that it will transition off Program), press Clear Layer. This turns off the layer button. If the Red LED above the layer button is lit, on the next transition the layer will transition off Program. DSK — press to select the unscaled DSK on Preview for transition to or from Program. The button lights when selected. Please note: DSK • • When the Red LED above the button is lit, the DSK is on Program. The DSK and BG B are mutually exclusive. LOGO — press to select the unscaled, full screen LOGO on Preview for transition to or from Program. The button lights when selected. Please note: LOGO • • When the Red LED above the button is lit, the LOGO is on Program. • The LOGO layer is often used as a “black preview” function. If Black is selected as the “type” on the Logo Input Setup Menu, you can fade to black at any time by selecting LOGO on preview. In Chapter 4, refer to the “LOGO Menu” section on page 182 for details. • The logo is not a live input, and does not have an associated key signal. The LOGO is the system’s highest priority layer. The LOGO “source” is selected from one of the individual ScreenPRO-II’s three internal frame stores. Important Clear Layer All layers are maintained underneath the LOGO. For example, if you have two PIPs and a DSK on Program when you transition to the LOGO, when you fade the LOGO off — the previous “look” is still there. Clear Layer — press Clear Layer to remove the currently selected (blinking) layer from Preview — in preparation for transitioning it off Program. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Clearing Layers from Program” section on page 234 for instructions. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 49 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections Split — press to select whether or not the mixer’s two layers work independently (in Split Mode), in tandem (Mix Mode), or in “Join” mode. Split • Mix Mode — the Split Layer button is off. In this mode, the two layers are ganged together, offering a variety of additional transitions including the toggle, mix source and swap functions. • Split Mode — the Split Layer button is on. In this mode, each layer works independently. You have the freedom to size, position, manipulate and transition each one independently of the other. • Join Mode — the Split Layer button is on. The currently blinking layer button is considered the “master.” Press and hold the Split Layer button, then press the other (non-blinking) layer button to “join” the two layers together. Both layer buttons blink, and in this mode, both are now joined together. ~ Any manipulation that you perform to the “master” layer is also performed to the joined layer. Both can be sized, positioned, moved and manipulated as if they are one. ~ To un-join the two layers, press and hold the Split Layer button, then press either Layer button. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Layers” section on page 226 for details. qê~åëáíáçå=pÉÅíáçå The figure below illustrates the Transition Section. TRANSITIONS WIPE MIX CUT AUTO TRANS Figure 2-9. Transition Section Descriptions of each button and control are provided below: WIPE MIX 50 WIPE — press to select a wipe as the current transition type for the selected destination. The button lights when enabled, and the wipe is initiated by pressing AUTO TRANS. The wipe patterns, edge types and transition rates are selected using the Effects Menu. MIX — press to select a mix (dissolve) as the current transition type for the selected destination. The button lights when enabled, and the mix is initiated by pressing AUTO TRANS. Auto transition rates are defined using the Effects Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections CUT — press to instantly cut the images from Preview to Program. CUT AUTO TRANS Auto Trans — press to transition automatically from Preview to Program at a pre-defined rate, using the selected transition type (MIX or WIPE). Auto transition rates are defined using the Effects Menu. Note Because the Controller’s Effects Menu is destination-based, WIPE and MIX effects can be assigned per destination. For example, with destinations 1 and 3 lit, select WIPE. Next, with destination 2 lit, select MIX. Next, select all three destinations and press AUTO TRANS to perform a wipe on destinations 1 and 3, and a dissolve on destination 2. T-Bar — enables you to perform smooth, manual transitions. Each time the T-Bar is moved from limit to limit, the setup on Preview transitions to Program using the selected transition type (MIX or WIPE). For additional information on transitions and the Effects Menu: • • In Chapter 4, refer to the “Effects Menu” section on page 146 for menu details. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Transitions” section on page 241 for operational procedures. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 51 2. Hardware Orientation Front Panel Sections 52 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide PK==e~êÇï~êÉ=fåëí~ää~íáçå få=qÜáë=`Ü~éíÉê This chapter provides comprehensive installation instructions for the ScreenPRO-II Controller system’s hardware. The following topics are discussed: • • • • • • • • • Safety Precautions Unpacking and Inspection Site Preparation Controller Installation Cable, Adapter and Accessory Information Connection Charts System Installation BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections Overview of Edge-Blending Technology Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Once you have reviewed all of the sections in this chapter, please continue with Chapter 4, “Menu Orientation” on page 85. 53 3. Hardware Installation Safety Precautions p~ÑÉíó=mêÉÅ~ìíáçåë= For all ScreenPRO-II Controller installation procedures, please observe the following important safety and handling rules to avoid damage to yourself and the equipment: • To protect users from electric shock, ensure that the chassis connects to earth via the ground wire provided in the AC power Cord. • The AC Socket-outlet should be installed near the equipment and be easily accessible. råé~ÅâáåÖ=~åÇ=fåëéÉÅíáçå= Before opening the ScreenPRO-II Controller shipping box, inspect it for damage. If you find any damage, notify the shipping carrier immediately for all claims adjustments. As you open the box, compare its contents against the packing slip. If you find any shortages, contact your sales representative. Once you have removed all the components from their packaging and checked that all the listed components are present, visually inspect the system to ensure there was no damage during shipping. If there is damage, notify the shipping carrier immediately for all claims adjustments. páíÉ=mêÉé~ê~íáçå= The environment in which you install your ScreenPRO-II Controller should be clean, properly lit, free from static, and have adequate power, ventilation, and space for all components. `çåíêçääÉê=fåëí~ää~íáçå The ScreenPRO-II Controller is designed to be used in a “tabletop” configuration, without rack mounting. Because the Controller is part of a larger system, which can involve a variety of components including ScreenPRO-II, BlendPRO-II, MatrixPRO routers, ImagePRO, PresentationPRO-II and one or more projectors, please refer to the “System Installation” section on page 73 for comprehensive installation instructions. 54 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Cable, Adapter and Accessory Information `~ÄäÉI=^Ç~éíÉê=~åÇ=^ÅÅÉëëçêó=fåÑçêã~íáçå The table below provides information regarding cables and adapters: Table 3-1. ScreenPRO-II Controller System Cables, Adapters and Accessories Item Description Note Accessories Gooseneck Lamp Connects to the XLR connector on the Controller panel 1 Lamp Supplied Power Connections AC Power Cord AC Power, 7 foot, 10A Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 1 Cord Supplied In Chapter 3, “Hardware Installation” of the ScreenPRO-II User’s Guide, refer to the “Cable and Adapter Information” section for details on the components supplied with individual ScreenPRO-II units. 55 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts `çååÉÅíáçå=`Ü~êíë= The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • Connection Chart Overview Sample Connection Charts — External Routing Sample Connection Charts — Internal Routing Blank Connection Charts `çååÉÅíáçå=`Ü~êí=lîÉêîáÉï A series of Connection Charts are provided on the following pages to assist with your ScreenPRO-II input and output connections. Please note the following points: • • Each ScreenPRO-II provides: ~ 8 x analog inputs, scaled. These can be used to connect RGB, composite, S-Video (Y/C) and component video. ~ ~ 2 x HD-SDI/SD-SDI inputs, scaled (on the HD model). 2 x DVI inputs, unscaled (BG/DSK). You can connect sources directly to inputs (internal routing), or you can connect router outputs to inputs (external routing). This assignment is performed on the Destination Setup Menu. Note that the use of routers offers less restrictions with regard to assigning sources to layers. ~ If you have configured a ScreenPRO-II to use internal routing, both the white buttons (analog sources) and the yellow buttons (HD-SDI/SD-SDI sources) are active on the Source Selection Bus. You can assign a maximum of 16 analog and 2 HD-SDI/SD-SDI sources. ~ If you have configured a ScreenPRO-II to use external routing, only the white source buttons on the Source Selection Bus are active. You can assign a maximum of 16 sources, using any mix of analog and digital. Important • In this mode, with external routing enabled, the two yellow SDI buttons are disabled. On each ScreenPRO-II, two DVI connectors are provided for Background and DSK Inputs. Both connectors are digital only, and do not include analog pins. Please note: ~ To use two background sources, connect one source to connector A and one to connector B. ~ To use one background and one DSK source, connect the background to connector A and the DSK source to connector B. Chart instructions: • Analog Router I/O Chart If you are using external routing, complete the Analog I/O router chart for your analog input and output connections. The chart can also be used to specify router outputs that connect to Aux destinations. 56 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts • Digital Router I/O Chart If you are using external routing, complete the digital I/O router chart for your digital input and output connections. The chart can also be used to specify router outputs that connect to Aux destinations. • Analog Input Chart — Direct or DA Connections If you are using internal routing, complete the analog input chart for direct or DA analog connections to each ScreenPRO-II and other target analog destinations. Be sure to check (3) whether or not the analog input is a direct connection, or from a DA output. • Digital Input Chart — Direct or DA Connections If you are using internal routing, complete the digital input chart for direct or DA digital connections to each ScreenPRO-II and other target analog destinations. Be sure to check (3) whether or not the digital input is a direct connection, or from a DA output. • DVI Connection Chart For all system configurations, complete the DVI Connection Chart to map your Background and DSK DVI connections. Be sure to check (3) whether or not the DVI source originates from a multi-head graphics card, or a DA (or splitter). • Standard Destination Chart For all system configurations, complete the Standard Destination Chart. The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to configure up to four standard destinations. Note that the chart is also used to map the usage of BlendPRO-II in widescreen configurations. • Auxiliary Destination Chart For all system configurations, complete the Auxiliary Destination Chart. The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to configure up to four auxiliary destinations. Before you complete the actual charts, please review the sample charts as provided in the following two sections: • • “Sample Connection Charts — External Routing”, page 58. “Sample Connection Charts — Internal Routing”, page 62. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 57 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts p~ãéäÉ=`çååÉÅíáçå=`Ü~êíë=Ô=bñíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ Following are sample connection charts for a ScreenPRO-II Controller system configured for external routing. The system is comprised of the following components: • • • • • • 2 x ScreenPRO-II 1 x widescreen destination (using two projectors) 1 x BlendPRO-II 2 x Aux destinations (PresentationPRO-II, ImagePRO) 1 x Analog router, 8x8 1 x SDI router, 8x8 The figure below provides a simplified diagram of the system: PresentationPRO-II (Aux Destination 1) Widescreen Destination MatrixPRO RGBHV Router ImagePRO (Aux Destination 2) ScreenPRO-II #1 MatrixPRO HD-SDI Router BlendPRO-II Preview Left Preview Right Program Left Program Right ScreenPRO-II #2 ScreenPRO-II Controller PC (Background) DVI PC (DSK) DVI Ethernet Distribution (Local Network Only) Figure 3-1. Sample System with External Routing The following sample charts are provided: • • • • • External Routing — Sample Analog Router I/O Chart External Routing — Sample Digital Router I/O Chart Widescreen — Sample DVI Connection Chart Widescreen — Sample Standard Destination Chart Widescreen — Sample Auxiliary Destination Chart Note 58 Abbreviated charts are used in the following sections. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts bñíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=^å~äçÖ=oçìíÉê=fLl=`Ü~êí With a ScreenPRO-II configured to use external routing (on the Destination Setup Menu), use the following chart to map Analog Router input and output connections: Table 3-2. Sample Analog Router I/O Chart Router #1 — Analog Router Source Name Controller Input # ← Input | Output → Connects to: DVD A 7 1 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 1 Analog DVD B 8 2 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 2 Analog LOGO 9 3 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 1 Analog PowerPoint 10 4 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 2 Analog PowerPoint Backup 11 5 PrePRO-II, Input 1 Analog Demo A 12 6 ImagePRO, Analog Input Demo B 13 7 Betacam 6 8 bñíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=aáÖáí~ä=oçìíÉê=fLl=`Ü~êí With a ScreenPRO-II configured to use external routing, use the following chart to map SDI Router input and output connections: Table 3-3. Sample Digital Router I/O Chart Router #2 — SDI Router Source Name Camera 1 Controller Input # ← Input | Output → Connects to: 1 1 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 1 SDI Camera 2 2 2 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 2 SDI Camera 3 3 3 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 1 SDI Digital Betacam 4 4 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 2 SDI Server 5 5 PrePRO-II, Input 1 SDI 6 ImagePRO, SDI Input 7 8 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 59 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts táÇÉëÅêÉÉå==Ô=p~ãéäÉ=asf=`çååÉÅíáçå=`Ü~êí Each ScreenPRO-II has two DVI inputs for the Background and DSK (BG/DSK in A and BG/DSK in B). Widescreen backgrounds will typically originate from a multi-head graphics card, while single screen backgrounds are typically distributed from one computer through a DA or signal splitter. Use the following chart to map your Background and DSK DVI connections: Table 3-4. Sample DVI Connection Chart Background DVI Routing Source Multi-Head Graphics Card Out 3 3 Computer 1 DA (or Splitter) Connects to: Note 1 ScreenPRO-II #1, BG/DSK In A Widescreen BG 2 ScreenPRO-II #2, BG/DSK In A Widescreen BG ScreenPRO-II #1, BG/DSK In B Single screen DSK ScreenPRO-II #2, BG/DSK In B Single screen DSK 3 4 Computer 2 1 2 3 3 3 4 táÇÉëÅêÉÉå=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=pí~åÇ~êÇ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=`Ü~êí The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to configure up to four standard destinations. Use the following chart to map the distribution of each destination, the usage of BlendPRO-II if required, and the routing of your additional program and preview outputs: Table 3-5. Sample Standard Destination Connection Chart Standard Destinations Output ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm DVI Dest 1 ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm Analog 1 Screen Widescreen left BlendPRO-II Channel Notes 1 R12+ 2 R12+ VGA 1 ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm Analog 2 ScreenPRO-II #1 Pvw ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm DVI ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm Analog 1 VGA 2 2 Widescreen right VGA 3 ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm Analog 2 ScreenPRO-II #2 Pvw 60 VGA 4 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts táÇÉëÅêÉÉå=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=^ìñáäá~êó=aÉëíáå~íáçå=`Ü~êí The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to configure up to four auxiliary destinations. Use the following chart to map the distribution of each auxiliary destination: Table 3-6. Sample Aux Destination Connection Chart Aux Destinations Dest 1 Device PresentationPRO-II Inputs from Analog Router Out #5 Screen / Device Notes Downstage monitor LC47 Record VTR Digital Betacam Digital Router Out #5 2 ImagePRO Analog Router Out #6 Digital Router Out #6 Important ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide For all Widescreen configurations using BlendPRO-II, ensure that you review the “BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections” section on page 77. 61 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts p~ãéäÉ=`çååÉÅíáçå=`Ü~êíë=Ô=fåíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ Following are sample connection charts for a ScreenPRO-II Controller system configured for internal routing. The system is comprised of the following components: • • • 2 x ScreenPRO-II 2 x single screen destinations 2 x Aux destinations (PresentationPRO-II, ImagePRO) The figure below provides a simplified diagram of the system: Camera Analog DA PresentationPRO-II (Aux Destination 1) Single Screen Destinations DVD or VTR ImagePRO (Aux Destination 2) ScreenPRO-II #1 MAC PC Server or D-VTR Preview Left Preview Right Program Left Program Right ScreenPRO-II #2 Digital DA ScreenPRO-II Controller PC (Background) DVI PC (DSK) DVI Ethernet Distribution (Local Network Only) Figure 3-2. Sample System with Internal Routing The following sample charts are provided: • • • • • Internal Routing — Sample Analog Input Chart Internal Routing — Sample Digital Input Chart Single Screens — Sample DVI Connection Chart Single Screens — Sample Standard Destination Chart Single Screens — Sample Auxiliary Destination Chart Note 62 Abbreviated charts are used in the following sections. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts fåíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=^å~äçÖ=fåéìí=`Ü~êí With a ScreenPRO-II configured to use internal routing (on the Destination Setup Menu), use the following chart to map Analog Inputs to each ScreenPRO-II and other target analog destinations. Note that the use of DAs is recommended to provide identical inputs to each ScreenPRO-II (or target device). Table 3-7. Sample Analog Input Chart — Direct or DA Connections Analog Inputs Source Name Direct DA 3 Camera 3 DVD 3 MAC DA Output Target Input 1 PresentationPRO-II, Analog Input 2 ImagePRO, Analog Input 3 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 1 Analog 4 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 1 Analog 1 PresentationPRO-II, Analog Input 2 ImagePRO, Analog Input 3 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 2 Analog 4 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 2 Analog 1 2 3 PC 3 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 3 Analog 4 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 3 Analog 1 2 3 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 4 Analog 4 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 4 Analog fåíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=aáÖáí~ä=fåéìí=`Ü~êí With a ScreenPRO-II configured to use internal routing, use the following chart to map Digital Inputs to each ScreenPRO-II and other target digital destinations. The use of DAs is recommended to provide identical inputs to each ScreenPRO-II (or target device). Table 3-8. Sample Digital Input Chart — Direct or DA Connections Digital Inputs Source Name Direct Server DA 3 DA Output ScreenPRO-II Input 1 ScreenPRO-II #1, Input 1 Digital 2 ScreenPRO-II #2, Input 1 Digital 3 4 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 63 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts páåÖäÉ=pÅêÉÉåë=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=asf=`çååÉÅíáçå=`Ü~êí Each ScreenPRO-II has two DVI inputs for the Background and DSK (BG/DSK in A and BG/DSK in B). Single screen backgrounds are typically distributed from one computer through a DA or signal splitter. Use the following chart to map your Background and DSK DVI connections: Table 3-9. Sample DVI Connection Chart Background DVI Routing Source Multi-Head Graphics Card Out Computer 1 1 2 DA (or Splitter) 3 3 Connects to: Note ScreenPRO-II #1, BG/DSK In A Single screen BG ScreenPRO-II #2, BG/DSK In A Single screen BG ScreenPRO-II #1, BG/DSK In B Single screen DSK ScreenPRO-II #2, BG/DSK In B Single screen DSK 3 4 Computer 2 1 2 3 3 3 4 páåÖäÉ=pÅêÉÉåë=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=pí~åÇ~êÇ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=`Ü~êí The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to configure up to four standard destinations. Use the following chart to map the distribution of each destination and the routing of your additional program and preview outputs: Table 3-10. Sample Standard Destination Connection Chart Standard Destinations Output ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm DVI Dest 1 ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm Analog 1 Screen Stage left BlendPRO-II Channel Notes n/a R12+ n/a R12+ VGA 1 ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm Analog 2 ScreenPRO-II #1 Pvw ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm DVI ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm Analog 1 VGA 2 2 Stage right VGA 3 ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm Analog 2 ScreenPRO-II #2 Pvw 64 VGA 4 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts páåÖäÉ=pÅêÉÉåë=Ô=p~ãéäÉ=^ìñáäá~êó=aÉëíáå~íáçå=`Ü~êí The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to configure up to four auxiliary destinations. Use the following chart to map the distribution of each auxiliary destination: Table 3-11. Sample Aux Destination Connection Chart Aux Destinations Dest 1 Device PresentationPRO-II Inputs from Analog DA #1, Out #1 Screen / Device Notes Downstage monitor LC47 Record VTR Digital Betacam Analog DA #2, Out #1 2 ImagePRO Analog DA #2, Out #2 Analog DA #2, Out #2 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 65 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts _ä~åâ=`çååÉÅíáçå=`Ü~êíë= The following blank connection charts are provided: • • • • • • • External Routing — Analog Router I/O Chart External Routing — Digital Router I/O Chart Internal Routing — Analog Input Chart Internal Routing — Digital Input Chart DVI Connection Chart Standard Destination Chart Auxiliary Destination Chart bñíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ=Ô=^å~äçÖ=oçìíÉê=fLl=`Ü~êí If you are using external routing, complete the following Analog Router I/O Chart to map your analog input and output connections. The chart can also be used to specify analog router outputs that connect to Aux destinations. Refer to the “External Routing — Sample Analog Router I/O Chart” section on page 59 for a sample chart. Table 3-12. Analog Router I/O Chart Router #1 — Analog Router Source Name Controller Input # ← Input | Output → Connects to: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 66 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts bñíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ=Ô=aáÖáí~ä=oçìíÉê=fLl=`Ü~êí If you are using external routing, complete the following Digital Router I/O Chart to map your digital input and output connections. The chart can also be used to specify digital router outputs that connect to Aux destinations. Refer to the “External Routing — Sample Digital Router I/O Chart” section on page 59 for a sample chart. Table 3-13. Digital Router I/O Chart Router #2 — Digital Router Source Name Controller Input # ← Input | Output → Connects to: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 67 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts fåíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ=Ô=^å~äçÖ=fåéìí=`Ü~êí If you are using internal routing, complete the following Analog Input Chart to map your analog input connections, either direct or via DA. The chart can also be used to specify other analog destinations such as Aux device inputs. Please copy the chart as required for additional inputs. Refer to the “Internal Routing — Sample Analog Input Chart” section on page 63 for a sample chart. Table 3-14. Analog Input Chart — Direct or DA Connections Analog Inputs Source Name Direct DA DA Output Target Input 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 68 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts fåíÉêå~ä=oçìíáåÖ=Ô=aáÖáí~ä=fåéìí=`Ü~êí If you are using internal routing, complete the following Digital Input Chart to map your digital input connections, either direct or via DA. The chart can also be used to specify other digital destinations such as Aux device inputs. Please copy the chart as required for additional inputs. Refer to the “Internal Routing — Sample Digital Input Chart” section on page 63 for a sample chart Table 3-15. Digital Input Chart — Direct or DA Connections Digital Inputs Source Name Direct DA DA Output ScreenPRO-II Input 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 69 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts asf=`çååÉÅíáçå=`Ü~êí Each ScreenPRO-II has two DVI inputs for the Background and DSK (BG/DSK in A and BG/DSK in B). Widescreen backgrounds will typically originate from a multi-head graphics card, while single screen backgrounds are typically distributed from one computer through a DA or signal splitter. Use the following chart to map your Background and DSK DVI connections. Refer to the “Widescreen — Sample DVI Connection Chart” section on page 60 for a sample chart. Table 3-16. Sample DVI Connection Chart Background DVI Routing Source Computer 1 Multi-Head Graphics Card Out DA (or Splitter) Connects to: Note 1 2 3 4 Computer 2 1 2 3 4 Computer 3 1 2 3 4 Computer 4 1 2 3 4 70 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts pí~åÇ~êÇ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=`Ü~êí The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to configure up to four standard destinations. Use the following chart to map the distribution of each destination, the usage of BlendPRO-II if required, and the routing of your additional program and preview outputs. Refer to the “Widescreen — Sample Standard Destination Chart” section on page 60 for a sample chart. Table 3-17. Standard Destination Connection Chart Standard Destinations Output Dest Screen BlendPRO-II Channel Notes ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm DVI ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm Analog 1 ScreenPRO-II #1 Pgm Analog 2 ScreenPRO-II #1 Pvw ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm DVI ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm Analog 1 ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm Analog 2 ScreenPRO-II #2 Pvw ScreenPRO-II #3 Pgm DVI ScreenPRO-II #3 Pgm Analog 1 ScreenPRO-II #3 Pgm Analog 2 ScreenPRO-II #3 Pvw ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm DVI ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm Analog 1 ScreenPRO-II #2 Pgm Analog 2 ScreenPRO-II #2 Pvw ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 71 3. Hardware Installation Connection Charts ^ìñáäá~êó=aÉëíáå~íáçå=`Ü~êí The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to configure up to four auxiliary destinations. Use the following chart to map the distribution of each auxiliary destination: Table 3-18. Aux Destination Connection Chart Aux Destinations Dest Device Inputs from Screen / Device Notes 1 2 3 4 72 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation System Installation póëíÉã=fåëí~ää~íáçå This section provides instructions for installing your ScreenPRO-II Controller system. If required, use the two previous sample system diagrams for reference: • Refer to “Figure 3-1” on page 58 for an illustration of a Sample System with External Routing. • Refer to “Figure 3-2” on page 62 for an illustration of a Sample System with Internal Routing. You will need one (or more) of the items listed below: Table 3-19. Equipment List, ScreenPRO-II Controller System Qty. Item Note 1 ScreenPRO-II Controller chassis Required 1-4 ScreenPRO-II Required, quantity based on production and screen requirements 1-4 Video projector Required, quantity based on single or widescreen requirements 1-4 Analog monitor(s) Preview, quantity based on single or widescreen requirements 1-4 Analog or digital monitor(s) Program, quantity based on single or widescreen requirements 1 Ethernet hub or switch Customer supplied TBD Ethernet cables Customer supplied TBD Video cables Customer supplied (Genlock, Genlock Loop, Widescreen Lock) 1 Analog router Required for systems configured for external routing 1 Digital router Required for systems configured for external routing 1 BlendPRO-II Required for systems configured for widescreen blends TBD Discreet analog sources Required for systems configured for internal routing TBD Discreet digital sources Required for systems configured for internal routing TBD PC(s), Mac(s) Required for BG and DSK DVI sources, and discreet RGB sources TBD DA(s) Required for signal distribution, when internal routing utilized Use the following steps to install ScreenPRO-II Controller: 1. Follow the unpacking procedures as listed in the “Unpacking and Inspection” section on page 54. 2. As required, refer to the “Physical and Electrical Specifications” section on page 258 in Appendix A for electrical and mechanical details. 3. As required, refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Controller Rear Panel” section on page 32 in Chapter 2 for the locations of all connectors. 4. If you are rack mounting peripheral equipment such as the BlendPRO-II and MatrixPRO routers, follow the rack mount procedures as outlined in each individual User’s Guide. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 73 3. Hardware Installation System Installation 5. As required, ensure that your system interconnection charts are handy. Refer to the “Connection Charts” section on page 56 for details on completing the charts. 6. Ethernet Connections — a completely “local” network connection is recommended, without IP connections to the outside world. 7. a. Using an Ethernet cable, connect the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s Ethernet port to a Hub or Switch. b. Connect all ScreenPRO-II units to the Ethernet Hub or Switch. c. If your system uses BlendPRO-II, connect the BlendPRO-II chassis to the Ethernet Hub or Switch. d. Connect all routers (such as MatrixPRO) to the Ethernet Hub or Switch. Serial Connections — the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s serial port is configured as DCE, 115K baud, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, no parity bits. e. For a single serial controlled router, use an RS-232 cable to connect the router to the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s EXT COMM port. f. To connect two (or more) serial routers, a third-party Ethernet-to-Serial converter box is required, such as the Lantronix model UDS200 Device Server (http://www.lantronix.com/pdf/UDS200_PB.pdf). Each Lantronix UDS200 can control two serial routers. • Using RS-232 cables, connect each router to the UDS200. • Set up a static IP address on the Lantronix device itself. The recommended range is 192.168.0.200 - 192.168.0.239 — such as not to conflict with other devices. Refer to the Lantronix UDS200 User’s Guide for instructions. • Using an Ethernet cable, connect the UDS200 to the same LAN that includes the ScreenPRO-II Controller. Note 8. 74 The ScreenPRO-II Controller supports Lantronix models UDS100 and UDS200. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Lantronix Setup Menu” section on page 131 for addition information about Lantronix setup. Source Connections a. If you are using external routing: • Ensure that all sources are properly connected to your analog and digital routers. • Connect analog router outputs to analog inputs 1 and 2 on each ScreenPRO-II. These are the default analog router inputs. • Connect digital router outputs to SDI inputs 1 and 2 on each ScreenPRO-II. b. If you are using internal routing: • As required, connect discreet analog source outputs to the desired analog inputs on each ScreenPRO-II. • As required, connect discreet digital source outputs to the desired digital inputs on each ScreenPRO-II. • If analog DAs are utilized (recommended), connect analog source outputs to DA inputs, and DA outputs to the desired analog inputs on each ScreenPRO-II. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation System Installation • 9. If digital DAs are utilized (recommended), connect digital source outputs to DA inputs, and DA outputs to the desired digital inputs on each ScreenPRO-II. c. For widescreen backgrounds and DSK sources, connect your computers’ DVI outputs (typically from multi-head graphics cards) to the BG/DSK in A and BG/DSK in B inputs on each ScreenPRO-II. d. For single screen backgrounds and DSK sources, connect your computers’ DVI outputs (typically from DAs or splitters) to the BG/DSK in A and BG/DSK in B inputs on each ScreenPRO-II. Output Connections a. One Analog Preview Output is provided on each ScreenPRO-II. Connect this output to the input of each analog Preview Monitor, as required per your configuration. b. Three Program Outputs are provided on each ScreenPRO-II: one digital and two analog. For each chassis (for single screen applications), use these outputs to connect your Program Monitor(s) and your projector(s). For example: S Connect the Digital Program Output to the input of your projector. S Connect Analog Program Output 1 to the input of your main program monitor. S Connect Analog Program Output 2 to an auxiliary or spare program monitor. 10. BlendPRO-II Input/Output Connections — for widescreen applications, BlendPRO-II requires the following connections: a. Connect the Digital Program Output on each ScreenPRO-II to the desired DVI Input (1 - 4) on BlendPRO-II. b. Per your system configuration, connect DVI Outputs (1 - 4) on BlendPRO-II to the DVI inputs on your projectors, or connect Analog Outputs (1 - 4) on BlendPRO-II to the analog inputs on your projectors. 11. Genlock Connections For single screen applications, genlock connections are optional: a. If you will be using synchronous camera sources in your production, use a BNC cable to connect a PAL or NTSC black burst (or a composite sync) signal to the Genlock In connector on each ScreenPRO-II. b. If desired, you can loop reference video from one ScreenPRO-II chassis to another by connecting a BNC cable from the Genlock Loop connector to the next ScreenPRO-II’s Genlock In connector (or to other video devices in the chain). c. If a particular ScreenPRO-II is the last device in a reference video chain, do not make any connections to the Genlock Loop connector. Refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination” section on page 76 for details. Important ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide For wide screen applications that use BlendPRO-II, specific “Widescreen Lock” connections are mandatory. Refer to the “BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections” section on page 77 for instructions. 75 3. Hardware Installation System Installation 12. Power Connection a. Connect an AC power cord to the AC Power Connector on the rear of each ScreenPRO-II chassis, and then to AC outlets. b. Connect an AC power cord to the AC Power Connector on the rear of the ScreenPRO-II Controller chassis, and then to an AC outlet. c. Per your system configuration, connect AC Power cords to MatrixPRO routers and BlendPRO-II, and then to AC outlets. d. Connect AC Power cords (or AC adapters) to all peripheral equipment, such as Ethernet Hubs and monitors. Please note: ~ ~ Connect each unit only to a properly rated supply circuit. Reliable grounding of rack-mounted equipment should be maintained. 13. Tally Connection — If you are using the optional Tally board, connect tally “relay closure” lines from the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s Tally connector to the desired external devices (such as cameras). Eight tally circuits are provided. In Appendix A, refer to the “Tally Connector” section on page 262 for pinout details 14. Power On — turn on power to all units. 15. System ID — required for use with the ScreenPRO-II Controller. On each ScreenPRO-II chassis: a. Access the Remote Control Menu by pressing {REMOTE CONTROL} on the Home Menu. This menu enables you to set the ID of the ScreenPRO-II chassis. b. Set the ScreenPRO-II chassis ID to a unique value that is not used by another chassis. The system will not function if duplicate IDs are in use. Note The ScreenPRO-II Controller will detect duplicate IDs and prompt the user to correct the problem. Only the first device will connect to the console. Other devices with conflicting IDs will be refused a connection. 16. Display Calibration — calibrate the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s Touch Screen display using the Display Settings Menu. From the Home Menu, press {DISPLAY} > {LCD CAL}, and following the prompts to calibrate the display. If you are using BlendPRO-II, please review the “Overview of Edge-Blending Technology” section on page 79. pÅêÉÉåmolJff=dÉåäçÅâ=qÉêãáå~íáçå On the rear of each ScreenPRO-II chassis, one recessed Termination Switch is provided for genlock termination (adjacent to the Genlock Loop connector). • Terminated — when the switch is pushed in, the connection is terminated (75 Ohms). • Un-terminated — when the switch is out, the connection is un-terminated. If a particular ScreenPRO-II chassis is the last device in a reference video chain, ensure that the Termination Switch is pushed in. If a particular ScreenPRO-II chassis is in the middle of a reference chain, ensure that the Termination Switch is out. 76 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections _äÉåÇmolJff=táÇÉëÅêÉÉå=içÅâ=`çååÉÅíáçåë The figure below illustrates the required Widescreen Lock and Genlock connections for any ScreenPRO-II Controller system that uses BlendPRO-II. Use this figure for reference during the signal installation process. If required, refer to the “BlendPRO-II User’s Guide” and the “ScreenPRO-II User’s Guide” for details on specific rear panel connectors. GENLOCK IN IN LOOP WIDESCREEN LOCK OUT Termination BlendPRO-II GENLOCK ScreenPRO-II ID #1 Widescreen Lock In Loop Genlock In (Optional) Un-terminated ScreenPRO-II ID #2 In Loop Un-terminated ScreenPRO-II ID #3 In Loop Un-terminated ScreenPRO-II ID #4 In Terminated Figure 3-3. Required Widescreen Lock Connections (sample) For all widescreen systems that utilize BlendPRO-II, use the following steps to connect “Widescreen Lock” and “Genlock” signals. 1. 2. External Genlock connections to BlendPRO-II are optional. a. If desired (particularly if you will be using synchronous cameras), use a BNC cable to connect a PAL or NTSC black burst (or a composite sync) signal to the GENLOCK IN connector on BlendPRO-II. b. Do not connect an external Genlock signal to any ScreenPRO-II unit in your system. Widescreen Lock connections are mandatory: a. Connect a BNC cable from BlendPRO-II’s WIDESCREEN LOCK output to the GENLOCK IN connector on the ScreenPRO-II unit with the lowest numbered ID. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 77 3. Hardware Installation BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections 78 b. Connect the first ScreenPRO-II’s GENLOCK LOOP connector to the GENLOCK IN connector on the ScreenPRO-II unit with the next highest numbered ID. c. (If your system includes three ScreenPRO-IIs) — Connect the second ScreenPRO-II’s GENLOCK LOOP connector to the GENLOCK IN connector on the ScreenPRO-II with the next highest numbered ID. d. (If your system includes four ScreenPRO-IIs) — Connect the third ScreenPRO-II’s GENLOCK LOOP connector to the GENLOCK IN connector on the ScreenPRO-II unit with the highest numbered ID. e. Set the Termination Switch for all ScreenPRO-IIs in your system: • For all ScreenPRO-IIs except the last one in the chain, ensure that the ScreenPRO-II is un-terminated (HI-Z). Refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination” section on page 76 for details. • On the last unit in the chain (only), ensure that the ScreenPRO-II is terminated (75-OHM). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Overview of Edge-Blending Technology lîÉêîáÉï=çÑ=bÇÖÉJ_äÉåÇáåÖ=qÉÅÜåçäçÖó The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • • • Introduction to Edge Blending Content Creation Video Processing Projector Setup and System Adjustments Left Justified Configurations Center Justified Configurations fåíêçÇìÅíáçå=íç=bÇÖÉ=_äÉåÇáåÖ Edge-blending technology is becoming increasingly popular for supporting very large highresolution displays. The technology is very flexible and supports a wide range of screen configurations. A typical three projector system is illustrated below. As shown, multiple projectors are used to project on a common surface in order to create one high-resolution image. The creation of a seamless image requires careful attention to detail. High quality results depend upon a system-level approach that integrates content creation, video processing, projector setup and system adjustments as described below. Adjustable Image Overlap Projector #1 Output Projector #2 Output Projector #3 Output Figure 3-4. Typical three projector system `çåíÉåí=`êÉ~íáçå= When projecting an image across a large screen, it is important to maintain sufficient resolution to obtain a crisp, clear image from the perspective of the viewer. Generally, highresolution source material is used to maintain content that is pleasing to the eye. There are two methods that are commonly used to generate wide-screen source material, each of these methods is explained below. • Use of a Single High Definition Image High Definition source material has a resolution of 1920 pixels x 1080 lines. Images of this type can be reformatted to drive multiple screens. The reformatting ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 79 3. Hardware Installation Overview of Edge-Blending Technology is usually performed by a seamless switching system such as the Encore Video Processor, or BlendPRO-II. Reformatting allows the resultant images to provide seamless switching, integration of picture-in-picture (PIP) video and keying features. Note that the input image can be effectively spread to cover multiple screens, however, the inherent resolution of the output image remains that of the source material, 1920x1080 pixels. 1920 HDTV Image 1920 x 1080 _äÉåÇmolJff 1080 1280 Image for Projector 1 1280 x 1024 _äÉåÇmo 1024 1280 Image for Projector 2 1280 x 1024 ÇmolJff 1024 1920 _äÉåÇmolJff 1024 1 2 Figure 3-5. HD Source Material Formatting • Use Of Multi-Head Graphics Boards Standard multi-head graphics boards can be used to directly generate image data to drive multiple screens. In this case, the computer generates one very highresolution image and the image is output by multiple graphics heads. The inherent resolution of the output image is limited only by the processing power of the multi-head graphics board. Image resolutions with up to 10,000 pixels of horizontal resolution can be achieved with current technology. 80 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Overview of Edge-Blending Technology sáÇÉç=mêçÅÉëëáåÖ The purpose of the edge-blending process is to provide a smooth transition for the eye over the blending region. To provide a smooth transition, identical image data from two (or more) different projectors must be superimposed, and the output from each projector must be edge feathered to provide seamless optical mixing of the two source images. There are two video processing functions that are required specifically to support widescreen edge blended displays: Image Overlap and Edge Feathering. • Image Overlap Source images consist of a single HD image that has been split into multiple channels, or a series of images from a multi-head graphics card. In either case, the source images must be re-formatted to provide image overlap to support the edge-blending process. The Image Overlap processing is illustrated below. The width of the blending region determines the amount of required image overlap and this must be programmable to support different applications. 1280 Original Image from Multi-head Graphics Card 1024 Image for Projector 1 1280 _äÉåÇmolJff Unused Source Material _äÉåÇmo Image Overlap Region ÇmolJff Image for Projector 2 _äÉåÇmolJff 1 2 Figure 3-6. Image Overlap and Data Doubling ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 81 3. Hardware Installation Overview of Edge-Blending Technology • Edge Feathering The overlapping image data in the blend region must be edge-feathered to support a seamless optical blend. The transfer function must be programmable to support blend regions of different widths and adjust to different video characteristics. A typical blend function is illustrated below. Blend Region Image Intensity for Image 1 Image Intensity for Image 2 Figure 3-7. Typical Blend Function mêçàÉÅíçê=pÉíìé=~åÇ=póëíÉã=^ÇàìëíãÉåíë Accurate projector setup is essential for creating seamless images. Please note the following important guidelines: 82 • • The projectors must be precisely aligned to overlap the adjacent blending regions. • Custom test patterns and an alignment procedure are used to simplify this process and provide an optimal result. • Mixing and matching projectors is not recommended as it makes the adjustment process much more difficult. The brightness, contrast and color balance of the projectors must be adjusted to provide a uniform appearance across the entire screen. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 3. Hardware Installation Overview of Edge-Blending Technology iÉÑí=gìëíáÑáÉÇ=`çåÑáÖìê~íáçåë Left justification means that the first pixels of the projected image begin immediately at the left, and that unused source material is removed from the far right of the image. A twoprojector sample is illustrated below. Projector 2 Image Projector 1 Image _äÉåÇmolJff Image Overlap Region Unused Source Material Figure 3-8. Left Justification `ÉåíÉê=gìëíáÑáÉÇ=`çåÑáÖìê~íáçåë Center justification means that the projected image is properly centered within the available number of pixels, and that unused source material is removed from the far left and far right of the image. A two-projector sample is illustrated below. Projector 2 Image Projector 1 Image _äÉåÇmolJff Unused Source Material Image Overlap Region Unused Source Material Figure 3-9. Center Justification This completes the hardware installation chapter. Please continue with Chapter 4, “Menu Orientation.” ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 83 3. Hardware Installation Overview of Edge-Blending Technology 84 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide QK==jÉåì=lêáÉåí~íáçå få=qÜáë=`Ü~éíÉê This chapter describes all ScreenPRO-II Controller menus, including how they are accessed, the functions that are available, and descriptions of each menu tree (in block diagram format). Note In this chapter, softkey labels on the menus are shown in bold upper and lowercase letters between brackets. S Press {BORDR} to … The following topics are discussed: • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Global Rules Home Menu Input Menu Output Menu System Menu Miscellaneous Menu Frame Grab Menu Effects Menu Status Menu PIP Adjustment Menu Key Menu Clone Setup Menu Crop Menu Source Adjustment Menus Background Input Setup Menu DSK Menus LOGO Menu Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Once you have reviewed all of the sections in this chapter, please continue with Chapter 5, “System Setup” on page 183. 85 4. Menu Orientation Global Rules däçÄ~ä=oìäÉë The following global rules apply to all menus: • Brackets — parameters and values displayed between brackets (e.g., [525]) cannot be changed. • ID “All” — For widescreen destinations, when the value “All” is shown for the ID parameter, it represents the lowest numbered ID in the destination, as configured (typically, number 1). • Exclamation Points — For widescreen destinations, if an exclamation point ( ! ) appears after a value (e.g., Contrast 100!), one (or more) of the destinations is not set to 100. • “All” Adjustments — For widescreen destinations, if a parameter is adjusted on a menu displaying an “All” ID condition, all values for all ScreenPRO-II’s in the destination will snap to the new value. To adjust an individual ScreenPRO-II’s values within the widescreen configuration, highlight the ID line, use the ADJ knob to select a specific destination, and then adjust a parameter in the normal manner. • • Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. Press {BACK} to return to the menu from which you accessed the current menu. Note 86 The {HOME} and {BACK} buttons will not be explained again in this chapter. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Home Menu eçãÉ=jÉåì The figure below illustrates the Home Menu: ScreenPRO II CONTROLLER INPUT OUTPUT SYSTEM MISC FRAME GRAB EFFECTS STATUS SAVE Figure 4-1. Home Menu The Home Menu is the system’s top level menu. To access a menu, press the desired button on the Touch Screen. You can also return to the Home Menu by pressing the {HOME} softkey at the top left of the Touch Screen (on most menus). The following menus can be accessed from the Home Menu: • Press INPUT to access the Input Menu. Refer to the “Input Menu” section on page 88 for details. • Press OUTPUT to access the Output Menu. Refer to the “Output Menu” section on page 100 for details. • Press SYSTEM to access the System Menu. Refer to the “System Menu” section on page 108 for details. • Press MISC to access the Miscellaneous Menu. Refer to the “Miscellaneous Menu” section on page 133 for details. • Press FRAME GRAB to access the Frame Grab Menu. Refer to the “Frame Grab Menu” section on page 142 for details. • Press EFFECTS to access the Effects Menu. Refer to the “Effects Menu” section on page 146 for details. • Press STATUS to access the Status Menu. Refer to the “Status Menu” section on page 147 for details. • Press SAVE to save the system configuration in non-volatile memory. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 87 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu fåéìí=jÉåì The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • Input Menu Tree Input Menu Description Input Menu Functions Input Sub Menus fåéìí=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the Input Menu Tree: HOME MENU INPUT INPUT MENU CFG AR Input Configuration Menu Aspect Ratio Menu COLOR BALANCE SIZING Destination ID Layer Input Connector 1:1 Sizing Menu Oversample Sizing Menu RGB Color Balance Menu Color Balance Menu Format Input Type File Number Mode ID ID ID ID Color Space File Name Ratio Layer Layer Layer Layer Sampling Mode Delete Applies Clock Phase Right Edge Red Contrast Saturation H Total Left Edge Red Brightness H Active Top Edge Grn Contrast SAVE Contrast SAVE Brightness Gamma H Position DELETE Input Sync Type Bottom Edge V Total Pulldown Compensation V Active Sync Slice V Position Sharpness Grn Brightness Hue RESET ALL Blue Contrast SAVE FORCE ACQUIRE Blue Brightness SAVE RESET ALL SAVE SAVE HOME FORCE ACQUIRE SAVE APPLY FORMAT FORCE ACQUIRE Figure 4-2. Input Menu Tree All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. 88 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu fåéìí=jÉåì=aÉëÅêáéíáçå The figure below illustrates the Input Menu: INPUT MENU H O M E SRC_1 Destination 1 ID 1 Layer C F G A R S A V E [A] Input Connector Format HD-15 1024 x 768 @ 60 Input Type [ RGB ] Color Space [ RGB ] Sampling Mode 1:1 Contrast < % > 100.0 APPLY FORMAT N A V SIZING COLOR BALANCE A D J FORCE ACQUIRE Figure 4-3. Input Menu (sample) The Input Menu is used to adjust all parameters relating to dedicated and routed inputs, including the physical sources connected to individual ScreenPRO-II units. The menu enables you to set all configuration options for the selected input. To access the menu: • • • Press a blue layer button in the Layer Control Section (the button blinks). Select an input on the Source Selection Bus (the button blinks). Press INPUT on the Home Menu. Note The menu cannot be accessed without a selected layer. An error message will be shown. The currently selected input appears in the menu’s upper right corner. The menu tracks the selected input, thus, if you switch inputs on the Source Selection Bus, the menu is immediately re-assigned to the new input. Important ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide From a conceptual standpoint, there are no “direct” connections to a ScreenPRO-II scaler. All connections, whether they are from a single source or an external router, connect to the internal router matrix of each ScreenPRO-II. 89 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu fåéìí=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë The following Input Menu functions are provided: • Destination — indicates the destination on which you are currently working (as selected on the Destination Bus). • ID — indicates the ID of the associated ScreenPRO-II. Note • The ID line only appears when a widescreen destination is selected. ~ If “All” is shown in a widescreen configuration, menu values represent those of the lowest numbered ID in the destination. When a parameter is adjusted, all values for all ScreenPRO-II’s in the destination will snap to the new value. ~ If an individual ID is shown (e.g., 2), it represents that ScreenPRO-II alone, and adjustments will only affect that unit. Layer — for widescreen destinations, indicates the layer on which you are adjusting the selected input. Important • Input Connector — selects the physical connector to which the input is connected on the ScreenPRO-II, either HD-15 or BNC. Note • In a widescreen configuration, because the electronics on individual ScreenPRO-II scalers may not match from unit to unit, you may be required to adjust ScreenPRO-II scalers and layers individually — by first selecting a specific destination ID, followed by a specific layer. The choice of available formats varies depending on the selected connector. For example, when BNC is selected, only Standard Definition and High Definition resolutions can be selected. Format — this line performs two functions: ~ Displays the resolution that is automatically determined by the FORCE ACQUIRE function. ~ Enables you to set the resolution of the incoming source if desired. Once the format is selected manually, press {APPLY FORMAT} to accept the selection. In Appendix A, refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions” section on page 263 for details on all available resolutions. Note 90 Selecting a format manually automatically defaults the Input Type and Color Space. In some cases, the Input Type and Color Space cannot be changed due to the selected resolution. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu • Input Type — sets the type of input connected to the ScreenPRO-II. Available choices change depending on the selected Format, and the choice affects the Color Space selection. Input types include: ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ RGB YPbPr Composite/S-Vid HD SDI SDI • Color Space — sets the input’s color space, either SMPTE or RGB. The system automatically sets the Color Space based on the selected Format and/or Input Connector and Input Type — but in some cases, color space can be changed. • Sampling Mode — sets the sampling mode for the selected input. • • • • ~ When 1:1 Sampling is selected, the system provides pixel-for-pixel sampling, and generally better image quality. ~ When Oversample is selected, the system performs multiple samples for every pixel, with a resulting “softer” image. Contrast — sets the input’s contrast. Adjustment range: 75% to 125%. Brightness — sets the input’s brightness. Adjustment range: 75% to 125%. Gamma — sets the input gamma, enabling you to match the gamma of the source. Adjustment range: 1.0 to 3.0. Input Sync Type — sets the type of sync used by the selected source. Choices include: ~ ~ ~ ~ H/V CSync (composite sync) SOG (sync on green) Auto • Pulldown Compensation — (On/Off) This function is applicable only for standard video (component, s-video, composite) inputs. The default mode is off. The feature should be turned on to process video derived from film material. • Sync Slice <mv> — This function selects the sync comparator threshold for RGsB (RGB with Sync on Green) or YPbPr analog component video sources. The value ranges from 20mV to 280mV and is adjustable in steps of 10mV. The default value is 160mV. When the ScreenPRO-II Controller detects Macrovision® copy protection on the incoming YPbPr NTSC/PAL video, the Sync Slice value is repositioned to 60mV to account for the reduced amplitude sync pulse. Note • The default Sync Slice level has been optimized for virtually all sources that will be encountered and should rarely, if ever, require adjustment. However, you can adjust the level to improve sync detection and synchronization in cases of extremely noisy RGsB or YPbPr video signals. Sharpness — sets the input’s sharpness. Adjustment range: -10 (very smooth) to 10 (very sharp). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 91 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu • Press {CFG} to display the Input Configuration Menu. Refer to the “Input Configuration Menu” section on page 93 for details. • Press {AR} to display the Aspect Ratio Menu. Refer to the “Aspect Ratio Menu” section on page 94 for details. • Press {SAVE} to save the selected input in the designated input file, using all current information on the Input Menu. Using an automatic “copy down” function, the saved file will also be transferred to all active destinations. Note Every sub menu under the Input Menu includes a {SAVE} button. This enables you to save the input at any point in the adjustment process, regardless of your location within the menu tree. • Press {APPLY FORMAT} to apply a manually selected input format. In Appendix A, refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions“section on page 263 for details on all available resolutions. • Press {SIZING} to display the Sizing Menu. Refer to the “Sizing Menu” section on page 95 for details. • Press {COLOR BALANCE} to display the Color Balance Menu. Refer to the “Color Balance Menu” section on page 98 for details. • Press {FORCE ACQUIRE} to force the system to perform the optimum image setup. Use this feature as a good starting point for setup. Note FORCE ACQUIRE only works on the selected input connector. Be sure to select the correct connector type before issuing the FORCE ACQUIRE command. fåéìí=pìÄ=jÉåìë The following sub menus can be accessed from the Input Menu: • • • • 92 Input Configuration Menu Aspect Ratio Menu Sizing Menu Color Balance Menu ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu fåéìí=`çåÑáÖìê~íáçå=jÉåì From the Input Menu, press {CFG} to display the Input Configuration Menu. INPUT CONFIGURATION B A C K File Number SRC_1 1 File Name IFILE_001 Delete Applies To: N A V Dest 1 A D J SAVE DELETE Figure 4-4. Input Configuration Menu (sample) Each input has an associated file that stores all input parameters and settings. Each time an input is selected on the Source Selection Bus, its associated file is recalled the instant before it appears on Preview. The Input Configuration Menu enables you to save or delete the input’s associated file — which guarantees that the exact parameters you set are those that are used on air. The following functions are provided: • File Number — sets the file number into which data is stored. In the current version, the file number defaults to the input number and cannot be changed. • File Name — sets the alphanumeric file name. In the current version, the file name automatically defaults to the input name and cannot be changed. • Delete Applies To — because inputs may be set up differently depending upon the destination, this parameter enables you to identify the destination from which you want to delete the associated file. • • Press {SAVE} to save the selected input in the designated input file. Press {DELETE} to delete the selected input file from the designated destination. Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide If multiple destinations are selected (for example, when you are using two single-screen configurations), pressing {SAVE} copies input parameters to both destinations, eliminating the need to configure and save each input twice. 93 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu ^ëéÉÅí=o~íáç=jÉåì From the Input Menu, press {ASPECT RATIO} to display the Aspect Ratio Menu. ASPECT RATIO B A C K SRC_1 Mode Custom Ratio 1.279 N A V A D J S A V E Figure 4-5. Aspect Ratio Menu (sample) The Aspect Ratio Menu enables you to change the input’s aspect ratio to pre-defined configurations, or enter a “custom” configuration if desired. • • 94 Mode — select 16:9, 5:4, 4:3, 3:2, 1:1 or Custom aspect ratios. Ratio — when Custom is selected, use the knob to enter a custom aspect ratio. The field is hidden when pre-defined ratios are selected. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu páòáåÖ=jÉåì From the Input Menu, press {SIZING} to display one of two “context sensitive” Sizing Menus — they change depending on the selected Sampling Mode. • • If 1:1 Sampling is selected, the 1:1 Sizing Menu appears. If Oversample is selected, the Oversample Sizing Menu appears. Each menu and function is described below. NWN=páòáåÖ=jÉåì The figure below illustrates the 1:1 Sizing Menu. All functions apply to the selected source. 1:1 SIZING B A C K SRC_1 ID ALL Layer [A] Clock Phase 0 [ 858 ] H Total S A V E N A V H Active 720 H Position 123 V Total [0] V Active 486 36 V Position A D J FORCE ACQUIRE Figure 4-6. 1:1 Sizing Menu (sample) With 1:1 Sampling enabled, the following timing parameters allow you to adjust the image to properly fit the layer’s blinking raster box. • ID — indicates the ID of the associated ScreenPRO-II. Note The ID line only appears when a widescreen destination is selected. ~ If “All” is shown in a widescreen configuration, menu values represent those of the lowest numbered ID in the destination. When a parameter is adjusted, all values for all ScreenPRO-II’s in the destination will snap to the new value. ~ If an individual ID is shown (e.g., 2), it represents that ScreenPRO-II alone, and adjustments will only affect that unit. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 95 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu • Layer — for widescreen destinations, indicates the layer on which you are adjusting the selected input. Important • Clock Phase — sets the system’s A/D converter, allowing you to select where pixels are sampled (ideally, on the pixel’s peak). Adjustment range: -16 to 15. For optimum visual results when adjusting high-resolution sources, project a burst test pattern and adjust the sampling for minimum noise. Refer to the “Test Pattern Menu” section on page 105 for information on test patterns. • H Total — for the selected source, sets the total pixel count per line. Note • • • • • • • This field is not adjustable for digital sources, including digital signals on the DVI and BNC input connectors. This field is not adjustable for NTSC and PAL sources, regardless of connection type. H Active — sets the width of the active area. H Position — sets the start of the active area’s horizontal offset from H sync. V Total — fixed value which cannot be adjusted. V Active — sets the number of vertical lines in the image. V Position — sets the start of the active area’s vertical offset from V sync. Press {SAVE} to save the selected input in the designated input file. Press {FORCE ACQUIRE} to force the ScreenPRO-II Controller to perform the optimum image setup. Note 96 In a widescreen configuration, because the electronics on individual ScreenPRO-II scalers may not match from unit to unit, you may be required to adjust ScreenPRO-II scalers and layers individually — by first selecting a specific destination ID, followed by a specific layer. If you switch to another input and there is no valid input video, the settings are not applicable and N/A is displayed. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu lîÉêë~ãéäÉ=páòáåÖ=jÉåì The figure below illustrates the Oversample Sizing Menu. All functions apply to the selected source. OVERSAMPLE SIZING B A C K SRC_1 ID ALL Layer [A] Right Edge 1320 Left Edge 296 Top Edge 35 N A V 803 Bottom Edge A D J S A V E FORCE ACQUIRE Figure 4-7. Oversample Sizing Menu (sample) With Oversample enabled, the following timing parameters allow you to adjust the image to properly fit the layer’s blinking raster box. • ID — indicates the ID of the associated ScreenPRO-II. Note • The ID line only appears when a widescreen destination is selected. ~ If “All” is shown in a widescreen configuration, menu values represent those of the lowest numbered ID in the destination. When a parameter is adjusted, all values for all ScreenPRO-II’s in the destination will snap to the new value. ~ If an individual ID is shown (e.g., 2), it represents that ScreenPRO-II alone, and adjustments will only affect that unit. Layer — for widescreen destinations, indicates the layer on which you are adjusting the selected input. Important In a widescreen configuration, because the electronics on individual ScreenPRO-II scalers may not match from unit to unit, you may be required to adjust ScreenPRO-II scalers and layers individually — by first selecting a specific destination ID, followed by a specific layer. • Select and adjust Right Edge, Left Edge, Top Edge or Bottom Edge as required, to fit the image precisely in the layer’s blinking raster box. • Press {SAVE} to save the selected input in the designated input file. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 97 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu • Press {FORCE ACQUIRE} to force the system to perform the optimum image setup. After the Force Acquire function is performed, the system remains on the Oversample Sizing Menu. Note If you switch to another input and there is no valid input video, the settings are not applicable and N/A is displayed. `çäçê=_~ä~åÅÉ=jÉåì From the Input Menu, press {COLOR BALANCE} to display the Color Balance Menu. COLOR BALANCE B A C K SRC_1 ID ALL Layer [A] Saturation < % > 100 Hue N A V 0 A D J S A V E RESET ALL Figure 4-8. Color Balance Menu (sample — for Composite, S-Video or YPbPr sources) RGB COLOR BALANCE B A C K S A V E SRC_1 ID ALL Layer [A] Red Contrast < % > 0.0 Red Brightness < % > 0.0 Grn Contrast < % > 0.0 Grn Brightness < % > 0.0 Blue Contrast < % > 0.0 Blue Brightness < % > 0.0 N A V A D J RESET ALL Figure 4-9. Color Balance Menu (sample — for RGB sources) 98 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Input Menu The Color Balance Menu changes depending on the selected Input Type. • ID — indicates the ID of the associated ScreenPRO-II. Note • The ID line only appears when a widescreen destination is selected. ~ If “All” is shown in a widescreen configuration, menu values represent those of the lowest numbered ID in the destination. When a parameter is adjusted, all values for all ScreenPRO-II’s in the destination will snap to the new value. ~ If an individual ID is shown (e.g., 2), it represents that ScreenPRO-II alone, and adjustments will only affect that unit. Layer — for widescreen destinations, indicates the layer on which you are adjusting the selected input. Important • When RGB sources are selected, the Color Balance Menu provides individual RGB contrast and brightness adjustments. Adjustment range: -25% to +25%. ~ ~ ~ • • • In a widescreen configuration, because the electronics on individual ScreenPRO-II scalers may not match from unit to unit, you may be required to adjust ScreenPRO-II scalers and layers individually — by first selecting a specific destination ID, followed by a specific layer. Adjust Red Contrast and Brightness as required. Adjust Green Contrast and Brightness as required. Adjust Blue Contrast and Brightness as required. When Composite, S-Video or YPbPr is selected, adjust Saturation and Hue: ~ ~ Adjust Saturation as required. Adjustment range: 75% to 125%. Note When the Input Type is YPbPr, the Hue field reads N/A because Hue does not apply to this type of source. Adjust Hue as required. Adjustment range (in degrees): -90.0 to 90.0. Press {SAVE} to save the selected input in the designated input file. Press {RESET ALL} to return all parameters to 0 (zero). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 99 4. Menu Orientation Output Menu lìíéìí=jÉåì The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • Output Menu Tree Output Menu Description Output Menu Functions Output Sub Menus lìíéìí=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the Output Menu Tree: HOME MENU OUTPUT OUTPUT MENU GLCK SETTINGS TEST PATTERN WIDE SCREEN Genlock Menu Settings Menu Test Pattern Menu Wide Screen Settings Menu Destination Format Color Space HOME APPLY FORMAT Source Output Monitor Output Monitor Total Projectors Type Sync Out Mode Total H Res Termination SOG Type Total V Res Gamma Raster Box Background Frmt Raster Box Size Alignment Pattern Marker Mode Overlap Width Alignment Pattern Data Doubling Justification Feather Mode Feather Gamma Figure 4-10. Output Menu Tree All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. 100 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Output Menu lìíéìí=jÉåì=aÉëÅêáéíáçå The figure below illustrates the Output Menu: OUTPUT MENU H O M E Destination Format 1 De 1024x768 @ 59.94 Color Space N A V [ RGB ] Press APPLY FORMAT to select the output resolution. DVI EDID format can be adjusted G L C K to match the output format in A D J the MISC > EDID menu. APPLY FORMAT SETTINGS TEST PATTERN WIDE SCREEN Figure 4-11. Output Menu (sample) The Output Menu enables you to configure ScreenPRO-II outputs, wide screen parameters and test patterns. To access the menu: • • Select a destination on the Destination Bus. Press OUTPUT on the Home Menu. The menu cannot be accessed unless a destination is selected. The currently selected destination is shown in the menu’s upper right corner. The menu tracks the destination, thus, if you switch destinations, the menu is immediately re-assigned. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 101 4. Menu Orientation Output Menu lìíéìí=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë The following Output Menu functions are provided: • Destination — indicates the destination on which you are currently working (as selected on the Destination Bus). Note • The selected destination can be configured as a single screen or multiple screens (in a wide screen application). In this situation, all changes to the Output Menu affect all ScreenPRO-II units in the wide screen definition. Format — sets the resolution and frame rate at which you want to drive the destination’s projector(s). To minimize synchronization problems, select a frame rate that is consistent with your input sources. S Example: If you are using 59.94 NTSC video inputs, run the output at the same rate in order to reduce jutter artifacts. After selecting a format, press {APPLY FORMAT} to accept the selection. In Appendix A, refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions” section on page 263 for details on all available resolutions. • Color Space — displays the output color space per the specifics of the selected output resolution and frame rate. • Press {GLCK} to display the Genlock Menu. Refer to the “Genlock Menu” section on page 103 for details. • Press {APPLY FORMAT} to accept a selected output format. In Appendix A, refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions” section on page 263 for details on all available resolutions. • Press {SETTINGS} to display the Settings Menu. Refer to the “Settings Menu” section on page 104 for details. • Press {TEST PATTERN} to display the Test Pattern Menu. Refer to the “Test Pattern Menu” section on page 105 for details. • Press {WIDE SCREEN} to display the Wide Screen Menu. Refer to the “Wide Screen Settings Menu” section on page 106 for details. Note This softkey only appears when a wide screen destination is selected. lìíéìí=pìÄ=jÉåìë The following sub menus can be accessed from the Output Menu: • • • • 102 Genlock Menu Settings Menu Test Pattern Menu Wide Screen Settings Menu ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Output Menu dÉåäçÅâ=jÉåì From the Output Menu, press {GLCK} to display the Genlock Menu. GENLOCK B A C K Source Black Burst Type [ V Lock ] Termination N A V [ 75 Ohm ] To change termination between 75 Ohm and Hi-Z, press the switch on the rear panel next to the Genlock Loop BNC. A D J Figure 4-12. Genlock Menu (sample) The Genlock Menu changes depending on the type of destination selected — widescreen or single screen. Please note: • For single screen destinations, the menu tells the ScreenPRO-II Controller which type of analog genlock signal is connected to each ScreenPRO-II’s Genlock BNC connector, and indicates the current setting of the selected ScreenPRO-II’s Termination Switch. • For widescreen destinations, the menu tells the ScreenPRO-II Controller which type of analog genlock signal is connected to BlendPRO-II’s Genlock connector. Remember that in this mode, each ScreenPRO-II’s Genlock In connector must be connected to BlendPRO-II’s Widescreen Lock output — and not to an external Genlock source. In Chapter 3, refer to the “BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections” section on page 77 for details. The following functions are provided: • Source — (applies to all types of destinations). This function sets the genlock source, either Black Burst, CSync or None. • Type — (applies to all types of destinations). Displays the type of genlock: ~ ~ ~ • When Source = None, Type = [Free-Run] When Source = Black Burst, Type = [V Lock] When Source = CSync, Type = [V Lock] Termination — (applies to single screen destinations only). This field indicates the current setting of the selected ScreenPRO-II’s Termination Switch. Please note: • If you elect to use external Genlock for single or widescreen configurations, PAL or NTSC black burst or composite sync signals are recommended. • In widescreen mode, you can optionally connect external Genlock to BlendPROII’s Genlock In connector — but not to the individual ScreenPRO-II units. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 103 4. Menu Orientation Output Menu • In widescreen configurations, BlendPRO-II is the master — whether or not you are using an external Genlock signal. • Genlock is recommended in configurations that utilize video camera sources. pÉííáåÖë=jÉåì From the Output Menu, press {SETTINGS} to display the Settings Menu. SETTINGS B A C K Output Monitor All -H-V Sync Out SOG Off Gamma 1.0 Raster Box Size N A V 1 A D J Figure 4-13. Settings Menu (sample) The Settings Menu enables you to set sync parameters for the monitors and projectors connected to the system — for the destination selected on the Output Menu. • Output Monitor — selects the device(s) that are affected by the sync settings. Choose between: ~ ~ ~ ~ Note 104 All — adjustments affect all program and preview monitors/projectors. Preview — adjustments affect preview monitors only. SPII Program — adjustments affect only the monitors/projectors connected to ScreenPRO-II program outputs. BPII Program — adjustments affect only the monitors/projectors connected to BlendPRO-II program outputs. Individual settings are maintained for each selection in the Output Monitor list. • • Sync Out — sets the sync value. Select +H+V, -H-V, +H-V, -H+V or CSync. • • Gamma — sets the output gamma for the selected destination. SOG — selects a specific “sync on green” signal. Choose between Off, Standard or Tri-Level (for certain HD devices). Raster Box Size — sets the size of the raster box that appears around PIPs and Keys. Range (in pixels): 0 to 8. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Output Menu qÉëí=m~ííÉêå=jÉåì From the Output Menu, press {TEST PATTERN} to display the Test Pattern Menu. TEST PATTERN B A C K Output Monitor All Mode ON Type Burst Raster Box On Alignment Test Pattern Off N A V A D J Figure 4-14. Test Pattern Menu (sample) The Test Pattern Menu enables you to display a variety of test patterns, for system and projector alignment — for the destination selected on the Output Menu. • Output Monitor — selects the monitor(s) and projector(s) that are affected by the test pattern settings. Choose between: ~ ~ ~ ~ • • • All — adjustments affect all program and preview monitors/projectors. Preview — adjustments affect preview monitors only. SPII Program — adjustments affect only the monitors/projectors connected to ScreenPRO-II program outputs. With this selection, test patterns will be data-doubled and edge-feathered. BPII Program — adjustments affect only the monitors/projectors connected to BlendPRO-II program outputs. With this selection, test patterns will not be data-doubled and edge-feathered. Mode — enables you to turn test patterns on or off. Type — sets the test pattern. Choose between Off, H Ramp, V Ramp, 100% Color Bars, 16x16 Grid, 32x32 Grid, Burst, 75% Color Bars, 50% Gray, Gray Steps 1, Gray Steps 2, White, Black, Red, Green and Blue. Raster Box — displays a raster box defined by the exact outer edges of the selected output resolution. For example, if the output is set to 1024 x 768, the raster box will encapsulate that exact format. Please note: ~ The Burst test pattern is the only pattern that is smaller than the selected output resolution. When the Raster Box is enabled, the Burst pattern will appear within its boundaries. ~ The Raster Box can be enabled when the test pattern is Off. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 105 4. Menu Orientation Output Menu • Alignment Test Pattern — for convenience, this function enables you to turn the alignment test pattern on or off from this menu (in addition to the Wide Screen Settings Menu). Note This field only appears when a wide screen destination is selected. táÇÉ=pÅêÉÉå=pÉííáåÖë=jÉåì From the Output Menu, press {WIDE SCREEN} to display the Wide Screen Settings Menu. WIDE SCREEN SETTINGS B A C K Total Projectors [2] Total H Res 2048 Total V Res [ 768 ] Background Format N A V Edge-Butted Marker Mode Off Overlap Width 0 Alignment Test Pattern Off Data Doubling Off Justification Center A D J Figure 4-15. Wide Screen Settings Menu (sample) The Wide Screen Settings Menu provides the tools required for wide screen setup and adjustment. Note that this menu can only be accessed when the destination selected in the Output Menu is designated as wide screen. Refer to the “Destination Setup Menu” section on page 117 for details. Important As an important prerequisite to widescreen setup (and to make widescreen setup easy), Barco offers the Configurator application to assist with wide screen setup. The software is available via download from the website, or you can contact Barco Technical Support for details. In Appendix B, refer to the “Contact Information” section on page 268 for information. The following functions are provided on the Wide Screen Settings Menu. • 106 Total Projectors — indicates the total number of ScreenPRO-II systems that have been assigned to the wide screen destination. This field is for information only, as derived from the Destination Setup Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Output Menu • Total H Res — sets the total number of horizontal pixels in the overall wide screen display. The formula is: # screens * horizontal output resolution (overlap width * (# screens - 1)) S Example: If two screens are used, each with an output resolution of 1024 x 768 and an overlap of 200 pixels, the Total H Res is: 2 * 1024 - (200 * 1) = 1848 As you adjust the Total H Res, the Overlap Width value tracks and the wide screen markers adjust accordingly. • Total V Res — displays the vertical resolution of the wide screen configuration. This field is fixed. • Background Format — selects the method by which your background graphics were originally produced: ~ Edge-butted — choose this option if your background graphics were produced with no pre-data doubling (e.g., typically from a multi-head graphics card). ~ Overlapped — choose this option if your backgrounds were produced using pre-data doubling (e.g., such as from a Dataton® system). • Marker Mode — enables and disables the system’s wide screen markers, to show the boundaries of active data. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Wide Screen Markers” section on page 218 for details. • Overlap Width — sets the overlap (in pixels) between projectors. As you adjust the width, the Total H Res value tracks and the wide screen markers adjust accordingly. • Alignment Test Pattern — enables or disables the test pattern used for performing projector lens shift and registration adjustments. • Data Doubling — enables or disables data doubling. Typically, the function is only disabled when unscaled background sources are pre-data doubled. In Chapter 3, refer to the “Overview of Edge-Blending Technology” section on page 79 for details. • Justification — sets the desired wide screen justification, either Center or Left. Once set, wide screen markers adjust accordingly. In the Feathering section: • • Mode — enables or disables edge feathering. Gamma — sets gamma for the feathered regions. Adjustment range: 1.0 to 5.0. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 107 4. Menu Orientation System Menu póëíÉã=jÉåì The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • System Menu Tree System Menu Description System Sub Menus póëíÉã=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the System Menu Tree: HOME MENU SYSTEM SYSTEM MENU RESET SW VER DIAG DEST SETUP System Reset Menu Software Version Menu Diagnostics Setup Menu Destination Setup Menu Modify Layers on PGM Tally Mode HOME Device Controller Ver Reset Option SP-II Ver Reset Type PP-II Ver BlendPRO-II Ver RESET DOWNLOAD CODE FORCE DOWNLOAD Reset Rotary Enc AUX SETUP Destination Type TALLY Diagnostic START LED TEST Diagnostic Routing Mode ROTARY ENCODER Diagnostic REMOVE SP to Add SP to Remove Aux Setup Menu (Standard) Source Mapping TBAR & JOYSTICK Diagnostic KEY DETECT Diagnostic Aux Setup Menu (ImagePRO, PrePRO-II) Source Mapping Router Name Unit ID Router Output Analog Rtr Name ADD Analog Rtr Out RESET Unit Analog Input SDI Rtr Name SDI Rtr Out Unit SDI Input DVI Rtr Name NETWORK SETUP INPUT PATCH DVI Rtr Out ROUTER SETUP Unit DVI Input RESET Network Setup Menu Input Source Patch Menu Router Specification Menu COMM SETUP OUTPUT PATCH Network DHCP Source Number Ctrlr IP Connection Type Name Port SP-II Input Manufacturer IP Range from Tally Number Router Type ADD PATCH # of Outputs IP Address Baud Rate Number Router Output Comm Type IP Port Number Data Bits Channel Device ID Parity Baud Rate SP Input IP Range to DELETE PATCH Number Ethernet Setup Menu RS-232 Setup Menu Lantronix Setup Menu Output Patch Menu # of Inputs DELETE ROUTER TEST COMM Stop Bits Data Bits Mixer Layer ADD NEW NEXT IP QUAD TEST COMM Parity SP Input Map To Stop Bits IP MAC Addr TEST COMM ADD PATCH DELETE PATCH Figure 4-16. System Menu Tree All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. 108 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu póëíÉã=jÉåì=aÉëÅêáéíáçå The figure below illustrates a sample System Menu: SYSTEM MENU H O M E Modify Layers On Program Off Tally Mode Off N A V R E S E T SW V E R A D J D I A G DEST SETUP NETWORK SETUP INPUT PATCH ROUTER SETUP Figure 4-17. System Menu (sample) To access the menu: • Press SYSTEM on the Home Menu. The System Menu provides the following functions: • Modify Layers On Program — when enabled, you can change PIPs and Keys directly on Program, without first setting up your “look” on Preview. When disabled, Preview must be used to set up the next look. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Still Frames” section on page 246 for details. • Tally Mode — enables or disables the tally function. When enabled, all eight tallies are activated, and can be triggered by pressing a source button. When disabled, all tallies are deactivated (but tally setups remain as configured). ~ Refer to the “Input Source Patch Menu” section on page 125 for details on assigning tallies to sources. ~ In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Tallies” section on page 253 for tally operating instructions. • Press {RESET} to display the System Reset Menu. Refer to the “System Reset Menu” section on page 111 for details. • Press {SW VER} to display the Software Version Menu. Refer to the “Software Version Menu” section on page 112 for details. • Press {DIAG} to display the Diagnostics Setup Menu. Refer to the “Diagnostics Setup Menu” section on page 113 for details. • Press {DEST SETUP} to display the Destination Setup Menu. Refer to the “Destination Setup Menu” section on page 117 for details. • Press {NETWORK SETUP} to display the Network Setup Menu. Refer to the “Network Setup Menu” section on page 124 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 109 4. Menu Orientation System Menu • Press {INPUT PATCH} to display the Input Source Patch Menu. Refer to the “Input Source Patch Menu” section on page 125 for details. • Press {ROUTER SETUP} to display the Router Specification Menu. Refer to the “Router Specification Menu” section on page 127 for details. póëíÉã=pìÄ=jÉåìë The following sub menus can be accessed from the System Menu: • • • • • • • 110 System Reset Menu Software Version Menu Diagnostics Setup Menu Destination Setup Menu Network Setup Menu Input Source Patch Menu Router Specification Menu ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu póëíÉã=oÉëÉí=jÉåì From the System Menu, press {RESET} to display the System Reset Menu: SYSTEM RESET B A C K Device ALL Reset Option All Detected SPs Reset Type N A V SOFT A D J RESET Figure 4-18. System Reset Menu (sample) The System Reset Menu enables you to perform various system reset functions. The following functions are provided: • Device — selects which device(s) to reset. Choose between ALL, CONTROLLER, SP, or BP. Note BP = BlendPRO-II SP = ScreenPRO-II • Reset Option — for the selected device(s), chooses the specific subset that you wish to reset. Choose between All Detected SPs or Active Dests. • Reset Type — selects the type of reset that you wish to perform. Choose between SOFT or FACTORY. Note that selecting SOFT will not delete any user defined configurations, while FACTORY deletes all user configurations. • Press {RESET} to perform the selected reset operation. When the confirmation screen appears: ~ Press {YES} to start the reset procedure. An “In Progress” message will be displayed. ~ Press {NO} to cancel the procedure. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 111 4. Menu Orientation System Menu pçÑíï~êÉ=sÉêëáçå=jÉåì From the System Menu, press {SW VER} to display the Software Version Menu. SOFTWARE VERSION B A C K Controller 1.00 BlendPRO-II 1.00 SP 1: 1.00 SP 2: 1.00 SP 3: 1.00 SP 4: 1.00 N A V ----------------------------------------All software versions match! DOWNLOAD CODE A D J FORCE DOWNLOAD Figure 4-19. Software Version Menu (sample) The Software Version Menu displays the software versions for the ScreenPRO-II Controller, all connected ScreenPRO-IIs, and BlendPRO-II. The following functions are provided: • • • Controller — displays the Controller’s software version. • In the lower portion of the menu, the system actively compares all software versions to that of the Controller: BlendPRO-II — displays BlendPRO-II’s software version. SP — these lines display each ScreenPRO-II’s software version. One line is shown for each active destination. ~ If all software versions match the Controller’s version, the display indicates “All Software version(s) match!” ~ If a mismatch is present, the display indicates “Software version mismatch!.” • Press {DOWNLOAD CODE} to begin the software download process, downloading code from the Controller to only those “mismatched” units. The entire process takes several minutes to complete. • Press {FORCE DOWNLOAD} to download code to all connected devices, typically for troubleshooting purposes, or to simply guarantee identical code in your entire system. This process also takes several minutes to complete. Note 112 The two “download” softkeys are always present on this menu, even when all code versions match. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu aá~ÖåçëíáÅë=pÉíìé=jÉåì From the System Menu, press {DIAG} to display the Diagnostics Setup Menu. DIAGNOSTICS SETUP B A C K Reset Rotary Encoders Yes T A L L Y N A V A D J START LED TEST ROTARY ENCODER TBAR & JOYSTICK KEY DETECT Figure 4-20. Diagnostics Setup Menu (sample) The Diagnostics Setup Menu enables you to perform a variety of diagnostic tests on the ScreenPRO-II Controller. The following functions are provided: • Reset Rotary Encoders — (Yes/No) determines whether or not you wish to reset the rotary encoder values when you exit the Rotary Encoder Menu. • Press {TALLY} to display the Tally Diagnostic Menu, and immediately start a test of all eight tally relays. This procedure takes several seconds to complete. Press {EXIT} when complete. • Press {START LED TEST} to begin testing all ScreenPRO-II Controller LEDs. This procedure takes several seconds to complete. Press {EXIT} when complete. • Press {ROTARY ENCODER} to display the Rotary Encoder Menu. Refer to the “Rotary Encoder Menu” section on page 114 for details. • Press {TBAR & JOYSTICK} to display the TBar & Joystick Menu. Refer to the “TBar & Joystick Menu” section on page 115 for details. • Press {KEY DETECT} to display the Key Detect Menu. Refer to the “Key Detect Menu” section on page 116 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 113 4. Menu Orientation System Menu oçí~êó=båÅçÇÉê=jÉåì From the Diagnostics Setup Menu, press {ROTARY ENCODER} to display the Rotary Encoder Menu. ROTARY ENCODER DIAGNOSTICS E X I T Rotary # RelCnt AbsCnt 1 0 0 2 0 0 Figure 4-21. Rotary Encoder Menu (sample) The Rotary Encoder Menu enables you to test the functionality of each rotary encoder, displaying both relative and absolute counts for each. • 114 Press {EXIT} to return to the Diagnostics Setup Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu q_~ê=C=gçóëíáÅâ=jÉåì From the Diagnostics Setup Menu, press {TBAR & JOYSTICK} to display the TBar & Joystick Menu. TBAR & JOYSTICK DIAGNOSTICS E X I T Joystick TBAR X= 0 Y= 0 Z= 0 0.0 % Figure 4-22. TBar & Joystick Menu (sample) The TBar & Joystick Menu enables you to test the functionality of the TBar and Joystick. • • • The TBAR range is 0 to 100%. The Joystick range is -100 to 100 on each axis (X, Y and Z). Press {EXIT} to return to the Diagnostics Setup Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 115 4. Menu Orientation System Menu hÉó=aÉíÉÅí=jÉåì From the Diagnostics Setup Menu, press {KEY DETECT} to display the Key Detect Menu. KEY DETECTION DIAGNOSTICS E X I T Key Label: SOURCE 1 Key Status: Released Key Scan Code: 0xC0 row=0 col=8 Figure 4-23. Key Detect Menu (sample) The Key Detect Menu shows you the key that is pressed, its status (pressed or released) its scan code and its location in the row and column matrix. • 116 Press {EXIT} to return to the Diagnostics Setup Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu aÉëíáå~íáçå=pÉíìé=jÉåì From the System Menu, press {DEST SETUP} to display the Destination Setup Menu. DESTINATION SETUP B A C K Destination 1 Type [ Widescreen SP ] SP to Add N A V [ N/A ] SP to Remove 1 Routing Mode External SPs assigned to destination 1: 1, 2 A D J REMOVE ADD Figure 4-24. Destination Setup Menu (sample) The Destination Setup Menu enables you to define each destination. The following functions are provided: • Destination — sets the destination that you want to define. Choices are 1 - 4 (standard destinations), and Aux 1 - 4. This field is independent of the destination(s) currently selected on the Destination Bus. Note • The destination that you select does equate to the same destination button on the Controller. Type — displays (or sets) the selected destination type. ~ For standard destinations: • Displays [Single Screen SP] if one ScreenPRO-II has been added to the destination’s configuration. • Displays [Widescreen SP] if two, three or four ScreenPRO-IIs have been added to the destination’s configuration. ~ For Aux destinations, enables you to select between Aux, ImagePRO Aux or PrePRO-II Aux destinations. Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide When Aux 1, 2, 3, or 4 is selected, the {AUX SETUP} button appears, which enables you to set Aux destination parameters. Refer to the “Aux Destination Setup” section on page 120 for details. 117 4. Menu Orientation System Menu • SP to Add — (as you rotate the ADJ knob), lists all available ScreenPRO-II units that can be assigned to the selected destination. Units are identified by their ID number. If a ScreenPRO-II is currently assigned to another destination, it will not appear in the list. • SP to Remove — lists all assigned ScreenPRO-II units that can be removed from the selected destination. Units are identified by their ID number. • Routing Mode — enables you to set the ScreenPRO-II’s routing mode — either Internal or External. This function instructs the system how sources are used on the assigned ScreenPRO-II unit(s). • At the bottom of the menu, the Status section dynamically lists the ScreenPRO-II IDs assigned to the current destination. • Press {ADD} to add the selected ScreenPRO-II (on the SP to Add line) to the current destination configuration. • Press {REMOVE} to remove the selected ScreenPRO-II (on the SP to Remove line) from the current destination configuration. • Press {BACK} to return to the System Menu. Important If you have configured a widescreen destination, the moment you press {BACK}, the system automatically checks the termination status of each ScreenPRO-II. • If the termination switch is properly set on each ScreenPRO-II, no action is required. • If any termination switch is improperly set, the ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination Menu appears, with instructions on how to correct the problem. Refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination Menu” section on page 119 for details. 118 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu pÅêÉÉåmolJff=dÉåäçÅâ=qÉêãáå~íáçå=jÉåì After having configured a wide screen destination, the ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination Menu will automatically appear if the system senses that any of the termination switches (in the Widescreen Lock signal chain) are improperly set. Note In Chapter 3, refer to the “BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections” section on page 77 for instructions on proper Widescreen Lock connection. A sample ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination Menu is shown below: SP-II GENLOCK TERMINATION B A C K Current Termination Status SP 1: HI-Z SP 2: HI-Z SP 3: 75 Ohm SP 4: 75 Ohm N A V ------------------------------------------Set SP-II termination as follows: Set to HI-Z: SP 3 Error: Termination setup incorrect Press CHECK TERM to retest setting. MORE A D J CHECK TERM Figure 4-25. ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination Menu This menu provides important information about the current status of your system’s Widescreen Lock chain, and each ScreenPRO-II’s Termination Switch. Important If you press {BACK}, the ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination Menu and the Destination Setup Menu will endlessly loop — until the termination problem is fixed. To correct the error: • • Review the menu information in detail. • • Press {CHECK TERM} to re-test the settings. Follow the instructions as noted in the menu to change the physical position of the termination switch(es) as instructed. For information on the termination switch, in Chapter 3 refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination” section on page 76. If required, press {MORE} for additional “help” menus. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 119 4. Menu Orientation System Menu ^ìñ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=pÉíìé When Aux 1, 2, 3, or 4 is selected on the Destination Setup Menu, you can select one of three types of Aux Destinations on the Type line: • • • Aux ImagePRO Aux PrePRO-II Aux. In each case, the {AUX SETUP} button appears, and when pressed, the Aux Setup Menu appears — which enables you to set parameters for the selected Aux destination. Note that the menu changes, depending upon the selected type of destination. By way of definition: • Each type of Aux destination can be switched from the ScreenPRO-II Controller by selecting it on the Destination Bus, and then selecting the desired source on the Source Selection Bus. • An Aux destination is the output of a router, which is typically connected directly to a monitor — rather than to the ScreenPRO-II. This type of destination is single format (e.g., an analog monitor can only accept signals from an analog router). • An ImagePRO Aux destination is an external ImagePRO, a multi-format processor with three inputs (one analog, one SDI and one DVI) and the ability to scale these inputs to one common output format. Typically, the ImagePRO output is connected to another display device such as a monitor or projector. • A PrePRO-II Aux destination is an external PresentationPRO-II, a multi-format processor with nine inputs (eight analog and one SDI), and the ability to scale these inputs to one common output format. Similar to ImagePRO, the PrePRO-II output is connected to another display device such as a monitor or projector. S For “standard” Aux destinations, press {AUX SETUP} to display the Aux Setup Menu: AUX SETUP B A C K Source Mapping Router Name AUX_1 Direct Map N A V MATRIXPRO1 7 Router Output A D J RESET Figure 4-26. Aux Setup Menu — Aux Destination (sample) The following functions are provided: • 120 Top Line — displays the selected Aux destination number. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu • Source Mapping — two selections are available: ~ Input Patch — maps Aux sources according to how your inputs are patched to buttons in the console’s Source Selection bus. ~ Direct Map — maps the Source Selection bus as a 1:1 map of your router inputs — for this destination only. • • Router Name — selects the router from which the Aux sources will be output. • Press {RESET} to return all fields to <UNDEFINED>. Router Output — selects the specific router output designated as an Aux (as assigned on the router’s Output Patch Menu). S For ImagePRO Aux and PrePRO-II Aux destinations, press {AUX SETUP} to display the Aux Setup Menu: AUX SETUP B A C K Source Mapping AUX_2 Input Patch N A V 17 ImagePRO ID: ----------------------------------------ANALOG Router Name MATRIXPRO1 ANALOG Router Output 7 ImagePRO Input: 1 ----------------------------------------SDI Router Name MATRIXPRO2 SDI Router Output 8 A D J RESET Figure 4-27. Aux Setup Menu — ImagePRO Aux Destination (sample) The following functions are provided: • • Top Line — displays the selected Aux destination number. Source Mapping — two selections are available: ~ Input Patch — maps Aux sources according to how your inputs are patched to buttons in the console’s Source Selection section. ~ Direct Map — maps Aux sources according to how your inputs are connected to the router. • ImagePRO ID or PrePRO-II ID — selects the ID of the ImagePRO or PrePRO-II, to which you want to route Aux sources. • In the Analog section: ~ Analog Router Name — selects the router from which analog sources will be routed to the ImagePRO or PrePRO-II. ~ Analog Router Output — selects the specific router output designated as Aux (as assigned on the router’s Output Patch Menu). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 121 4. Menu Orientation System Menu ~ • 122 ImagePRO Input or PrePRO-II Input — selects the ImagePRO or PrePRO-II input to which the analog router output is connected. In the SDI section: ~ SDI Router Name — selects the router from which SDI sources will be routed to the ImagePRO or PrePRO-II. ~ SDI Router Output — selects the specific router output designated as Aux (as assigned on the router’s Output Patch Menu). ~ ImagePRO Input or PrePRO-II Input — selects the ImagePRO or PrePRO-II input to which the SDI router output is connected. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu • • In the DVI section (applies to ImagePRO Aux destinations only): ~ DVI Router Name — selects the router from which DVI sources will be routed to the ImagePRO. ~ DVI Router Output — selects the specific router output designated as Aux (as assigned on the router’s Output Patch Menu). ~ ImagePRO Input — selects the ImagePRO input to which the DVI router output is connected. Press {RESET} to return all fields to <UNDEFINED>. Please note the following important points regarding Aux destinations: • For proper operation, ImagePRO and PrePRO-II devices must be connected to the ScreenPRO-II Controller via Ethernet. • ImagePRO and PrePRO-II output setups must be performed locally on the units themselves. • Only one router of each type (Analog, DVI and SDI) can be connected to an ImagePRO unit. • • Only one Analog and one SDI router can be connected to a PrePRO-II unit. In order to properly create “source files” on ImagePRO: ~ On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, select a ScreenPRO-II Controller destination. ~ ~ On the Input Menu, acquire the selected source in the normal manner. ~ Press {SAVE} to save the source in the normal manner, which in turn also creates a source file on the ImagePRO. Repeat for all desired sources. Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide The “copy down” of source file information is possible because the system “knows” that ImagePRO is connected to the same router from which the newly acquired input originates — all based on the patching configuration. 123 4. Menu Orientation System Menu kÉíïçêâ=pÉíìé=jÉåì From the System Menu, press {NETWORK SETUP} to display the Network Setup Menu. NETWORK SETUP B A C K Network DHCP Ctrlr IP Port IP Range from to [ Server ] : [ 192.168.0.10 ] : [ 3000 ] N A V [ 192.168.0.11 ] [ 192.168.0.191 ] A D J Figure 4-28. Network Setup Menu (sample) For reference only, the Network Setup Menu displays the available IP range for the ScreenPRO-II Controller system. The following information is provided: 124 • Network DHCP — this non-selectable field confirms that the Controller is a DHCP server, by showing the [SERVER] label. • • • Ctrlr IP — this non-selectable field shows the Controller’s IP address. Port — this non-selectable field shows the Controller’s port. IP Range from / to — these non-selectable fields show the system’s available IP range that the server can provide. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu fåéìí=pçìêÅÉ=m~íÅÜ=jÉåì From the System Menu, press {INPUT PATCH} to display the Input Source Patch Menu. INPUT SOURCE PATCH B A C K Source Number 1 Connection Type MATRIXPRO1 Router Input 1 Tally Number 1 A D J Press “ADD PATCH” to log change ADD PATCH N A V DELETE PATCH Figure 4-29. Input Source Patch Menu (sample) The Input Source Patch Menu enables you to associate (patch) specific router inputs to specific source buttons on the ScreenPRO-II Controller. The menu also enables you to assign tallies, and select connections to the ScreenPRO-II units. Important The fields that are shown on the Input Source Patch Menu change depending upon the selected Connection Type. Important From a conceptual standpoint, there are no “direct” connections to a ScreenPRO-II scaler. All connections, whether they are from a single source or an external router, connect to each ScreenPRO-II’s internal router matrix. The following functions are provided: • Source Number — selects the source button on the Controller that you want to patch. The selection range is 1 - 16. The source is chosen with the ADJ knob — not with the source buttons. • Connection Type — determines how the selected source is connected: ~ From a router — choose between up to eight MATRIXPRO routers, or a third party router (e.g., SIERRA, LEITCH, etc.) as selected on the Router Specification Menu. ~ To ScreenPRO-II’s internal matrix — choose ALL SP or an individual ScreenPRO-II ID. The “ALL SP” selection assumes connections from ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 125 4. Menu Orientation System Menu DAs to similar ScreenPRO-II inputs, and enables all ScreenPRO-IIs to switch simultaneously to the same input. Note • Asterisks around the ID number (e.g., *1*) indicate that the selected ID has not been detected by the system. However, you can proceed with patching, and once the ID is detected, the patch will be completed as programmed. Router Input — Applies to Router connections — this option selects the physical router input that you wish to associate with the source. The available range depends on the number of router inputs that are defined in the Router Specification Menu. Note The same router input can be chosen for different source numbers. • • ScreenPRO-II Input — selects the specific input on the ScreenPRO-II. • Press {ADD PATCH} to confirm any change that you make on the menu. As you dial through the choices, the “SP Input is mapped to” lines will show if the current choice is already in use. If the patch already exists and you “add” it, you will be asked to confirm. • Press {DELETE PATCH} to delete all input patch registers for the selected input. When pressed: Tally Number — Applies to all connections — this option enables you to assign any of the eight available tallies to any input source. There are no restrictions on tally usage. For example, inputs 1 and 8 could both map to tally 1 if desired. ~ ~ The Connection Type setting changes to “UNDEFINED.” The Router Input line is cleared. This procedure is an excellent starting point if you are uncertain about specific input patch settings. In Chapter 5, refer to the “Input Patching” section on page 198 for important information about the system’s default Input Patch Table. 126 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu oçìíÉê=péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçå=jÉåì From the System Menu, press {ROUTER SETUP} to display the Router Specification Menu. ROUTER SPECIFICATION B A C K Number 1 Name [ MATRIXPRO1 ] Manufacturer FOLSOM Router Type ANALOG N A V 16 Number of Inputs 8 Number of Outputs Communication Type ETHERNET A D J COMM SETUP DELETE ROUTER ADD NEW OUTPUT PATCH Figure 4-30. Router Specification Menu (sample) The Router Specification Menu enables you to define input, output and communication parameters for all connected routers. The following functions are provided: • Number — select the number of the router that you wish to configure. The system supports up to eight definitions. • Name — this non-selectable field shows the router’s assigned name. After a factory reset, router number 1 defaults to [MATRIXPRO1] in Analog format, router number 2 defaults to [MATRIXPRO2] in SDI format, and router number 3 defaults to [MATRIXPRO3] in DVI format. When a router number is undefined, the name [ROUTER #] appears, and in the Number field, the word “EMPTY” appears before the selected number. Note • Manufacturer — identifies the router manufacturer. Choose between FOLSOM, EXTRON, SIERRA, LEITCH, ISIS, DVILINK and DPI. Refer to the “Router Interface Notes” section on page 128 for additional details about third party manufacturers. • Router Type — identifies the type of router being used. The choices are ANALOG, DVI, SDI, D/A ANALOG, D/A DVI and D/A SDI. Please note: • • ~ The {COMM SETUP} function must be set for Analog, DVI and SDI routers. ~ The D/A selections are provided for future implementation. Number of Inputs — identifies the number of inputs on the selected router. Number of Outputs — identifies the number of outputs on the selected router. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 127 4. Menu Orientation System Menu • Communication Type — sets the device’s communication type, either RS-232, ETHERNET or LANTRONIX. • Press {COMM SETUP} to display one of three Comm Setup Menus, depending on the selected Communication Type. Refer to the “Comm Setup Menus” section on page 129 for details. • Press {DELETE ROUTER} to delete the current specification and change the selected router Number to <EMPTY>. • Press {ADD NEW} after choosing an empty configuration’s Manufacturer, Type, Number of Inputs and Number of Outputs to save a new router specification. • Press {OUTPUT PATCH} to display the Output Patch Menu. Refer to the “Output Patch Menu” section on page 132 for details. oçìíÉê=fåíÉêÑ~ÅÉ=kçíÉë For selected third party routers, additional interface information is provided below. • Extron Router Support The ScreenPRO-II Controller supports Extron routers enabled with Ethernet. ~ In the Router Specification Menu, set the Communication Type to ETHERNET. ~ In the Ethernet Setup Menu, dial in the router’s IP address, and keep the port number set to 23. ~ Press {TEST COMM} to establish communications. Due to the Extron protocol, the router’s matrix size will not be read by the Controller, but will instead default to 16 x 16. When you return from the Ethernet Setup Menu to the Router Specification Menu, dial in the proper number of inputs and outputs to gain full access to the router. Note • Ensure that you set the router’s IP address to work with the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s 192.168.0.xxx standard (e.g., 192.168.0.245). Any 192.168.0.xxx address will work provided it does not conflict with the Controller, VPs or other network routers and devices. DVILink 18x18 Router Support The ScreenPRO-II Controller supports the DVILink 18x18 router enabled with serial control. Connect the router to the EXT COMM port on the back of the Controller. In Appendix A, refer to the “Serial Connector” section on page 261 for pinouts. • Sierra Video Systems Router Support The ScreenPRO-II Controller supports Sierra Video Systems routers enabled with serial control. Connect the router to the EXT COMM port on the back of the Controller. In Appendix A, refer to the “Serial Connector” section on page 261 for pinouts. 128 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu `çãã=pÉíìé=jÉåìë Information is provided for three different Comm Setup Menus: • • • Ethernet Setup Menu RS-232 Setup Menu Lantronix Setup Menu bíÜÉêåÉí=pÉíìé=jÉåì On the Router Specification Menu, when the Communication Type is set to ETHERNET, press {COMM SETUP} to display the Ethernet Setup Menu: ETHERNET SETUP B A C K IP Address 192.168.0.241 IP Port Number 23 N A V A D J TEST COMM NEXT IP QUAD Figure 4-31. Ethernet Setup Menu (sample) The Ethernet Setup Menu enables you to set the selected router’s IP address and port number. • • • IP Address — sets the router’s IP address. • Press {TEST COMM} to test communications with the defined router: IP Port Number — sets the router’s IP port number, if applicable. Press {NEXT IP QUAD} to advance to the next 3-digit set of numbers in the address. Use the ADJ knob in the normal manner to change the digits. ~ If the test is successful, a “ROUTER CONNECTED” message will appear that includes the Router name and version. ~ If the test is unsuccessful, a “ROUTER FAILED” message will appear. In this condition, re-check all connections and settings, and repeat the test. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 129 4. Menu Orientation System Menu opJOPO=pÉíìé=jÉåì On the Router Specification Menu, when the Communication Type is set to RS-232, press {COMM SETUP} to display the RS-232 Setup Menu: RS-232 SETUP B A C K Baud Rate 9600 Data Bits [8] Parity N A V [ NONE ] Stop Bits [1] A D J TEST COMM Figure 4-32. RS-232 Setup Menu (sample) The RS-232 Setup Menu enables you to set the router’s RS-232 communications parameters. 130 • Baud Rate — sets the desired baud rate (9600, 14400, 19200, 28800, 38400, 57600, 115200). • • • • Data Bits — this value is fixed at [8]. Parity — this value is fixed at [None]. Stop Bits — this value is fixed at [1]. Press {TEST COMM} to test communications with the defined router: ~ If the test is successful, a “ROUTER CONNECTED” message will appear that includes the Router name and version. ~ If the test is unsuccessful, a “ROUTER FAILED” message will appear. In this condition, re-check all connections and settings, and repeat the test. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation System Menu i~åíêçåáñ=pÉíìé=jÉåì On the Router Specification Menu, when Communication Type is set to LANTRONIX, press {COMM SETUP} to display the Lantronix Setup Menu: LANTRONIX SETUP B A C K Number < EMPTY > Channel [ N/A ] Baud rate [ N/A ] Data bits [ N/A ] Stop bit [ N/A ] Parity [ N/A ] IP: N/A MAC Addr: [ N/A ] N A V A D J DISCOVER LTRX Figure 4-33. Lantronix Setup Menu (sample) The Lantronix Setup Menu enables you to set parameters for multiple Lantronix Ethernetto-Serial device servers. The ScreenPRO-II Controller supports Lantronix models UDS100 and UDS200. The menu will appear blank until the Lantronix device is “discovered.” Important Prior to pressing {DISCOVER LTRX}, it is highly recommended that you set up a static IP address on the Lantronix device itself. The recommended range is 192.168.0.200 - 192.168.0.239 — such as not to conflict with other devices in the ScreenPRO-II Controller system. Refer to the Lantronix UDS100 or UDS200 User’s Guide for instructions. • • • Number — selects the number of the Lantronix device that you wish to set up. • • • • • Baud Rate — sets the selected channel’s baud rate. • MAC Addr — displays the hard-coded MAC address of the Lantronix. Press {DISCOVER LTRX} to set up communications with the Lantronix device. Channel — sets the specific Lantronix channel (1 or 2) that you wish to set up. Each Lantronix can control two serial routers. Data Bits — sets the selected channel’s data bits. Stop Bit — sets the selected channel’s stop bit. Parity — sets the selected channel’s parity. IP — displays the IP address of the Lantronix. This parameter must be set at the device itself. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 131 4. Menu Orientation System Menu lìíéìí=m~íÅÜ=jÉåì From the Router Specification Menu, press {OUTPUT PATCH} to display the Output Patch Menu. OUTPUT PATCH B A C K MATRIXPRO1 Router Output 1 Device ID SP 1 SP Input N A V 1 Mixer Layer [ N/A ] SP Input is mapped to MATRIXPRO1 Output 1 Set Device ID to NONE to define A D J the Router Output as an AUX. ADD PATCH DELETE PATCH Figure 4-34. Output Patch Menu (sample) The Output Patch Menu allows you to associate router outputs to ScreenPRO-II inputs. When a router is chosen on the Router Specification Menu, you then use the Output Patch Menu to associate a specific output with a ScreenPRO-II ID and input. This process creates a unique “Output Patch Table” for each defined router. The following functions are provided: • Router Output — selects the specific router output that is being patched. The selectable range is 1 to the number of outputs defined in the Router Specification Menu (e.g., 1 - 16). • Device ID — selects the ScreenPRO-II ID to which the Router’s output will be connected. The selectable range is 1 - 32. Note If “None” is selected, the output is designated as an Aux output. • SP Input — selects the physical ScreenPRO-II input to which the router’s output is patched. • • Mixer Layer — this line displays N/A, as it does not apply to ScreenPRO-II. • Press {ADD PATCH} to confirm any change that you make on the menu. As you dial through the choices, the “SP Input is mapped to” lines will show if the current choice is already in use. If the patch already exists and you “add” it, you will be asked to confirm. Press {DELETE PATCH} to delete all “Output Patch Table” registers for the selected router output. This function is an excellent starting point if you are uncertain about specific output patch settings. In Chapter 5, refer to the “Router Setup” section on page 193 for important information about the system’s default Output Patch Table. 132 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu jáëÅÉää~åÉçìë=jÉåì The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • Miscellaneous Menu Tree Miscellaneous Menu Description Miscellaneous Sub Menus jáëÅÉää~åÉçìë=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the Miscellaneous Menu Tree: HOME MENU MISC MISCELLANEOUS MENU CONSL LOCK Console Port Setup Menu Lockout Code Menu EDID LIGHT ADJUST EDID DVI Input Format Menu Keypad Backlight Menu HOME Baud Rate CHANGE CODE Lockout Code Destination Data Bits Keypad Backlight Format Change Lockout Code Menu Parity Stop Bits Current Format PROGRAM EDID Enter New Code Confirm Code CANCEL LCD SETTINGS USER PREF BACKUP RESTORE LCD Settings Menu User Preference Menu Backup / Restore Menu Brightness Black Invalid Vid Contrast Device Controller Options SP to Restore RESET BACKUP LCD CAL LCD Calibration CHECK CARD RESTORE Figure 4-35. Miscellaneous Menu Tree All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 133 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu jáëÅÉää~åÉçìë=jÉåì=aÉëÅêáéíáçå The Miscellaneous Menu accesses ScreenPRO-II Controller functions that do not fall into other distinct menu categories. MISCELLANEOUS MENU H O M E C O N S L L O C K E D I D LIGHT ADJUST LCD SETTINGS USER PREF BACKUP RESTORE Figure 4-36. Miscellaneous Menu To access the menu: • Press MISC on the Home Menu. The following “miscellaneous” functions are provided: 134 • Press {CONSL} to access the Console Port Setup Menu. Refer to the “Console Port Setup Menu” section on page 135 for details. • Press {LOCK} to access the Lockout Code Menu. Refer to the “Lockout Code Menu” section on page 136 for details. • Press {EDID} to access the EDID DVI Input Format Menu. Refer to the “EDID DVI Input Format Menu” section on page 137 for details. • Press {LIGHT ADJUST} to access the Keypad Backlight Menu. Refer to the “Keypad Backlight Menu” section on page 138 for details. • Press {LCD SETTINGS} to access the LCD Settings Menu. Refer to the “LCD Settings Menu” section on page 139 for details. • Press {USER PREF} to access the User Preference Menu. Refer to the “User Preference Menu” section on page 140 for details. • Press {BACKUP RESTORE} to access the Backup/Restore Menu. Refer to the “Backup/Restore Menu” section on page 141 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu jáëÅÉää~åÉçìë=pìÄ=jÉåìë The following sub menus can be accessed from the Miscellaneous Menu: • • • • • • • Console Port Setup Menu Lockout Code Menu EDID DVI Input Format Menu Keypad Backlight Menu LCD Settings Menu User Preference Menu Backup/Restore Menu `çåëçäÉ=mçêí=pÉíìé=jÉåì From the Miscellaneous Menu, press {CONSL} to display the Console Port Setup Menu: CONSOLE PORT SETUP B A C K Baud Rate 115200 Data Bits Parity 8 N A V NONE Stop Bits 1 A D J Figure 4-37. Console Port Setup Menu (sample) This menu enables you to verify (or change) ScreenPRO-II Controller’s serial port communication settings (for the Ext Comm port). The following functions are provided: • • • • Baud Rate — sets the port’s baud rate. Range: 2400 to 115200. Data Bits — sets the port’s data bits. Range: 5 to 8. Parity — sets the port’s parity: Even, Odd or None. Stop Bits — sets the port’s stop bits: 1, 1.5 or 2. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 135 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu içÅâçìí=`çÇÉ=jÉåì From the Miscellaneous Menu, press {LOCK} to display the Lockout Code Menu: LOCKOUT CODE H O M E Lockout Code Default A D J B A C K CHANGE CODE Figure 4-38. Lockout Code Menu (sample) The Lockout Code Menu enables you to define a programmable lockout code, so that the Controller can be locked out from unauthorized users. The following functions are provided: • The Lockout Code field defines which code is currently enabled. ~ ~ • Select Default to enable the system’s default lockout code: 1111 Select Custom to enable a custom lockout code, as entered on the Change Lockout Code Menu. Press {CHANGE CODE} to display the Change Lockout Code Menu. CHANGE LOCKOUT CODE Enter new code: __ __ __ __ Confirm new code: __ __ __ __ Enter and confirm new code using source keys 1 – 8. CANCEL Figure 4-39. Change Lockout Code Menu (sample) 136 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu To enter a new lockout code, use the eight numbered buttons on the Source Selection Bus, and then confirm the new code. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Locking and Unlocking the Controller” section on page 252 for instructions on using the Controller Panel Lockout mode. bafa=asf=fåéìí=cçêã~í=jÉåì From the Miscellaneous Menu, press {EDID} to display the EDID DVI Input Format Menu: EDID DVI INPUT FORMAT B A C K Destination ALL FORMAT: 1280 x 1024 @ 60 N A V Current EDID format 1280 x 1024 @ 60 To change EDID for DVI inputs, select the desired format and select Program EDID. A D J PROGRAM EDID Figure 4-40. EDID DVI Input Format Menu (sample) The EDID DVI Input Format Menu enables you to update the system’s preferred EDID resolution for each ScreenPRO-II’s two DVI inputs (Background and DSK) — for the selected destination bus. Note This menu is designed for advanced users only. Do not program the EDID unless it is necessary. Extended Display Identification Data (EDID) is a VESA standard data format that contains information about a display device and its resolution, both preferred and allowed. The system’s EDID file is stored in non-volatile memory. This file is read by an external computer’s DVI graphic card when the computer’s DVI output is connected to ScreenPROII via the DVI-I connector during boot-up. The ScreenPRO-II must be powered on first for the EDID information to be read. The following functions are provided: • Destination — sets the destination bus on which you want to program EDID — all or individual ScreenPRO-II units. • Format — selects the preferred DVI video format with which you want to program the selected ScreenPRO-II(s) EDID non-volatile memory • • Current — displays the current EDID video format that resides in memory. Press {PROGRAM EDID} to program EDID with the new selected format. A warning message will be shown. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 137 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu Please note the following important points regarding EDID: • • For the computer to correctly see the EDID data: a. Turn on ScreenPRO-II power. b. Connect the DVI cable from the computer’s video card to one of ScreenPRO-II’s DVI connectors. c. Boot the computer. d. Once EDID programming is complete, you will be prompted to power down the external computer, power it back on again, and then ensure that the computer’s format is set to match. A ScreenPRO-II’s EDID prom is not reset to any default during a factory reset. To change the EDID, you must use the EDID DVI Input Format Menu. hÉóé~Ç=_~ÅâäáÖÜí=jÉåì From the Miscellaneous Menu, press {LIGHT ADJUST} to show the Keypad Backlight Menu: KEYPAD BACKLIGHT H O M E Keypad Backlight 10 A D J B A C K Figure 4-41. Keypad Backlight Menu (sample) The Keypad Backlight Menu enables you to adjust the backlight level of all buttons on the ScreenPRO-II Controller. The following functions are provided: • 138 Keypad Backlight — adjusts the backlight level. Backlight range is 0 (backlight off) to 100 (backlight on full). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu i`a=pÉííáåÖë=jÉåì From the Miscellaneous Menu, press {LCD SETTINGS} to show the LCD Settings Menu: LCD SETTINGS B A C K Brightness Contrast 100 65 B R I T E C O N T R A S T RESET LCD Cal Figure 4-42. LCD Settings Menu (sample) The LCD Settings Menu enables you to adjust contrast and brightness settings for the touch screen, and also calibrate the touch screen. The following functions are provided: • • • • Rotate the BRITE knob to adjust touch screen brightness. Rotate the CONTRAST knob to adjust touch screen contrast. Press {RESET} to return settings to the factory default values. Press {LCD CAL} to calibrate the touch screen display to your finger, or to a stylus. Once pressed, you will be prompted to touch the center of a target three times. At the conclusion of the procedure, the display is calibrated and the system returns to the Home Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 139 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu rëÉê=mêÉÑÉêÉåÅÉ=jÉåì From the Miscellaneous Menu, press {USER PREF} to display the User Preference Menu: USER PREFERENCE MENU B A C K Black Invalid Video ON N A V A D J Figure 4-43. User Preference Menu (sample) The User Preference Menu enables you to set a variety of user preference parameters. The following functions are provided: • Black Invalid Video — selects the method by which the scaler “loading” procedure is shown on Preview, when the user changes inputs: ~ ON — shows black when scalers are loaded. In addition: • Black is shown when a background channel (BG) becomes invalid. • The DSK will be turned off when source video becomes invalid. ~ OFF — shows the full scaler loading procedure, which can temporarily include non-sync and non-stable video. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Setting User Preferences” section on page 221 for instructions. 140 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Miscellaneous Menu _~ÅâìéLoÉëíçêÉ=jÉåì From the Miscellaneous Menu, press {BACKUP RESTORE} to display the Backup/ Restore Menu: BACKUP / RESTORE H O M E Device Ctrlr+SP Controller Options All SP To Restore All N A V B A C K Select option to Backup / Restore to or from the Flash card. BACKUP A D J CHECK CARD RESTORE Figure 4-44. Backup/Restore Menu (sample) The Backup/Restore Menu enables you to back up and restore system configurations, using the console’s Flash Memory Card capability. You can also use this function to transfer configurations between Controllers as required. Note You can only store one system configuration on a Flash Memory Card. The following functions are provided: • Device — Selects the device(s) that you want to backup or restore. Choose between the Ctrlr, SP or Ctrlr+SP. • Controller Options — Selects which portion of the selected devices you want to backup or restore. Choose between All, System or Presets. • SP to Restore — Selects the device(s) that you wish to restore. Choose between All devices, or the ID of a specific ScreenPRO-II (e.g., 1, 2, 3). • Press {BACKUP} to perform a backup operation to the Flash Memory Card using the selected device(s) and options. • Press {CHECK CARD} to check the system for the presence of a Flash Memory Card. If a memory card is present, the system then checks for the presence of a system configuration on the card. • Press {RESTORE} to restore a system configuration from the Flash Memory Card to the selected device(s). In Chapter 6, refer to the “Using Backup and Restore” section on page 253 for instructions. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 141 4. Menu Orientation Frame Grab Menu cê~ãÉ=dê~Ä=jÉåì The following topics are discussed in this section: • • Frame Grab Menu Tree Frame Grab Menu Description cê~ãÉ=dê~Ä=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the Frame Grab Menu Tree: HOME MENU FRAME GRAB Frame Grab Menu NAME Destination ID Frame Grab Name Menu FG to Capture HOME Saved Location ERASE Confirmation Current Name New Name CAPTURE SAVE Confirmation DELETE RECALL Figure 4-45. Frame Grab Menu Tree All functions and menus are discussed in the following sections. 142 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Frame Grab Menu cê~ãÉ=dê~Ä=jÉåì=aÉëÅêáéíáçå The figure below illustrates a sample Frame Grab Menu: FRAME GRAB H O M E Destination [1] ID ALL Frame Number FG_1 Capture Format N A M E N A V [ 1280 x 1024 ] Name [ SAVED_FG_1 ] Format [ 1280 x 1024 ] A D J E R A S E CAPTURE SAVE DELETE RECALL Figure 4-46. Frame Grab Menu (sample) To access the Frame Grab Menu: • On Preview, select the layer (Layer A or B) or the background (BG A or BG B) from which you want to capture a “full screen” still frame. • Press FRAME GRAB on the Home Menu. The Frame Grab Menu enables you to capture still frames into each ScreenPRO-II system’s three internal frame stores. The “sources” of the still frames are each ScreenPRO-II’s BG A and BG B inputs, or the scaled inputs (Layer A or B). Please note: • For widescreen destinations, even though you are using the frame stores of multiple ScreenPRO-II units, you are conceptually working with only three frame stores — each of which captures’s its “slice” of the complete widescreen image. • For single screen destinations, you are working with the individual destination’s three frame stores in the normal manner. Regarding captures: • All captures of the background (BG A or BG B) must occur on Preview — the desired full screen source to capture must be visible on Preview. You will get an error message if you attempt to capture while the source is on Program. • All captures of the layers (Layer A or Layer B) can occur on either Preview or Program. Once captured, a still frame can be assigned as the input “type” for BG A, BG B, the DSK source or the LOGO — basically any “green” button in the Layer Control Section. Each frame store utilizes the “temp” (temporary) memory for on-air production. During operation, you can overwrite the memory with new captured stills as desired — as it takes only a few seconds to capture a still. Note that stills in “temp” memory are lost when the system is powered down. You can also store three stills in “permanent” flash memory, which will not be lost when the ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 143 4. Menu Orientation Frame Grab Menu system is powered down. Thus, at any one time, you could have a maximum of three stills in temporary memory, and three different stills in permanent memory. At bootup, the contents of flash memory is read into “temp” memory for use on-air. It takes several minutes to save a still into permanent memory, and this procedure should not be performed on-air. Permanent frames can also be overwritten. The following Frame Grab Menu functions are provided: • • Destination — displays the currently selected destination. • Frame Number — enables you to select FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3 for capture, storage, erasure, recall or deletion. • Capture Format — displays the output resolution. Each ScreenPRO-II always captures a full screen image at the output resolution — regardless of the input resolution. • Name — displays the name of the file. ID — displays the ID(s) of the selected destination’s associated ScreenPRO-II system(s). ~ ~ UNSAVED indicates that the file’s source is temporary memory. SAVED indicates that the file is permanently stored. If this appears, the permanent file has been read into “temp” memory for use on-air. • • Format — displays the resolution of the captured frame. • Press {ERASE} to permanently erase the selected frame from permanent (flash) memory. This process takes from 1 to 2 minutes, and locks the console during the procedure. You will be asked to confirm before proceeding. Press {NAME} to display the Frame Grab Name Menu. Refer to the “Frame Grab Name Menu” section on page 145 for details. Note You can perform this function even if there is no frame stored in the permanent register. • Press {CAPTURE} to capture a still into the selected “temporary” frame store. Once pressed, the screen will indicate that the frame is being captured. • Press {SAVE} to save the captured frame into permanent (flash) memory within the selected register. This process takes from 2 to 3 minutes, and locks the console during the procedure. You will be asked to confirm before proceeding. • Press {DELETE} to mark the selected permanent frame as deleted — but note that the ERASE function is still required for permanent deletion. You can consider this as a “quick” delete function. • Press {RECALL} to recall a selected frame from permanent (flash) storage back into temporary memory. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Still Frames” section on page 246 for instructions. 144 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Frame Grab Menu cê~ãÉ=dê~Ä=k~ãÉ=jÉåì The figure below illustrates a sample Frame Grab Name Menu: FRAME GRAB NAME B A C K Saved Location 1 Current Name: [ N A V SAVED_FG_1 ] New Name: [ SAVED_FG_1 ] Enter a new name for this saved frame grab using a PS2 keyboard, then hit Enter to save it. A D J Figure 4-47. Frame Grab Name Menu (sample) The Frame Grab Name Menu enables you to name a saved frame grab, using a customer supplied PS-2 keyboard. Note The optional Tally board is required for the “naming” feature. The board includes the tally connector plus a PS-2 connector for the Keyboard Port. The following functions are provided: • Saved Location — enables you to select the saved frame that you want to name. You must use the Save function (on the Frame Grab Menu) as a prerequisite to naming the frame. • • Current Name — displays the name of the saved frame. New Name — enables you to enter a new name with the PS-2 keyboard. Once entered, the name is “attached” to the file that already resides in permanent (flash) memory. The name will now be shown on all menus in which a still frame can be selected (e.g., LOGO Menu, DSK Input Setup Menu, Background Input Setup Menu, etc.). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 145 4. Menu Orientation Effects Menu bÑÑÉÅíë=jÉåì The figure below illustrates a sample Effects Menu: EFFECTS MENU H O M E Destination 1 Key Frame Effect LINEAR Transition Rate 1.0 Transition Wipe Wipe Right Transition Edge Width N A V 16 ! Wide Screen destinations only support Mix Transition ! Keyframe Effects are ignored A D J by ScreenPROII destinations Figure 4-48. Effects Menu (sample) To access the menu: • Press EFFECTS on the Home Menu. The Effects Menu allows you to modify and manage effects on a destination-bydestination basis, including the ability to define key frames, paths and effect properties. The following functions are provided: • • Destination — displays the currently selected destination. Key Frame Effect — enables you to select the type of motion for a “move.” Note Only the Linear motion type is supported. All other key frame effects are ignored by ScreenPRO-II destinations. • Transition Rate — sets the auto-transition rate that is used when the Auto Trans button is pressed. The transition value is in 0.1 second increments. • Transition Wipe — sets the transition type when the WIPE button is selected. Choose between Wipe Right, Wipe Left, Wipe Down, Wipe Up, Curtain Open, Curtain Close, Box In and Box Out. Note • Wide screen destinations only support Mix transitions. Key frame effects are ignored by ScreenPRO-II destinations. Transition Edge Width — When WIPE is selected, this field enables you to set the transition’s edge type. The range (in pixels) is from 0 to 256. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Transitions” section on page 241 for instructions. 146 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Status Menu pí~íìë=jÉåì The Status Menu provides basic status information: SP II Controller H O M E Ver 1.0 SCREENPRO II: 4 PREPRO II: 0 IMAGEPRO: 2 ROUTERS: 2 BLENDPRO II: 1 Figure 4-49. Status Menu (sample) To access the Status Menu: • Press STATUS on the Home Menu. The following status information is provided: • • • • • • ScreenPRO-II Controller — (top line) displays the Controller’s software version. SCREENPRO-II — lists the number of ScreenPRO-II units detected. PREPRO-II — lists the number of PresentationPRO-II units detected. IMAGEPRO — lists the number of ImagePRO units detected. ROUTERS — lists the number of Routers detected. BLENDPRO-II — lists the number of BlendPRO-II units detected. Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide If certain error conditions exist, the Status Menu displays additional messages such as “Checksum Mismatch” and “Please Upgrade.” 147 4. Menu Orientation PIP Adjustment Menu mfm=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • PIP Adjustment Menu Tree PIP Adjustment Menu Description PIP Adjustment Menu Functions PIP Adjustment Sub Menus mfm=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the PIP Adjustment Menu tree: LAYER A LAYER B PIP ADJUSTMENT MENU PIP BORDR SHDOW EFX Border Menu Shadow Menu Image Effects Menu H Size V Size H Position V Position Move Rate 3 Track Size HOME Mode H Size Style V Size Monochrome Red Color: Red H Pos Green Color: Green V Pos Blue Color: Blue Transparency Invert Size Specified Size Track Size PIP PIP SHDOW EFX 3 BORDR EFX Hue Strobe Mode Strobe Interval PIP BORDR SHDOW RESET RGB Figure 4-50. PIP Adjustment Menu Tree All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. 148 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation PIP Adjustment Menu mfm=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì=aÉëÅêáéíáçå The figure below illustrates a sample PIP Adjustment Menu: PIP ADJUSTMENT H O M E B O R D R H Size < 37.3% > 674 V Size < 58.9% > 452 H Position -34 V Position 70 N A V ----------------------------S H D O W Move Rate Key Frame Effect 0.8 [ LINEAR ] OPERATION: E F X JOY Z to SIZE, X Y TO POSITION 3 A D J TRACK SIZE Figure 4-51. PIP Adjustment Menu (sample) The PIP Adjustment Menu provides tools that enable you to adjust the “active” PIP. To access the menu: • • Press LAYER A or LAYER B in the Layer Control Section, then ... Press the PIP button in the Layer Function Section. mfm=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë The following PIP Adjustment Menu functions are provided: • H Size — adjusts the PIP’s horizontal size in pixels. The “%” value is the PIP’s size as a percentage of the screen’s horizontal resolution. The numeric value is the PIP’s width in pixels. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or the Joystick’s Z-Axis knob. • V Size — adjusts the PIP’s vertical size in pixels. The “%” value is the PIP’s size as a percentage of the screen’s vertical resolution. The numeric value is the PIP’s height in pixels. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or the Joystick’s Z-Axis knob. • H Position — indicates the PIP’s position, relative to the horizontal center of the screen (00), as measured from the exact center of the PIP. Thus, the value -34 is 34 pixels to the left of center. To adjust, move the Joystick left and right or use the ADJ knob. • V Position — indicates the PIP’s position, relative to the vertical center of the screen (00), as measured from the exact center of the PIP. Thus, the value 70 is 70 pixels above center. To adjust V Position, move the Joystick up and down or use the ADJ knob. • Move Rate — adjusts the rate (in 0.1 second increments) for programmed PIP movement from key frame to key frame. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or twist the Joystick Z-Axis knob. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 149 4. Menu Orientation PIP Adjustment Menu • Key Frame Effect — indicates the “motion type” that is used to move the PIP from point to point. Only the Linear motion type is supported. All other key frame effects are ignored by ScreenPRO-II destinations. Note • Press {BORDR} to display the Border Menu. Refer to the “Border Menu” section on page 151 for details. • Press {SHDOW} to display the Shadow Menu. Refer to the “Shadow Menu” section on page 152 for details. • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. • At the bottom of the PIP Adjustment Menu, the {TRACK SIZE} check box has the following functions: • ~ Check the {TRACK SIZE} check box to lock H Size and V Size together. Regardless of the PIP’s current aspect ratio, its size will adjust proportionally when the Joystick’s Z-Axis knob or the ADJ rotary knob is used to change size. ~ Uncheck the {TRACK SIZE} check box to adjust H Size or V Size individually, without affecting the other parameter. In this way, you can stretch the PIP horizontally or vertically. Press Source in the Joystick Section to display the Input Source Adjustment Menu. Refer to the “Source Adjustment Menus” section on page 165. Please note the following related functions: • To return the PIP to its default size and aspect ratio, press the Reset button in the Joystick Section. • To adjust the PIP with fine resolution, press the Fine Adjust button in the Joystick Section. mfm=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=pìÄ=jÉåìë The following sub menus can be accessed from the PIP Adjustment Menu: • • • Border Menu Shadow Menu Image Effects Menu Complete descriptions are provided in the following sections. 150 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation PIP Adjustment Menu _çêÇÉê=jÉåì From the PIP Adjustment Menu, press {BORDR} to display the Border Menu. BORDER H O M E Mode On Style 5 Color: P I P S H D O W Red 609 Green 600 Blue 531 Size Specified In N A V % of PIP Size < % of PIP > 10.2 A D J E F X Figure 4-52. Border Menu (sample) The Border Menu enables you to add a border to a PIP, and adjust its shape, style and color as desired. Note You can also access the Border Menu from the Shadow Menu and the Image Effects Menu by pressing {BORDR}. The following functions are provided: • • Mode — enables or disables the PIP’s border. • Color — enables you to individually adjust the border’s Red, Green and Blue attributes as desired. • Size Specified In — select the method by which you want to specify the border size, either as a percentage of the PIP size or in pixels. • Size — adjust’s the border size, using the method selected on the “Size Specified In” line. Note that if “% of PIP” is selected and you switch to “Pixels,” the system auto converts one display method to the other. • Press {PIP} to return to the PIP Adjustment Menu. Refer to the “PIP Adjustment Menu Functions” section on page 149 for details. • Press {SHDOW} to display the Shadow Menu. Refer to the “Shadow Menu” section on page 152 for details. • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. Style — select one of multiple border styles, including single color and dual color with various combinations of soft edge. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 151 4. Menu Orientation PIP Adjustment Menu pÜ~Ççï=jÉåì From the PIP Adjustment Menu, press {SHDOW} to display the Shadow Menu. SHADOW H O M E P I P B O R D R Mode On H Size < % > 106 V Size < % > 106 H Pos < % > 28 V Pos < % > 11 Transparency 100 N A V A D J E F X 3 TRACK SIZE Figure 4-53. Shadow Menu (sample) The Shadow Menu enables you place a shadow behind a PIP, and adjust its size, position and transparency. Note You can also access the Shadow Menu from the Border Menu and the Image Effects Menu by pressing {SHDOW}. The following functions are provided: 152 • • Mode — enables or disables the PIP’s shadow. • V Size < % > — adjusts the shadow’s vertical size as a percentage of the PIP’s size. If {TRACK SIZE} is checked, H and V size adjust proportionally. • H Pos < % > — adjusts the shadow’s horizontal position as an offset from the base PIP image. The value represents a percentage of the PIP’s size. • V Pos < % > — adjusts the shadow’s vertical position as an offset from the base PIP image. The value represents a percentage of the PIP’s size. • Transparency — adjusts the shadow’s transparency, from 0 (full transparency) to 1024 (opaque). • • Check {TRACK SIZE} to adjust the shadow’s H Size and V Size proportionally. • Press {BORDR} to display the Border Menu. Refer to the “Border Menu” section on page 151 for details. • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. H Size < % > — adjusts the shadow’s horizontal size as a percentage of the PIP’s size. If {TRACK SIZE} is checked, H and V size adjust proportionally. Press {PIP} to return to the PIP Adjustment Menu. Refer to the “PIP Adjustment Menu Functions” section on page 149 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation PIP Adjustment Menu fã~ÖÉ=bÑÑÉÅíë=jÉåì From the PIP Adjustment Menu (or the Key Menu), press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. IMAGE EFFECTS P I P B O R D R S H D O W Monochrome Mode Off Red 100 Green 100 Blue 100 Invert Off N A V 0 Hue - - - - - - STROBE - - - - - Mode Off Interval (frames) 2 A D J RESET RGB Figure 4-54. Image Effects Menu (sample) The Image Effects Menu enables you to creatively manipulate the selected PIP or Key. Note When adjusting PIPs, you can also access the Image Effects Menu from the Border Menu or the Shadow Menu by pressing {EFX}. When adjusting Keys, you can also access the Image Effects Menu from the Key Adjustment Menu or the Matte Menu by pressing {EFX}. • Monochrome Mode — turns chroma on or off. When the mode is enabled, the image is completely monochrome. • • • Red — adjusts the image’s red saturation. Adjustment range is 0 to 100. • • Green — adjusts the image’s green saturation. Adjustment range is 0 to 100. Blue — adjusts the image’s blue saturation. Adjustment range is 0 to 100. Note The Red, Green and Blue adjustments work whether or not Monochrome Mode is enabled. Tip For a sepia tone effect, turn Monochrome Mode on, and set Red to 100, Green to 65 and Blue to 10. Invert — inverts all image colors. Hue — adjusts the image’s hue, by rotating color vectors throughout the 360 degree color spectrum. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 153 4. Menu Orientation PIP Adjustment Menu • Mode — In the “Strobe” section, enables or disables the strobe mode which when enabled, acts as a programmable freeze. • • • Interval (frames) — In the “Strobe” section, sets the freeze interval. • Press {BORDR} to display the Border Menu. Refer to the “Border Menu” section on page 151 for details. • Press {SHDOW} to display the Shadow Menu. Refer to the “Shadow Menu” section on page 152 for details. Press {RESET RGB} to reset all image colors to their default values. Press {PIP} to return to the PIP Adjustment Menu. Refer to the “PIP Adjustment Menu Functions” section on page 149 for details. Note 154 To remove any image effects from the PIP or Key, press the RESET button in the Layer Functions Section — while the Image Effects Menu is active. No other PIP parameters will be affected. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Key Menu hÉó=jÉåì The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • Key Menu Tree Key Menu Description Key Menu Functions Key Sub Menus hÉó=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the Key Menu Tree: LAYER A LAYER B KEY KEY MENU Key Type (Luma) Key Type (Color) Key Type (Cut + Fill) Invert Mode Red Color Invert Mode Clip Green Color Clip EFX MATTE SIZE & POS Image Effects Menu Matte Menu Key Adjustment Menu Gain Blue Color Gain Opacity Red Threshold Opacity Monochrome Red H Size Fill Source Green Threshold Fill Source Red Green V Size Green Blue H Pos Blue Threshold HOME Red Mask HOME Green Mask STATS Blue Mask Opacity Blue Invert STATS Hue 3 STATS Strobe Mode KEY STATS PICK COLOR RESET RGB GRAB COLOR Track Size KEY HOME KEY 3 STATS Strobe Interval STATS V Pos Track RGB EFX MATTE SIZE & POS EFX MATTE SIZE & POS Figure 4-55. Key Menu Tree All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 155 4. Menu Orientation Key Menu hÉó=jÉåì=aÉëÅêáéíáçå The figure below illustrates a sample Key Menu, when Luma key is selected: KEY H O M E S T A T S Key Type Luma Invert Mode Off Clip N A V 0 Gain 1.00 Opacity 624 Fill Source Self A D J E F X MATTE SIZE & POS Figure 4-56. Key Menu (sample) The Key Menu provides tools to adjust the “active” key. To access the menu: • • Press LAYER A or LAYER B in the Layer Control Section, then ... Press the KEY button in the Layer Function Section. hÉó=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë The available Key Menu functions change, depending upon the type of key selected. • Key Type — enables you to choose the type of key: ~ Choose between Luma or Color when the Mix Mode is enabled (Split button is off). ~ Choose between Luma, Color, or Cut + Fill when Split Mode is enabled (Split button is on). Refer to the following sections for details. • • • 156 Luma Key Functions Color Key Functions Cut + Fill Key Functions ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Key Menu iìã~=hÉó=cìåÅíáçåë A Luma (luminance) key is one in which the hole-cutting information is derived from the luminance (brightness) level of the key source. Note Luma keys can be selected on both the Layer A and Layer B keyers, in both Split and Mix modes. The following Key Menu functions are provided when Luma key is selected: • • Invert Mode — enables you to invert the key signal. Clip — adjusts the threshold of the video that electronically “cuts” into the background image. A hole will be cut into the background anywhere that foreground luminance is greater than the clip level. The hole is then filled with the Fill Source. Adjustment range is 0 to 1023. • Gain — adjusts the sensitivity of the keyer, enabling you to change the sharpness of the keyed image. Gain only affects the key hole, as set by the clip. Adjustment range is 0 to 1023.99. • Opacity — enables you to adjust the opacity of the keyed image, from fully opaque to fully transparent. Adjustment range is 0 to 1024. • Fill Source — determines the video that fills the key hole: ~ Self — fills the hole with the key source video itself, for example, the video from a character generator or logo. ~ Matte — fills the hole with a color, which can then be adjusted with the Matte Menu. • Press {STATS} to display the Status Menu. Refer to the “Status Menu” section on page 147 for details. • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. • Press {MATTE} to display the Matte Menu. Refer to the “Matte Menu” section on page 159 for details. • Press {SIZE & POS} to display the Key Adjustment Menu. Refer to the “Key Adjustment Menu” section on page 160 for details. `çäçê=hÉó=cìåÅíáçåë A Color key is one in which the hole-cutting information is derived from a specific RGB value — including luminance. Note Color keys can be selected on both the Layer A and Layer B keyers, in both Split and Mix modes. The following Key Menu functions are provided when Color key is selected: • • • • Red Color — adjusts the red component of the selected key color, from 0 to 1024. Green Color — adjusts the green component of the key color, from 0 to 1024. Blue Color — adjusts the blue component of the key color, from 0 to 1024. Red Threshold — adjusts the key’s clip along the Cyan vector (as demonstrated using a CIE color chip chart). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 157 4. Menu Orientation Key Menu • • • • • • Green Threshold — adjusts the key’s clip along the Magenta vector. • Press {STATS} to display the Status Menu. Refer to the “Status Menu” section on page 147 for details. • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. • Press {PICK COLOR} to choose the keying color visually. Once pressed, the {GRAB COLOR} label appears, and a crosshair appears on Preview. Use the Joystick to move the crosshair around the Preview monitor as desired. • Press {GRAB COLOR} to select the color directly underneath the crosshair. These values are immediately mapped into the Red, Green and Blue color fields on the menu, and can be adjusted with the knobs in the normal manner. • Press {SIZE & POS} to display the Key Adjustment Menu. Refer to the “Key Adjustment Menu” section on page 160 for details. Blue Threshold — adjusts the key’s clip along the Yellow vector Red Mask — adjusts the background mask to/from black along the Cyan vector. Green Mask — adjusts background mask to/from black along the Magenta vector. Blue Mask — adjusts background mask to/from black along the Yellow vector. Opacity — adjusts the opacity of the keyed image, from fully opaque to fully transparent. Adjustment range is 0 to 1024. `ìí=H=cáää=hÉó=cìåÅíáçåë A Cut + Fill key is one in which the hole-cutting information is provided by a Key on Layer B, while the fill information is provided by the effect on Layer A (either a PIP or a Key). Note Cut + Fill keys can only be selected on Layer B when the Split Mode is enabled. Cut + Fill functions are identical to those available when a Luma Key is selected. Refer to the “Luma Key Functions” section on page 157 for details. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Layers” section on page 226 for instructions on using all types of keys. hÉó=pìÄ=jÉåìë The following sub menus can be accessed from the Key Adjustment Menu: • • 158 Matte Menu Key Adjustment Menu ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Key Menu j~ííÉ=jÉåì From the Key Menu, press {MATTE} to display the Matte Menu. MATTE S T A T S Red 528 Green 204 Blue 260 N A V K E Y A D J E F X SIZE & POS TRACK RGB Figure 4-57. Matte Menu (sample) Note The menu (and slight variations of the menu) can also be accessed from the DSK Adjustment Menu and the BG Input Setup Menus. The menu’s “title” on the top line will change accordingly. The Matte Menu enables you to adjust the fill color of a matte key. The following functions are provided: • • • • Red — adjusts the red component of the matte fill as required, from 0 to 1024. • Press {KEY} to display the Key Menu. Refer to the “Key Menu Description” section on page 156 for details. • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. • Check {TRACK RGB} to lock RGB values together, and adjust them all simultaneously. Uncheck to unlock the values, and adjust colors individually. • Press {SIZE & POS} to display the Key Adjustment Menu. Refer to the “Key Adjustment Menu” section on page 160 for details. • • • Press {MIN} (if present) to change the highlighted color to 0. Green — adjusts the green component of the matte fill, from 0 to 1024. Blue — adjusts the blue component of the matte fill, from 0 to 1024. Press {STATS} to display the Status Menu. Refer to the “Status Menu” section on page 147 for details. Press {MAX} (if present) to change the highlighted color to 1023. Press {BLACK} (if present) to change all three colors to 0. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 159 4. Menu Orientation Key Menu hÉó=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì From the Key Menu, press {SIZE & POS} to display the Key Adjustment Menu. KEY ADJUSTMENT S T A T S K E Y H Size < 33.5% > 606 V Size < 58.3% > 448 H Position -160 V Position 64 N A V ----------------------------M A T T E Move Rate 2.0 Key Frame Effect [ N/A ] OPERATION: E F X JOY Z to SIZE. X Y TO POSITION 3 A D J TRACK SIZE Figure 4-58. Key Adjustment Menu (sample) The Key Adjustment Menu is virtually identical to the PIP Adjustment Menu — except that it pertains to Keys rather than PIPs. The following functions are provided: • H Size — adjusts the Key’s horizontal size in pixels. The “%” value indicates the key’s size as a percentage of the screen’s horizontal resolution. The numeric value is the Key’s width in pixels. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or the Joystick’s ZAxis knob. • V Size — adjusts the Key’s vertical size in pixels. The “%” value indicates the Key’s size as a percentage of the screen’s vertical resolution. The numeric value is the Key’s height in pixels. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or the Joystick’s Z-Axis knob. • H Position — indicates the Key’s position, relative to the horizontal center of the screen (00), as measured from the exact center of the Key. Thus, the value -160 is 160 pixels to the left of center. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or move the Joystick left and right. • V Position — indicates the Key’s position, relative to the vertical center of the screen (00), as measured from the exact center of the Key. Thus, the value 64 is 64 pixels above center. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or move the Joystick up and down. • Move Rate — adjusts the rate (in 0.1 second increments) for programmed Key movement, from key frame to key frame. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or twist the Joystick Z-Axis knob. • Key Frame Effect — indicates the “motion type” that is used to move the Key from point to point. Note 160 Only the Linear motion type is supported. All other key frame effects are ignored by ScreenPRO-II destinations. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Key Menu • Press {STATS} to display the Status Menu. Refer to the “Status Menu” section on page 147 for details. • Press {KEY} to display the Key Menu. Refer to the “Key Menu Description” section on page 156 for details. • Press {MATTE} to display the Matte Menu. Refer to the “Matte Menu” section on page 159 for details. • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. • At the bottom of the Key Adjustment Menu, the {TRACK SIZE} check box has the following functions: ~ Check the {TRACK SIZE} check box to lock H Size and V Size together. Regardless of the Key’s current aspect ratio, its size will adjust proportionally when the Joystick’s Z-Axis knob or the ADJ rotary knob is used to change size. ~ Uncheck the {TRACK SIZE} check box to adjust H Size or V Size individually, without affecting the other parameter. In this way, you can stretch the Key horizontally or vertically. Please note the following related functions: • To return the Key to its default size and aspect ratio, press the RESET button in the Joystick Section. • To adjust the Key with fine resolution, press the FINE ADJUST button in the Joystick Section. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 161 4. Menu Orientation Clone Setup Menu `äçåÉ=pÉíìé=jÉåì Press CLONE to display the Clone Setup Menu. CLONE SETUP P I P Destination [1] Clone Type Offset 704 Offset B O R D R N A V S H D O W A D J E F X Figure 4-59. Clone Setup Menu (sample) The Clone Menu enables you to set up parameters for a cloned layer. Please note: • • The mode can only be enabled when a widescreen destination is selected. • • Both PIPs and Keys can be cloned. The mode cannot be enabled if the PIP or Key straddles any part of the center of the overall widescreen. You can perform a Move in conjunction with a cloned layer. The following functions are provided: • • Destination — displays the currently selected destination. Clone Type — sets the type of clone “motion.” ~ PIP A Offset — both images move together with a fixed pixel offset between the two. For example, if you adjust H Position, both images move left and right. If you adjust V Position, both images move up and down. Cloned PIP A Figure 4-60. Clone Offset Mode 162 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Clone Setup Menu ~ Mirror — both images move together as if a mirror is positioned in the middle of the widescreen overlap region. For example, if you adjust H Position, both images move towards (and away from) the center of the widescreen. PIP A Cloned PIP A Figure 4-61. Clone Mirror Mode • Offset — if “Offset” is selected on the Clone Type line, this field enables you to set the offset (in pixels). If “Mirror” is selected, the field is hidden. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 163 4. Menu Orientation Crop Menu `êçé=jÉåì With a PIP or Key selected, press Crop (in the Joystick Section) to display the Crop Menu, as shown in the sample below. CROP ADJUSTMENT H O M E ALL-SIDES H Size < 53.3% > 682 V Size < 50.0% > 512 N A V - - - - Aspect Ratio - - - - S T A T S Mode 4:3 Ratio 1.333 OPERATION: JOY Z TO CROP SIZE 3 A D J TRACK SIZE Figure 4-62. Crop Menu (sample) The Crop Menu enables you crop the sides of a PIP or a Key without affecting the size of the source image. The menu works with the Top Left and Bottom Right buttons: • When Top Left is enabled, the menu adjustments only affect the top and left sides of the PIP or Key. The legend on the menu’s top line reads TOP-LEFT. • When Bottom Right is enabled, menu adjustments only affect the bottom and right sides of the PIP or Key. The legend on the top line reads BOTTOM-RIGHT. • When the Top Left and Bottom Right buttons are off, menu adjustments affect all sides of the PIP or Key. The legend on the top line reads ALL-SIDES. The following functions are provided: • H Size — adjusts the PIP or Key’s horizontal size. The “%” indicates size as a percentage of the screen’s horizontal resolution. The value is the width in pixels. • V Size — adjusts the PIP or Key’s vertical size. The “%” indicates size as a percentage of the screen’s vertical resolution. The value is the height in pixels. • Mode — in the Aspect Ratio section, this function selects one of several standard aspect ratios: 16:9, 5:4, 4:3, 3:2 and 1:1. • Ratio — displays the corresponding ratio based on the selected Mode (1.777, 1.25, 1.333, 1.500, 1.000) and enables you to select custom aspect ratios. • Enable the {TRACK SIZE} check box to proportionally crop H Size and V Size. Disable the function for individual parameter adjustments. Note 164 To remove any crop effects from the PIP or Key, press the RESET button in the Joystick Section — while the Crop Menu is active. No other parameters will be affected. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Source Adjustment Menus pçìêÅÉ=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåìë The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • Source Adjustment Menu Trees Source Adjustment Menu Description Source Adjustment Menu Functions ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 165 4. Menu Orientation Source Adjustment Menus pçìêÅÉ=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì=qêÉÉë The figure below illustrates the two Source Adjustment Menu Trees. PIP Source INPUT SOURCE ADJUSTMENT MENU BORDR SHDOW EFX Border Menu Shadow Menu Image Effects Menu KEY MATTE EFX Key Menu Matte Menu Image Effects Menu H Size V Size H Position V Position Move Rate Key Frame Effect 3 Track Size HOME SIZE & POS KEY Source KEY SOURCE ADJUSTMENT MENU H Size V Size H Position V Position Move Rate Key Frame Effect 3 Track Size STATS Figure 4-63. Source Adjustment Menu Trees All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. 166 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Source Adjustment Menus pçìêÅÉ=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì=aÉëÅêáéíáçå Two similar Source Adjustment Menus are available: • If a PIP is selected, press Source (in the Joystick Section) to display the Input Source Adjustment Menu. • If a Key is selected, press {SIZE & POS} on the Key Menu to access the Key Adjustment menu, then press Source (in the Joystick Section) to display the Key Source Adjustment Menu. Both menus are virtually identical in their functionality, with the exception of the available branches. The figure below illustrates a sample Input Source Adjustment Menu: INPUT SOURCE ADJUSTMENT H O M E B O R D R H Size < 100.0% > 640 V Size < 100.0% > 475 H Position 0 V Position 0 N A V ----------------------------S H D O W Move Rate 2.0 Key Frame Effect [ Linear ] OPERATION: E F X A D J JOY Z TO SIZE, X Y TO POSITION 3 TRACK SIZE Figure 4-64. Input Source Adjustment Menu (sample) The figure below illustrates a sample Key Source Adjustment Menu: KEY SOURCE ADJUSTMENT S T A T S K E Y H Size < 1.9% > 1280 V Size < 0.3% > 1024 H Position 0 V Position 0 N A V ----------------------------M A T T E Move Rate Key Frame Effect OPERATION: E F X JOY Z TO SIZE, X Y TO POSITION 3 2.0 [ Linear ] A D J TRACK SIZE Figure 4-65. Key Source Adjustment Menu (sample) ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 167 4. Menu Orientation Source Adjustment Menus As shown in the samples above, the two menus are virtually identical — and also virtually identical to the PIP and Key Adjustment menus. The exception is that the two Source adjustment menus pertain to the source “inside” the PIP or Key — rather than the boundaries of the PIP or Key itself. In this way, for example, a PIP can remain in its exact location on screen, but you can scale or re-position the image inside the PIP. pçìêÅÉ=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë The following Source Adjustment Menu functions are provided: • H Size — adjusts the source’s horizontal size in pixels. The “%” value indicates the source’s size as a percentage of the original PIP or Key’s horizontal resolution. The numeric value is the source’s width in pixels. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or the Joystick’s Z-Axis knob. • V Size — adjusts the source’s vertical size in pixels. The “%” value indicates the size as a percentage of the original PIP or Key’s vertical resolution. The numeric value is the source’s height in pixels. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or the Joystick’s Z-Axis knob. • H Position — indicates the source’s horizontal position, relative to its default horizontal position (00) with no offset. Thus, the value 50 is 50 pixels to the right of its default position. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or move the Joystick left and right. • V Position — indicates the source’s vertical position, relative to its default vertical position (00) with no offset. Thus, the value -10 is 10 pixels below its default position. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or move the Joystick up and down. • Move Rate — adjusts the rate (in 0.1 second increments) for programmed Key or PIP movement, from key frame to key frame. To adjust, use the ADJ knob or twist the Joystick Z-Axis knob. • Key Frame Effect — indicates the “motion type” that is used to move the PIP or Key from point to point. Note • Only the Linear motion type is supported. All other key frame effects are ignored by ScreenPRO-II destinations. At the bottom of each menu, the {TRACK SIZE} check box has the following functions: ~ Check the {TRACK SIZE} check box to lock H Size and V Size together. Regardless of the PIP or Key’s current aspect ratio, its size will adjust proportionally when the Joystick’s Z-Axis knob or the ADJ rotary knob is used to change size. ~ Uncheck the {TRACK SIZE} check box to adjust H Size or V Size individually, without affecting the other parameter. In this way, you can stretch the PIP horizontally or vertically. For Input Source Adjustments: 168 • Press {BORDR} to display the Border Menu. Refer to the “Border Menu” section on page 151 for details. • Press {SHDOW} to display the Shadow Menu. Refer to the “Shadow Menu” section on page 152 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Source Adjustment Menus • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. For Key Source Adjustments: • Press {STATS} to display the Status Menu. Refer to the “Status Menu” section on page 147 for details. • Press {KEY} to display the Key Menu. Refer to the “Key Menu Description” section on page 156 for details. • Press {MATTE} to display the Matte Menu. Refer to the “Matte Menu” section on page 159 for details. • Press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Refer to the “Image Effects Menu” section on page 153 for details. Please note the following related functions: • To return the source to its default size and aspect ratio, press the RESET button in the Joystick Section. • To adjust the source with fine resolution, press the FINE ADJUST button in the Joystick Section. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 169 4. Menu Orientation Background Input Setup Menu _~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=fåéìí=pÉíìé=jÉåì The BG (Background) Input Setup Menu enables you to set up and define background sources A and B. For each background source, you can choose between a solid matte color, a DVI input or a captured frame grab (FG). The menus change depending on the selected background “type.” To access the menu: • Press BG A or BG B in the Controller’s Layer Control Section. ~ If the selected background is already on Program, the BG Input Setup Menu will not appear. ~ If the selected background is not on Program, the menu appears. The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • • 170 Background Input Setup Menu Tree Shared Background Menu Functions Background Menu Functions — Matte Type Background Menu Functions — DVI Type Background Menu Functions — FG Type ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Background Input Setup Menu _~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=fåéìí=pÉíìé=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the Background Input Setup Menu Tree. BG A BG B BG INPUT SETUP MENU Destination ID Type (Matte) HOME Type (DVI) Format Crop: H Offset Key Type (FG) HOME Crop: V Offset MATTE SAVE HOME SAVE RESET SAVE APPLY FORMAT FORCE ACQUIRE Figure 4-66. Background Input Setup Menu Tree All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 171 4. Menu Orientation Background Input Setup Menu pÜ~êÉÇ=_~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë The figure below illustrates a sample BG Input Setup Menu, showing shared functions: BG INPUT SETUP H O M E Destination BG_A [1] Destinat ID [ All ] Type Matte N A V Figure 4-67. BG Input Setup Menu (sample) The following functions are shared — regardless of the selected background type: • • Top Line — indicates the selected background: BG_A or BG_B. • ID — displays the ID of the selected destination’s associated ScreenPRO-II. Note that with wide screen destinations, the background for each ScreenPRO-II can be individually adjusted. Destination — displays the currently selected destination. Note that different backgrounds can be assigned to different destinations. Important • 172 In a widescreen configuration, because the electronics on individual ScreenPRO-II units may not match from unit to unit, you may be required to adjust a ScreenPRO-II background individually — by first selecting a specific destination ID. Type — selects the desired background type: ~ When MATTE is selected, a solid color can be used as the background. Refer to the “Background Menu Functions — Matte Type” section on page 173 for menu details. ~ When DVI is selected, a digital graphic from a computer or other DVI source can be used as the background. Refer to the “Background Menu Functions — DVI Type” section on page 175 for menu details. ~ When FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3 is selected, a captured still frame can be used as the background source. Refer to the “Background Menu Functions — FG Type” section on page 176 for menu details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Background Input Setup Menu _~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë=Ô=j~ííÉ=qóéÉ The figure below illustrates a sample BG Input Setup Menu when “Matte” is selected as the background type. BG INPUT SETUP BG_A H O M E Destination ID [ All ] M A T T E Type Matte [1] N A V A D J S A V E Figure 4-68. BG Input Setup Menu — Matte Type (sample) The following functions are provided for a Matte background: • Press {MATTE} to display the BG Matte Menu. Refer to the “BG Matte Menu” section on page 174 for details. • Press {SAVE} to store all selected background settings. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Background Transitions” section on page 227 for operating instructions. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 173 4. Menu Orientation Background Input Setup Menu _d=j~ííÉ=jÉåì From the BG Input Setup Menu, press {MATTE} to access the BG Matte Menu. BG MATTE B A C K Red 528 Green 204 Blue 260 N A V M I N M A X A D J BLACK Figure 4-69. BG Matte Menu (sample) The Background Matte Menu enables you to create a solid background matte color to use behind your PIPs and Keys. Each ScreenPRO-II supports two separate matte colors — one for BG_A and one for BG_B. • • • • • • Red — adjusts the red component of the background matte color, from 0 to 1023. Green — adjusts the green component of the background matte, from 0 to 1023. Blue — adjusts the blue component of the background matte, from 0 to 1023. Press {MIN} to change the highlighted color to 0. Press {MAX} to change the highlighted color to 1023. Press {BLACK} to change all three colors to 0. Note The default state is a black matte color. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Background Transitions” section on page 227 for operating instructions. 174 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation Background Input Setup Menu _~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë=Ô=asf=qóéÉ The figure below illustrates a sample BG Input Setup Menu when “DVI” is selected as the background type. BG INPUT SETUP H O M E BG_A Destination [1] ID All Type Destinat Format DVI 1024 x 768 @ 60 Crop: H Offset [0] V Offset [0] R E S E T N A V A D J S A V E APPLY FORMAT FORCE ACQUIRE Figure 4-70. BG Input Setup Menu — DVI Type (sample) The following functions are provided for a DVI background: • • • • • Format — this line performs two functions: ~ Displays the resolution that is automatically determined by the FORCE ACQUIRE function. ~ Enables you to manually set the resolution of the incoming source, if desired. Once the format is selected manually with the ADJ knob, press {APPLY FORMAT} to “accept” and activate the format. For the two Crop settings: ~ If the source’s input resolution matches the output resolution, or if the output resolution is larger than the input resolution, the Crop settings will be bracketed. ~ If the input data is smaller than the output resolution, the area around the active data is set to black. ~ If the source’s input resolution is larger than the output resolution, the H Offset and V Offset values can be used to choose which portion of the background you want to display. ~ Press {RESET} to reset the H and V offsets to 0. Press {SAVE} to store all selected settings. Press {APPLY FORMAT} to “activate” the selected format. Press {FORCE ACQUIRE} to automatically detect the input signal resolution and update the display Format field accordingly. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 175 4. Menu Orientation Background Input Setup Menu _~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=jÉåì=cìåÅíáçåë=Ô=cd=qóéÉ The figure below illustrates a sample BG Input Setup Menu when a captured frame grab (FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3) is selected as the background type. BG INPUT SETUP H O M E BG_A Destination [1] ID Type All N A V FG_1 Destinat A D J S A V E Figure 4-71. BG Input Setup Menu — Frame Grab Type (sample) When FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3 is selected as the background type, a captured still frame can be used as the background. This source type cannot be selected until one or more frames have been captured. • Press {SAVE} to store all selected settings. Refer to the “Frame Grab Menu” section on page 142 for details on the Frame Grab Menu. In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Still Frames” section on page 246 for frame grab instructions. 176 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation DSK Menus aph=jÉåìë The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • DSK Menu Tree DSK Adjustment Menu DSK Input Setup Menu aph=jÉåì=qêÉÉ The figure below illustrates the DSK Menu Tree. DSK DSK ADJUSTMENT MENU INPUT SETUP Destination ID Key Type (Luma) DSK Input Setup Menu Key Type (Color) Invert Mode Red Color Clip Green Color ID Gain Blue Color DSK Input Opacity Red Threshold Fill Source Green Threshold Destination Type (None) Blue Threshold HOME Red Mask HOME Blue Mask KEY Opacity SAVE MATTE Type (FG) Format HOME Crop: H Offset Green Mask STATS Type (DVI) Crop: V Offset HOME HOME KEY STATS RESET PICK COLOR KEY SAVE SAVE APPLY FORMAT GRAB COLOR FORCE ACQUIRE Figure 4-72. DSK Menu Tree All functions and sub menus are discussed in the following sections. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 177 4. Menu Orientation DSK Menus aph=^ÇàìëíãÉåí=jÉåì The DSK Adjustment Menu provides the tools necessary to adjust the DSK (Downstream Key. To access the menu: • Press {DSK} in the Layer Control Section. The available DSK Adjustment Menu functions change, depending upon the selected “Key Type.” • When Luma is selected, you can perform a luminance DSK. Refer to the “DSK Luma Key Functions” section on page 178 for details. • When Color is selected, you can perform a color DSK. Refer to the “DSK Color Key Functions” section on page 179 for details. aph=iìã~=hÉó=cìåÅíáçåë A Luma (luminance) key is one in which the hole-cutting information is derived from the luminance (brightness) level of the key source. The figure below illustrates a sample DSK Adjustment Menu when Luma key is selected: DSK ADJUSTMENT H O M E S T A T S Key Type Luma Destination [1] ID ALL Invert Mode Off Clip 512 Gain 7.00 Opacity 512 Fill Source Matte N A V A D J INPUT SETUP MATTE Figure 4-73. DSK Adjustment Menu — Luma (sample) The following DSK Adjustment Menu functions are provided when Luma is selected as the DSK type: • • • • • 178 Destination — displays the currently selected destination. ID — displays the ID of the selected destination’s associated ScreenPRO-II. Invert Mode — enables you to invert the DSK signal. Clip — adjusts the threshold of the video that electronically “cuts” into the background image. A hole will be cut into the background anywhere that foreground luminance is greater than the clip level. The hole is then filled with the Fill Source. Adjustment range is 0 to 1023. Gain — adjusts the sensitivity of the keyer, enabling you to change the sharpness of the keyed image. Gain only affects the key hole, as set by the clip. Adjustment range is 0 to 1023.99. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation DSK Menus • Opacity — enables you to adjust the opacity of the keyed image, from fully opaque to fully transparent. Adjustment range is 0 to 1024. • Fill Source — determines the video that fills the DSK hole: ~ Self — fills the hole with the DSK source video itself, such as the video from a character generator. ~ Matte — fills the hole with a matte color, which can be adjusted with the DSK Matte Adjustment Menu. Refer to the “Matte Menu” section on page 159 for details. • Press {STATS} to display the Status Menu. Refer to the “Status Menu” section on page 147 for details. • Press {INPUT SETUP} to display the DSK Input Setup Menu. Refer to the “DSK Input Setup Menu” section on page 180 for details. aph=`çäçê=hÉó=cìåÅíáçåë A Color key is one in which the hole-cutting information is derived from a specific RGB value — including luminance. The figure below illustrates a sample DSK Adjustment Menu when Color key is selected: DSK ADJUSTMENT H O M E S T A T S Key Type Destination ID Red Color Color [1] 1 1000 Green Color 200 Blue Color 200 Red Threshold 100 Green Threshold 100 Blue Threshold 100 PICK COLOR N A V A D J INPUT SETUP Figure 4-74. DSK Adjustment Menu — Color (sample) The following DSK Adjustment Menu functions are provided when Color is selected as the DSK type: • • • • • • Destination — displays the currently selected destination. • Green Threshold — adjusts the DSK’s clip along the Magenta vector. ID — displays the ID of the selected destination’s associated ScreenPRO-II. Red Color — adjusts the red component of the DSK color, from 0 to 1024. Green Color — adjusts the green component of the DSK color, from 0 to 1024. Blue Color — adjusts the blue component of the DSK color, from 0 to 1024. Red Threshold — adjusts the DSK’s clip along the Cyan vector (as demonstrated using a CIE color chip chart). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 179 4. Menu Orientation DSK Menus • • • • • Blue Threshold — adjusts the DSK’s clip along the Yellow vector • Press {STATS} to display the Status Menu. Refer to the “Status Menu” section on page 147 for details. • Press {PICK COLOR} to choose the keying color visually. Once pressed, the {GRAB COLOR} label appears, and a crosshair appears on Preview. Use the Joystick to move the crosshair around the Preview monitor as desired. • Press {GRAB COLOR} to select the color directly under the crosshair. These values are immediately mapped into the Red, Green and Blue color fields on the menu, and can be adjusted with the knobs in the normal manner. • Press {INPUT SETUP} to display the DSK Input Setup Menu. Refer to the “DSK Input Setup Menu” section on page 180 for details. Red Mask — adjusts the background mask to/from black along the Cyan vector. Green Mask — adjusts background mask to/from black along the Magenta vector. Blue Mask — adjusts background mask to/from black along the Yellow vector. Opacity — adjusts the opacity of the keyed image, from fully opaque to fully transparent. Adjustment range is 0 to 1024. aph=fåéìí=pÉíìé=jÉåì The figure below illustrates a sample DSK Input Setup Menu: DSK INPUT SETUP H O M E Destination [1] ID 1 DSK Input K E Y 1B Type DVI Format R E S E T N A V 1024 x 768 @ 70 Crop: H Offset 0 V Offset 0 A D J S A V E APPLY FORMAT FORCE ACQUIRE Figure 4-75. DSK Input Setup Menu (sample) The following menu functions are provided: • • • 180 Destination — displays the currently selected destination. ID — displays the ID of the selected destination’s associated ScreenPRO-II. DSK Input — displays the input connector from which the DSK source is pulled. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 4. Menu Orientation DSK Menus • Type — selects the desired DSK type: ~ When None is selected, the DSK circuitry for a selected ScreenPRO-II (as chosen with the ID field), can be turned off. This selection is recommended, for example, when a DSK is only required on one of three screens (in a wide screen configuration), and when only a single head graphics card would be required for the “active” DSK source. ~ When DVI is selected, a digital graphic from a computer or other DVI source can be used as the DSK Source. Refer to the “Background Menu Functions — DVI Type” section on page 175 for menu details. Note that the functions on the Background Input Setup Menu are identical to those on the DSK Input Setup Menu when DVI is selected. ~ When FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3 is selected, a captured still image can be used as the DSK source. Refer to the “Background Menu Functions — FG Type” section on page 176 for menu details. Note that the functions on the Background Input Setup Menu are identical to those on the DSK Input Setup Menu when FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3 is selected. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 181 4. Menu Orientation LOGO Menu ildl=jÉåì The figure below illustrates a sample LOGO Menu: LOGO H O M E Destination [1] ID ALL Type N A V FG_1 Temp FG1 Info: [ FG1_T ] File Name [ 1024 x 768 ] Resolution A D J Figure 4-76. LOGO Menu (sample) The LOGO Menu enables you to select the full screen source for the panel’s LOGO button. You can choose between the three internal frame stores (FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3), or black. Because the LOGO is the highest priority layer and downstream of all other effects, the “black” source can serve as a convenient way to fade all effects to black — without changing any of the image setups underneath the LOGO. On factory reset, “black” is the default LOGO source. If you capture a frame and assign it as the LOGO source, that frame will be the default upon power up. Note To access the menu: • Press the LOGO button in the Layer Control Section. The following LOGO Menu functions are provided: • Type — enables you to select still frames FG_1, FG_2, FG_3 or Black as the LOGO source. Use the Frame Grab Menu to capture frames. Refer to the “Frame Grab Menu” section on page 142 for details. • In the Temp FG Info section: ~ File Name — displays the selected still frame’s temporary storage register. ~ Resolution — displays the resolution of the selected still frame. Once you have reviewed all of the sections in this chapter, please continue with Chapter 5, “System Setup” on page 183. 182 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide RK==póëíÉã=pÉíìé få=qÜáë=`Ü~éíÉê This chapter provides comprehensive instructions for setting up the ScreenPRO-II Controller system. The following topics are discussed: • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Setup Prerequisites System Setup Sequence System Power Up Return to Factory Default Touch Screen Calibration Programming EDID Restore from Flash Memory Card Standard Destination Setup Router Setup AUX Destination Setup Input Patching Output Format Setup Sync Setup Genlock Setup Projector Setup Background Setup Input Setup DSK Setup Procedure LOGO Setup Procedure Saving the Setup Backup to Flash Memory Card Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Once you have reviewed all of the sections in this chapter, please continue with Chapter 6, “Operations” on page 215. 183 5. System Setup Setup Prerequisites pÉíìé=mêÉêÉèìáëáíÉë Before starting to set up your ScreenPRO-II Controller system, please review the following important prerequisites: • Ensure that you are familiar with all ScreenPRO-II Controller system hardware, including all Controller sections, and the functions of all buttons within the sections. Refer to Chapter 2, “Hardware Orientation” on page 31 for details. • Ensure that hardware is properly installed, and that all sources, routers and peripherals are properly connected. Refer to Chapter 3, “Hardware Installation” on page 53 for details. • If you will be using a widescreen configuration, ensure that all “Widescreen Lock” connections to/from BlendPRO-II are properly installed. In Chapter 3, refer to the “BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections” section on page 77 for details. • Ensure that you are familiar will all ScreenPRO-II Controller menus and submenus. Refer to Chapter 4, “Menu Orientation” on page 85 for details. • Ensure that your connection charts are complete, and readily available for reference throughout this chapter. In Chapter 3, refer to the “Connection Charts” section on page 56 for details. Please note: • In this chapter, when a procedure tells you to “scroll to” a certain line, use the rotary knob labelled NAV to move the highlight. • When a procedure tells you to “adjust” or “select” a certain parameter, use the ADJ rotary knob. 674 452 N A V -34 70 0.8 [ LINEAR ] A D J Figure 5-1. Menu Navigation 184 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup System Setup Sequence póëíÉã=pÉíìé=pÉèìÉåÅÉ This section provides a top level view of the entire ScreenPRO-II Controller setup procedure, plus links to each individual procedure. Important For the optimum ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup, it is recommended that you follow all procedures in the order outlined below. Preliminary steps: 1. “ID Setup and Remote Enable,” page 186. 2. “System Power Up,” page 187. 3. “Return to Factory Default,” page 189. Next, set up all menus under the MISC heading: 4. “Touch Screen Calibration,” page 189. 5. “Programming EDID,” page 190. 6. “Restore from Flash Memory Card,” page 191. Next, set up all menus under the System heading: 7. “Standard Destination Setup,” page 192. 8. “Router Setup,” page 193. 9. “AUX Destination Setup,” page 195. 10. “Input Patching,” page 198. Next, set up all menus under the Output heading: 11. “Output Format Setup,” page 199. 12. “Sync Setup,” page 200. 13. “Genlock Setup,” page 201. 14. “Projector Setup,” page 202. Set up all background inputs and primary sources: 15. “Background Setup,” page 205. 16. “Input Setup,” page 206. 17. “DSK Setup Procedure,” page 211. 18. “LOGO Setup Procedure,” page 212. To complete your setup: 19. “Saving the Setup,” page 213. 20. “Backup to Flash Memory Card,” page 213. All of the above procedures are covered in the following sections. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 185 5. System Setup ID Setup and Remote Enable fa=pÉíìé=~åÇ=oÉãçíÉ=bå~ÄäÉ= ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 1. 1 In this procedure, you will set up individual ScreenPRO-II IDs and enable remote control. Each ScreenPRO-II in your system must have a unique ID. Use the following steps to set up ScreenPRO-II IDs and remote control: 1. On an individual ScreenPRO-II system, press {REMOTE CONTROL} on the Home Menu to access the Remote Control Menu. 2. Scroll to the Unit ID line, and select a unique ID for the ScreenPRO-II chassis. The ID range is 1 to 32. 3. Scroll to the Remote Control/DHCP line, and enable remote control and DHCP. Note 4. 186 When remote control is on, the {HOME} buttons disappears, the ScreenPRO-II’s front panel is disabled, and the unit’s IP address is dynamically assigned. All control now originates from the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s console. Repeat steps 1 through 3 for all other ScreenPRO-II units in your system. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup System Power Up póëíÉã=mçïÉê=ré= ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 2. 2 In this procedure, you will power up the entire system, and download code (if required). Use the following steps to power up your ScreenPRO-II Controller system: 1. Ensure that all individual ScreenPRO-II units are powered up. 2. Power up all routers in your system, and allows them to fully boot up. These are your devices with static IP addresses. 3. Power up the ScreenPRO-II Controller, and allow it to fully boot up. This is the system’s DHCP server. 4. If you will be using a widescreen configuration, power up the BlendPRO-II. 5. Power up all PresentationPRO-II units and ImagePRO units in your system. This sequence enables the ScreenPRO-II Controller to “serve” IP addresses to the other peripherals. 6. Power up all additional peripherals, such as monitors and projectors. 7. Check the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s Status Menu, and ensure that all devices have been recognized. By default, this menu should appear at power up. If it is not shown, press STATUS on the Home Menu. 8. Check code compatibility — when the ScreenPRO-II Controller connects to the individual devices, it automatically checks the compatibility of the code versions. ~ If the Controller’s code version matches that of the ScreenPRO-II units, PresentationPRO-II units and BlendPRO-II, the Status Menu is shown — and you do not need to download code. ~ If the message “Checksum Mismatch” appears on the Status Menu, you must download code. Please continue with the “Downloading Code” procedure on page 188. ~ If the Controller’s code version is incompatible with the code version of a ScreenPRO-II, PresentationPRO-II or BlendPRO-II (or a combination of units), all buttons will flash on the Controller console. The Status Menu is shown with the message “Please Upgrade.” Please continue with the “Downloading Code” procedure on page 188. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 187 5. System Setup System Power Up açïåäç~ÇáåÖ=`çÇÉ When an incompatibility exists between software code versions, all buttons will flash on the Controller console. In this situation, the Status Menu automatically appears with the message “Please Upgrade.” Use the following steps to download code from the Controller to the target device(s), including ScreenPRO-II, PresentationPRO-II and BlendPRO-II: 1. From the Controller’s Home Menu, press SYSTEM > {SW VER} to display the Software Version Menu. Any incompatibilities will be listed. SOFTWARE VERSION B A C K Controller 1.10 BlendPRO-II 1.10 SP 1: 1.10 SP 2: 1.00 SP 3: 1.00 SP 4: 1.10 N A V Software versions incompatible with Controller’s version ----------------------------------------Software version mismatch! A D J Download device(s) software DOWNLOAD CODE FORCE DOWNLOAD Figure 5-2. Software Version Menu (sample) 2. Press {DOWNLOAD CODE} to begin the download process, which takes several minutes to complete. During the procedure, several “progress” messages will be shown. When the entire procedure is complete, the Download Code Results Menu will display a summary of the download. Please note: • • • Results may appear on multiple pages. If required, press {PG DN} and {PG UP} to move between pages. Press {DETAILS} to view additional information for a specific download. At the conclusion of the procedure, each ScreenPRO-II, PresentationPRO-II and BlendPRO-II is running the same version of code as the Controller. 188 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Return to Factory Default oÉíìêå=íç=c~Åíçêó=aÉÑ~ìäí ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 3. 3 In this procedure, you will perform a factory reset — in order to reset all router tables and source mappings. The procedure guarantees that any previous setups and presets (e.g., those that may have been programmed by other users), do not remain in system memory. S Prerequisite — Ensure that you are familiar with the System Reset Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “System Reset Menu” section on page 111. Use the following steps to return the system to factory default values: 1. On the Home Menu, press SYSTEM to access the System Menu. 2. Press {RESET} to display the System Reset Menu. 3. On the Device line and select ALL. 4. Scroll to the Reset Type line and select FACTORY. 5. Press {RESET}. When the confirmation screen appears, press {YES} to delete all user configurations and reset the system to factory default values. qçìÅÜ=pÅêÉÉå=`~äáÄê~íáçå ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 4. 4 In this procedure, you will calibrate the Touch Screen. S Prerequisite — Ensure that you are familiar with the LCD Settings Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “LCD Settings Menu” section on page 139. Use the following steps to calibrate the Touch Screen: 1. On the Home Menu, press MISC to access the Miscellaneous Menu. 2. Press {LCD SETTINGS} to show the LCD Settings Menu. 3. Press {LCD Cal} to display the first Touch Screen Calibration Menu. 4. Follow the directions on the menu to complete the calibration procedure. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 189 5. System Setup Programming EDID mêçÖê~ããáåÖ=bafa ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 5 5 In this procedure, you will program EDID (Extended Display Identification Data), as a prerequisite for background and DSK setup. The procedure guarantees proper communications at the preferred resolution between each ScreenPRO-II’s DVI inputs and your system’s PCs. S Prerequisite — Ensure that you are familiar with the EDID DVI Input Format Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “EDID DVI Input Format Menu” section on page 137. Use the following steps to program each ScreenPRO-II’s EDID: 1. Ensure that ScreenPRO-II output format matches your projector’s native resolution. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Output Menu Functions” section on page 102 for output format information. 2. Ensure that the computer(s) or external equipment that you wish to use as background and DSK source(s) are capable of supporting the selected output resolution. 3. Ensure that all DVI inputs to each ScreenPRO-II are disconnected. 4. On the Home Menu, press MISC to access the Miscellaneous Menu. 5. Press {EDID} to display the EDID DVI Input Format Menu. 6. On the Destination line, select the individual destination who’s EDID you wish to program, or select ALL if all destinations will be using the same resolution. 7. Note the Current line, which displays the current EDID video format that resides in memory. If this format is already set to the desired resolution, no programming is required. You can exit this procedure, and continue with other setup steps. 8. If a new resolution is required, scroll to the Format line and use the ADJ knob to select the preferred EDID format. 9. Press {PROGRAM EDID}. A warning message will be shown. Press {CONTINUE} to continue with the procedure. 10. Once EDID programming is complete, reconnect each external computer and power it back on. 11. On each PC’s desktop, right-click to display the Display Properties Window. 12. Select the Settings Tab, and verify that the PC’s resolution matches that which you just programmed into EDID. If not, set the resolution as required. 13. If you selected an individual destination in step 6, repeat steps 6 through 12 for each remaining destination. 190 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Restore from Flash Memory Card oÉëíçêÉ=Ñêçã=cä~ëÜ=jÉãçêó=`~êÇ ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 6 (optional) 6 In this procedure, you will restore your system configuration from flash memory — provided that you previously backed up your system to the flash memory card. S Prerequisite — Ensure that you are familiar with the Backup/Restore Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Backup/Restore Menu” section on page 141. Use the following steps to restore your system from the flash memory card: 1. Ensure that your flash memory card is properly inserted in the Controller’s MEMORY CARD slot on the rear panel. 2. On the Home Menu, press MISC to access the Miscellaneous Menu. 3. Press {BACKUP RESTORE} to display the Backup/Restore Menu. 4. Press {CHECK CARD} to ensure that the Controller recognizes the card. 5. On the Device line, select Ctrlr+SP to perform a complete “restore.” 6. On the Controller Options line, select All. 7. On the SP to Restore line, select All. 8. Press {RESTORE} to restore the selected system configuration. At the conclusion of this procedure, your system is completely set up — exactly the way that you left it when you performed a complete system “backup.” No further setup operations are required. Please continue with system operations. Refer to Chapter 6, “Operations” on page 215 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 191 5. System Setup Standard Destination Setup pí~åÇ~êÇ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 7 7 In this procedure, you will set up the system’s “standard” destinations (single screen and widescreen) on the Controller’s Destination Bus. S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the Destination Setup Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Destination Setup Menu” section on page 117. Note Up to 4 “standard” destinations can be assigned (single screen and widescreen), but only 1 widescreen destination is allowed. Use the following steps to set up a single screen or a widescreen destination: 1. From the Home Menu, press SYSTEM to access the System Menu. 2. Press {DEST SETUP} to display the Destination Setup Menu. 3. Scroll to the Destination line and select the destination that you want to define — either 1, 2, 3 or 4. 4. Scroll to the SP to Add line and select the ID of an available ScreenPRO-II. If a ScreenPRO-II is already assigned to a destination, it will not appear in the list. Note 5. When there are no more ScreenPRO-IIs available to assign, the right-hand column displays N/A. Press {ADD} to add the highlighted ScreenPRO-II to the destination. Once added, the ID will appear in the bottom portion of the menu. Please note: ~ For a Single Screen configuration, add only one ScreenPRO-II. Repeat from step 3 to define all remaining single screen destinations. ~ For a Wide Screen configuration, add as many ScreenPRO-IIs as required — up to the maximum of 4. 6. If required, scroll to the SP to Remove line and select the ID of a ScreenPRO-II that you want to remove from the current configuration. Press {REMOVE} to clear the ScreenPRO-II from the destination. 7. Press {BACK} to return to the System Menu. Important If the ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination Menu appears after you press {BACK}, there is a termination switch problem. In Chapter 4, refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Genlock Termination Menu” section on page 119 for details. 8. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 9. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. This completes the procedure for defining single and widescreen destinations. The selected buttons on the Destination Bus are now active. 192 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Router Setup oçìíÉê=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 8 8 In this procedure, you will set up the system’s routing switchers. S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the following menus: ~ Router Specification Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Router Specification Menu” section on page 127. ~ Comm Setup Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Comm Setup Menus” section on page 129. ~ Output Patch Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Output Patch Menu” section on page 132. Use the following steps to set up your system’s routers: 1. Ensure that your router(s) are properly connected to the ScreenPRO-II Controller system. In Chapter 3, refer to the “System Installation” section on page 73. 2. For Ethernet controlled routers, ensure that your router’s protocol is supported. The list of supported manufacturers currently includes the Folsom MatrixPro series, and routers from Sierra, Extron, Leitch, Isis, DVILink and DPI. 3. For Ethernet controlled routers, ensure that you know each router’s IP address. If required, preset IP addresses at the routers themselves. Refer to each router’s User’s Guide for instructions. Please note that MatrixPRO routers default to the following IP addresses: ~ ~ MatrixPRO Analog Router: 192.168.0.241 MatrixPRO SDI Router: 192.168.0.242 4. From the Home Menu, press SYSTEM to access the System Menu. 5. Press {ROUTER SETUP} to display the Router Specification Menu. 6. On the Number line, select the number of the router that you wish to configure. 7. On the Manufacturer line, select the router manufacturer. 8. On the Router Type line, select the type of router being used. 9. On the Number of Inputs line, select the router’s input count. 10. On the Number of Outputs line, select the routers’ output count. 11. On the Communication Type line, select the type of communication that you are using to connect to the router. 12. Press {COMM SETUP} to display the appropriate Comm Setup Menu for the selected device. 13. For Ethernet controlled routers, verify that the IP Address field matches the router’s IP address. If not, use the ADJ knob in conjunction with the {NEXT IP QUAD} button to change the address as required. 14. Test communications: ~ ~ For serial and Ethernet controlled routers, press {TEST COMM}. For Lantronix devices, press {DISCOVER LTRX}. If the message “Communication Failed” appears, take the necessary actions to rectify the error and repeat this step as required. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 193 5. System Setup Router Setup 15. Press {BACK} to return to the Router Specification Menu. 16. Press {OUTPUT PATCH} to display the Output Patch Menu for the selected router. On the top line, note the router name and confirm that this is the router that you wish to patch. The table below illustrates the default output patch table (as configured after a factory reset). The table is valid for both analog and digital routers. Table 5-1. Default Output Patch Table Router Output ScreenPRO-II Input (Analog or SDI) ScreenPRO-II ID 1 1 1 2 1 2 3 2 1 4 2 2 5 3 1 6 3 2 7 4 1 8 4 2 If you have a Folsom MatrixPRO Router and you have connected the router outputs per the table above, no setup is necessary on the Output Patch Menu — unless you specifically want to patch the outputs in a different manner. This “default” configuration is ideal for most single and widescreen applications. 17. To “custom” patch router outputs, use the following steps: a. On the Router Output line, select the output that you want to patch. b. If you are uncertain about the current patch, or if you want to remove the current (existing) patch and start clean, press {DELETE PATCH}. c. On the Device ID line, select the ScreenPRO-II ID to which you want to patch the selected router output. d. On the SP Input line, select the specific ScreenPRO-II input to which you want to patch the selected router output. e. Press {ADD PATCH} to confirm your changes. The new “mapping” appears on the menu. f. Repeat step 17 to patch additional outputs. 18. To designate a router output as an “Aux” output: a. On the Router Output line, select the specific router output that you want to designate as an Aux output. b. If you are uncertain about the current patch, or if you want to remove the current (existing) patch and start clean, press {DELETE PATCH}. c. On the Device ID line, select None. d. Press {ADD PATCH} to confirm the change. e. Repeat step 18 to designate additional Aux outputs. 19. Press {BACK} to return to the Router Specification Menu. 194 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup AUX Destination Setup 20. Repeat from step 6 for the next router that you wish to assign. 21. When you have configured all of your system’s routers, on the Router Specification Menu, scroll to the Number line, and scan through the remaining router numbers. Other than the ones which you just assigned, if there are any router numbers that do not say <EMPTY> on the Number line, press {DELETE ROUTER} to remove the specification from the system. 22. Press {BACK} to return to the System Menu. 23. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 24. Press SAVE to save the current configuration. ^ru=aÉëíáå~íáçå=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 9 9 In this procedure, you will set up the system’s Aux (Auxiliary) destinations. S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the following menus: ~ Destination Setup Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Destination Setup Menu” section on page 117. ~ Aux Destination Setup Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Aux Destination Setup” section on page 120. Note Up to 4 “Aux” destinations can be assigned. These are accessible by pressing the red DEST AUX button. The following topics are discussed: • • • Aux Destination Overview Aux Destination Setup ImagePRO or PrePRO-II Aux Destination Setup ^ìñ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=lîÉêîáÉï The ScreenPRO-II Controller system provides three types of Aux destinations — Aux, ImagePRO Aux and PrePRO-II Aux. Each type of destination can be switched from the ScreenPRO-II Controller by selecting it on the Destination Bus, then selecting the desired source on the Source Selection Bus. • An Aux destination is the output of a router, which is typically connected directly to a monitor — rather than to the ScreenPRO-II. This type of destination is single format (e.g., an analog monitor can only accept signals from an analog router). • An ImagePRO Aux destination is an external ImagePRO, a multi-format processor with three inputs (one analog, one SDI and one DVI) and the ability to scale these inputs to one common output format. Typically, the ImagePRO output is connected to another display device such as a monitor or projector. • A PrePRO-II Aux destination is an external PresentationPRO-II, a multi-format processor with nine inputs (eight analog and one SDI), and the ability to scale these inputs to one common output format. Similar to ImagePRO, the PrePRO-II output is connected to another display device such as a monitor or projector. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 195 5. System Setup AUX Destination Setup ^ìñ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=pÉíìé This section provides instructions for setting up an Aux destination. Use the following steps to set up an Aux destination: 1. Ensure that your have properly configured one (or more) router outputs as “Aux” outputs. If not, refer to the “Router Setup” section on page 193 for instructions. 2. From the Home Menu, press SYSTEM to access the System Menu. 3. Press {DEST SETUP} to display the Destination Setup Menu. 4. On the Destination line, select the Aux destination that you want to define — either Aux 1, Aux 2, Aux 3 or Aux 4. 5. Scroll to the Type line and select Aux. 6. Press {AUX SETUP} to display the Aux Setup Menu. 7. On the Source Mapping line, two choices are available: ~ Select Input Patch if you want to map Aux sources according to how inputs are patched to buttons on the Source Selection bus. Note that this is the typical choice. ~ Select Direct Map if you want the Source Selection bus to be a 1:1 mapping of your router inputs — for this Aux destination only. 8. On the Router Name line, select the router on which you configured the Aux output(s). 9. On the Router Output line, select the specific router output that you wish to designate as the Aux destination. Note that only outputs configured as “Aux” will appear in the list. 10. Press {BACK} to return to the Destination Setup Menu. 11. Repeat from step 4 to configure additional Aux outputs. 12. Press {BACK} to return to the System Menu. 13. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 14. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. This completes the procedure for defining Aux destinations. The selected button(s) on the Destination Bus are now active. fã~ÖÉmol=çê=mêÉmolJff=^ìñ=aÉëíáå~íáçå=pÉíìé This section provides instructions for setting up an ImagePRO Aux or PrePRO-II Aux destination. Use the following steps to set up an ImagePRO or PrePRO-II Aux destination: 196 1. Ensure that your have properly configured one (or more) router outputs as “Aux” outputs. If not, refer to the “Router Setup” section on page 193 for instructions. 2. From the Home Menu, press SYSTEM to access the System Menu. 3. Press {DEST SETUP} to display the Destination Setup Menu. 4. On the Destination line, select the Aux destination that you want to define — either Aux 1, Aux 2, Aux 3 or Aux 4. 5. Scroll to the Type line and select ImagePRO Aux or PrePRO-II Aux. 6. Press {AUX SETUP} to display the Aux Setup Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup AUX Destination Setup 7. On the Source Mapping line, two choices are available: ~ Select Input Patch if you want to map Aux sources according to how inputs are patched to buttons on the Source Selection bus. Note that this is the typical choice. ~ Select Direct Map if you want the Source Selection bus to be a 1:1 mapping of your router inputs — for this Aux destination only. 8. On the ID line, select the ID of the ImagePRO or PrePRO-II to which you want to route Aux sources. 9. In the Analog section: a. On the Analog Router Name line, select the router from which analog sources will be routed to the ImagePRO (or PrePRO-II). b. On the Analog Router Output line, select the specific router output that you designated as an Aux output. c. On the ImagePRO Input (or PrePRO-II Input) line, select the ImagePRO or PrePRO-II input to which the analog router output is connected. 10. In the SDI section: a. On the SDI Router Name line, select the router from which SDI sources will be routed to the ImagePRO (or PrePRO-II). b. On the SDI Router Output line, select the specific router output that you designated as an Aux output. c. On the ImagePRO Input (or PrePRO-II Input) line, select the ImagePRO or PrePRO-II input to which the SDI router output is connected. 11. In the DVI section (applies to ImagePRO Aux destinations only): a. On the DVI Router Name line, select the router from which DVI sources will be routed to the ImagePRO. b. On the DVI Router Output line, select the specific router output that you designated as an Aux output. c. On the ImagePRO Input line, select the ImagePRO input to which the DVI router output is connected. 12. Press {BACK} to return to the Destination Setup Menu. 13. Repeat from step 4 to configure another ImagePRO or PrePRO-II Aux destination. 14. Press {BACK} to return to the System Menu. 15. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 16. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. This completes the procedure for defining ImagePRO or PrePRO-II Aux destinations. The selected button(s) on the Destination Bus are now active. Please note: • For proper operation, ImagePRO and PrePRO-II devices must be connected to the ScreenPRO-II Controller via Ethernet. • ImagePRO and PrePRO-II output setups must be performed locally on the units themselves. • Only one router of each type (Analog, DVI and SDI) can be connected to an ImagePRO unit. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 197 5. System Setup Input Patching fåéìí=m~íÅÜáåÖ ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 10 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the Input Source Patch 10 Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Input Source Patch Menu” section on page 125. In this procedure, you will associate (patch) specific router inputs to specific source buttons on the ScreenPRO-II Controller, and assign tally connections as desired. Important You may not need to change the input patches if you want to use those already contained in the default Input Patch Table. The ScreenPRO-II Controller creates a unique “Input Patch Table” for each default router. After a factory reset, the table defaults to the following settings: Table 5-2. Default input patch table after factory reset Router Number Router Name Router Type Router Input Sources: Map to Controller Sources: Tally 1 MatrixPRO1 Analog 1 - 16 1 - 16 1 - 8 defined only 2 MatrixPRO2 SDI Undefined Undefined Undefined You may elect to use the “automatic” patches as shown above, or you can create custom patches as required for specific input configurations. Tip The same router input can be patched to one (or more) source numbers. For example, if you want to use a DVD player in both 16:9 and 4:3 formats, patch it to inputs 8 and 16 (the shifted source 8). Using the input setup procedure, set up each input for the desired aspect ratio. Use the following steps to patch router inputs: 1. From the Home Menu, press SYSTEM to display the System Menu. 2. Press {INPUT PATCH} to display the Input Source Patch Menu. 3. On the Source Number line, select the source button on the Controller that you want to patch. 4. On the Connection Type line, select the method by which the source is connected: ~ ~ ~ 5. 198 Select a router by name (e.g., MatrixPRO), or ... Select an individual ScreenPRO-II ID, or ... Select “ALL SP” to assume connections from D/As to similar inputs on all ScreenPRO-IIs in your configuration. If you selected a router, on the Router Input line, select the physical router input that you wish to associate with the Controller’s source number. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Output Format Setup 6. If you selected an individual ScreenPRO-II ID or ALL SP, on the ScreenPRO-II Input line, select the specific input connector on the ScreenPRO-II. 7. On the Tally Number line, select the tally that you want to associate with the source button. 8. Press {ADD PATCH} to confirm your changes. 9. Repeat the procedure from step 3 to patch additional Controller buttons. 10. (Optional) If required, press {DELETE PATCH} to clear all registers for a selected Controller input. This enables you to start again with an “undefined” patch. 11. Press {BACK} to return to the System Menu. 12. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 13. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. Important If you elect to use tallies, the optional Tally board must be installed, and relay connections must be run to the devices that you wish to tally. In Appendix A, refer to the “Tally Connector” section on page 262 for connector pinouts. lìíéìí=cçêã~í=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 11 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the Output Menu. In 11 Chapter 4, refer to the “Output Menu Functions” section on page 102. In this procedure, you will configure the output format for each ScreenPRO-II that is used in your ScreenPRO-II Controller system. Important Be sure to select your projector’s native resolution and a frame rate that is consistent with your inputs — for example, if you are using 59.94 NTSC video inputs, run the output at the same rate in order to be synchronous. Use the following steps to set up the ScreenPRO-II output format: 1. From the Home Menu, press OUTPUT to display the Output Menu. 2. On the Destination Bus, select the destination that you want to configure. 3. On the Format line, select the resolution and frame rate at which you want to drive the destination’s projector(s). To minimize synchronization problems, select a frame rate that is consistent with your input sources. 4. Press {APPLY FORMAT} to accept the selection. 5. Repeat from step 2 to set additional destination output formats. 6. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 7. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 199 5. System Setup Sync Setup póåÅ=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 12 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the Settings Menu. In 12 Chapter 4, refer to the “Settings Menu” section on page 104. In this procedure, you will set up sync parameters for the monitors and projectors connected to the system — for the destination selected on the Output Menu. Note It is recommended that you leave the sync parameters at their default (factory reset) values. However, should you need to adjust individual settings for a particular monitor and projector configuration, use the following procedure. Use the following steps to set up sync parameters: 1. From the Home Menu, press OUTPUT to display the Output Menu. 2. On the Destination Bus, select the destination that you want to configure. 3. Press {SETTINGS} to display the Settings Menu. 4. On the Output Monitor line, select the device(s) that are affected by the sync settings — All, Preview, SPII Program or BPII Program. 5. On the Sync Out line, set the desired sync value — +H+V, -H-V, +H-V, -H+V or CSync. 6. On the SOG line, select a specific “sync on green” signal — Off, Standard or TriLevel (for certain HD devices). 7. On the Gamma line, set the output gamma for the selected destination. Important 8. On the Raster Box Size line, set the size of the raster box that appears around PIPs and Keys. Note 9. It is recommended that you leave Gamma at the unity setting (1.0). Change the value only if you need to compensate for a gamma problem in your projector or monitor. As required, you can change the Raster Box value during operations without affecting sync settings. Press {BACK} to return to the Output Menu. 10. Repeat from step 2 to set sync parameters for additional destinations. 11. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 12. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. 200 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Genlock Setup dÉåäçÅâ=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 13 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the Genlock Menu. In 13 Chapter 4, refer to the “Genlock Menu” section on page 103. In this procedure, you will set up Genlock for each destination selected on the Output Menu. Please note: • For Single Screen Destinations — if you elect to connect an external genlock signal to ScreenPRO-II (and loop that signal from chassis to chassis), use this procedure to select the genlock “type” and verify the current setting of each ScreenPRO-II’s Termination Switch. • For Widescreen Destinations — if you elect to connect an external genlock signal to BlendPRO-II, use this procedure to select the genlock “type.” Important For Widescreen destinations, the Widescreen Lock and External Genlock signals must be set according to the procedures outlined in Chapter 3, in the “BlendPRO-II Widescreen Lock Connections” section on page 77. Use the following steps to set up Genlock: 1. From the Home Menu, press OUTPUT to display the Output Menu. 2. On the Destination Bus, select the destination that you want to configure. 3. Press {GLCK} to display the Genlock Menu. 4. For all types of destinations, on the Source line, set the genlock source, either Black Burst, CSync or None. 5. For single screen destinations only, on the Termination line, verify the setting of the ScreenPRO-II’s Termination Switch. 6. Press {BACK} to return to the Output Menu. 7. Repeat from step 2 to set additional destination genlock types. 8. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 9. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 201 5. System Setup Projector Setup mêçàÉÅíçê=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 14 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the following menus and 14 applications: ~ Test Pattern Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Test Pattern Menu” section on page 105. ~ Wide Screen Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Wide Screen Settings Menu” section on page 106. ~ Configurator Application. You can use the Configurator application to assist with wide screen setup. The software is available via download from the website, or contact Barco Technical Support. In Appendix B, refer to the “Contact Information” section on page 268 for information. In this section, you will set up your projectors for both single screen and widescreen destinations. The following procedures are provided: • • Single Screen Projector Setup Wide Screen Projector Setup páåÖäÉ=pÅêÉÉå=mêçàÉÅíçê=pÉíìé Use the following steps to set up a projector for a single screen destination: 1. From the Home Menu, press OUTPUT to display the Output Menu. 2. On the Destination Bus, select the destination whose projector you want to configure. 3. Press {TEST PATTERN} to display the Test Pattern Menu. 4. On the Output Monitor line, select the output(s) on which you want a test pattern to appear — All, Preview, SPII Program or BPII Program. 5. On the Mode line, select On. 6. On the Type line, select the Burst test pattern. 7. On the Raster Box line, select On. 8. At the projector itself, perform the following adjustments to ensure that the output data from the selected device is properly displayed: ~ ~ 9. Adjust the image for a minimum amount of noise. Adjust the pixel clock for proper image position, such that the entire Raster Box is visible. On the Type line, select one of the many Gray Scale test patterns, as desired. 10. At the projector itself, adjust color balance, brightness and contrast. Important Refer to your projector’s technical manual for information on all projector setup and adjustment procedures. 11. Once the projector is properly set, turn Off both the Raster Box and the Mode. 12. Press {BACK} to return to the Output Menu. 202 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Projector Setup 13. Repeat from step 2 for additional single screen destination projector setups. 14. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 15. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. táÇÉ=pÅêÉÉå=mêçàÉÅíçê=pÉíìé Use the following steps to set up projectors for a wide screen application. Note 1. This procedure affects all projectors assigned to the selected wide screen configuration. If you elected to use the Configurator application to assist with your widescreen setup parameters, ensure that you have completed the following steps: a. On the Configurator’s Show Layout Tab, click the radio buttons for the ScreenPRO-II Controller and your desired show layout. b. On the Configurator’s Screen Details Tab, click the large “W” to display the Wide Screen Parameters Window. c. In the Wide Screen Parameters Window, enter your screen’s H and V dimensions and the number of projectors. d. Click Calculate to determine the required overlap. e. Make a note of these values. You will transfer them to the Controller’s Wide Screen Settings Menu in the following steps. 2. From the Home Menu, press OUTPUT to display the Output Menu. 3. On the Destination Bus, select your system’s wide screen destination. 4. Press {TEST PATTERN} to display the Test Pattern Menu. 5. On the Output Monitor line, select the output(s) on which you want a test pattern to appear — All, Preview, SPII Program or BPII Program. 6. On the Mode line, select On. 7. On the Type line, select the Burst test pattern. 8. On the Raster Box line, select On. 9. Press {BACK} to return to the Output Menu. 10. Press {WIDE SCREEN} to display the Wide Screen Settings Menu. Note that the Total Projectors line shows the total number of ScreenPRO-II units that you defined in the wide screen configuration (on the Destination Setup Menu). 11. Scroll to the Total H Res line and enter the total number of horizontal pixels in the overall wide screen display. 12. Scroll to the Background Format line and select the method by which your background graphics were originally produced: Edge-butted or Overlapped. 13. Scroll to the Marker Mode line and enable (or disable) the system’s wide screen markers, to show the boundaries of active data. Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide As required, you can change the Marker Mode value during operations without affecting other wide screen settings. 203 5. System Setup Projector Setup 14. Scroll to the Overlap Width line and enter the desired overlap (in pixels) between projectors. 15. Scroll to the Data Doubling line and enable or disable data doubling as required for your configuration. 16. Scroll to the Justification line and set the desired wide screen justification, either Center or Left. 17. In the Feathering section, scroll to the Mode line and enable or disable edge feathering as required for your configuration. 18. Scroll to the Gamma line and set the gamma for the feathered regions as desired. The default value is 2.2. 19. At each projector, perform the following adjustments to ensure that the output data is properly displayed: ~ ~ Adjust the images for a minimum amount of noise. Adjust the pixel clocks for proper image position, such that the entire Raster Box is visible. 20. Press {BACK} to return to the Output Menu. 21. Press {TEST PATTERN} to display the Test Pattern Menu. 22. On the Type line, select one of the many Gray Scale test patterns, as desired. 23. At each projector, adjust color balance, brightness and contrast. Important Refer to your projector’s technical manual for information on all projector setup and adjustment procedures. 24. Once each projector is properly set, scroll to the Alignment Test Pattern line and enable the function. This special test pattern allows you to perform projector lens shift and registration adjustments. a. At each projector, perform lens shift and registration adjustments. b. If required, adjust the horizontal and vertical “totals” to match those entered on the Wide Screen Settings Menu. Note Refer to your projector’s technical manual for information on all lens shift and registration procedures. c. When adjustments are complete, turn off the Alignment Test Pattern. 25. Press {BACK} to return to the Output Menu. 26. Press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 27. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. 204 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Background Setup _~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 15 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the following menus: 15 ~ Background Input Setup Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Background Input Setup Menu” section on page 170. ~ BG Matte Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “BG Matte Menu” section on page 174. In this procedure, you will set up the Controller’s two “background” sources (for the BG A and BG B buttons). Remember that each button can be configured as a live DVI input, as a matte color, or as a frame grab. Note In both single and widescreen modes, remember that BG B and the DSK are mutually exclusive. This occurs because the BG/DSK Input B is shared between the DSK and BG B on all individual ScreenPRO-II units. Use the following steps to set up your background sources: 1. Determine how you would like to configure your background and DSK sources. As a recommendation, the following configuration is typically used: ~ ~ The BG A input is configured as a live DVI source. The BG/DSK Input B is used primarily as the DSK source, and secondarily as a background frame grab source. 2. On the Destination Bus, select the destination whose background sources you want to configure. 3. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, press BG A to display the Background Input Setup Menu. 4. To configure a matte background: 5. a. Scroll to the Type line and select Matte. b. Press {MATTE} to display the BG Matte Menu. c. Adjust the matte color as desired. d. Press {BACK} to return to the Background Input Setup Menu. e. Press {SAVE}. To configure a live DVI background: a. Ensure that your DVI source (PC) is properly connected to the ScreenPRO-II chassis, and that the PC is turned on. b. Ensure that EDID is properly set. If not, refer to the “Programming EDID” section on page 190 for details. c. Scroll to the Type line and select DVI. d. Press {FORCE ACQUIRE}. e. Press {SAVE}. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 205 5. System Setup Input Setup 6. To configure a frame grab background: a. Ensure that you have captured a still frame, either from a live DVI background or from one of the two layers (LAYER A or LAYER B). In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Still Frames” section on page 246 for instructions. b. Scroll to the Type line and select FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3. c. Press {SAVE}. 7. Repeat from step 3 for BG B. 8. Repeat from step 2 for the next destination’s background sources that you want to configure. 9. When all background sources have been configured for all destinations, press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 10. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. fåéìí=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 16 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the Input Menu. In 16 Chapter 4, refer to the “Input Menu” section on page 88. In these procedures, you will set up the system’s inputs, and adjust phase and color balance for wide screen configurations only. The following procedures are provided: • • Standard Input Setup Widescreen Phase and Color Balance Setup pí~åÇ~êÇ=fåéìí=pÉíìé Use the following steps to set up inputs. This procedure applies to both single screen and widescreen destinations. 206 1. On the Destination Bus, select the destination whose inputs you want to configure. 2. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, select a layer (LAYER A or LAYER B). 3. Press {HOME} to display the Home Menu. 4. Press INPUT to display the Input Menu. 5. On the Source Selection Bus, select the first source that you want to set up. 6. Press {FORCE ACQUIRE} to perform the optimum image setup. 7. Perform additional setups on the Input Menu — if required: a. If you need to manually set the resolution, scroll to the Format line and select the desired format. Press {APPLY FORMAT} to accept. b. Scroll to the Sampling Mode line and set the sampling mode. c. Scroll to the Contrast line and set the input’s contrast. d. Scroll to the Brightness line and set the input’s brightness. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Input Setup 8. 9. e. Scroll to the Gamma line and set the input gamma. f. Scroll to the Input Sync Type line and set the type of sync used by the selected source. g. Scroll to the Pulldown Compensation line and enable (or disable) the mode. h. Scroll to the Sync Slice <mv> line and adjust as required. i. Scroll to the Sharpness line and set the input’s sharpness. j. Press {SAVE} to save the input configuration. Perform additional setups on the Aspect Ratio Menu — if required: a. Press {AR} to display the Aspect Ration Menu. b. Adjust the Mode and Ratio as required. c. Press {SAVE} to save the input configuration. d. Press {BACK} to return to the Input Menu. Perform additional setups on the Sizing Menu — if required: a. Press {SIZING} to display the Sizing Menu. b. If 1:1 Sampling was selected: • Scroll to the Clock Phase line and set the system’s A/D converter. • Scroll to the H Total line and set the total pixel count per line. • Scroll to the H Active line and set the width of the active area. • Scroll to the H Position line and set the start of the active area’s horizontal offset from H sync. • Scroll to the V Active line and set the number of vertical lines in the image. • Scroll to the V Position line and set the start of the active area’s vertical offset from V sync. c. • Press {SAVE} to save the input configuration. • Press {BACK} to return to the Input Menu. If Oversample was selected: • Scroll to the Right Edge line and adjust as required. • Scroll to the Left Edge line and adjust as required. • Scroll to the Top Edge line and adjust as required. • Scroll to the Bottom Edge line and adjust as required. • Press {SAVE} to save the input configuration. • Press {BACK} to return to the Input Menu. 10. Perform additional setups on the Color Balance Menu — if required: a. Press {COLOR BALANCE} to display the Color Balance Menu. b. If an RGB source was selected: • Scroll to the Red Contrast line and adjust as required. • Scroll to the Red Brightness line and adjust as required. • Scroll to the Green Contrast line and adjust as required. • Scroll to the Green Brightness line and adjust as required. • Scroll to the Blue Contrast line and adjust as required. • Scroll to the Blue Brightness line and adjust as required. • Press {SAVE} to save the input configuration. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 207 5. System Setup Input Setup • c. Press {BACK} to return to the Input Menu. If a Composite, S-Video or YPbPr source was selected: • • • • Scroll to the Saturation line and adjust as required. Scroll to the Hue line and adjust as required. Press {SAVE} to save the input configuration. Press {BACK} to return to the Input Menu. 11. Repeat from step 5 for the next source that you want to set up. 12. When all sources have been set up for this destination, press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 13. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. Important You do not have to repeat the input setup procedure for your other destinations if either of the following criteria are met: • Your other destinations use sources that are patched to the same router. • Your other destinations are configured using the “ALL SP” function on the Input Source Patch Menu. In this case, all other system destinations will automatically receive input configuration files via the system’s “copy down” functionality. You do have to repeat the input setup procedure if either of the following criteria are met: • • Your other destinations use a different router. Your other destinations use unique input patching. 14. If required, repeat the entire procedure from step 1 for other destinations. 208 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Input Setup táÇÉëÅêÉÉå=mÜ~ëÉ=~åÇ=`çäçê=_~ä~åÅÉ=pÉíìé This section provides instructions for phase and color balance setup for wide widescreen destinations utilizing BlendPRO-II. Please note the following important points: • For the optimum setup, it is highly recommended that you can output a test pattern from each source — however, you can make adjustments using a live image if necessary. For example, if the source is a PC, the best results can be achieved when a full screen test pattern can be generated on the desktop. • A test pattern application is available on the website (http://video.folsom.com). Click Downloads, select BlendPRO from the drop-down list, then download the Alignment Patterns application. • • The following “phase adjustment” steps apply to RGB and YUV analog sources. • The following adjustment steps are not required for digital sources. The following “color balance” steps apply to all types of analog sources — RGB, YUV, Composite and S-Video. Note These adjustments are primarily visual, rather than precisely numerical. Here, for each destination, you are visually matching sources across your system’s scalers. mÜ~ëÉ=^ÇàìëíãÉåíë Use the following steps to set up phase for widescreen destinations — for RGB and YUV sources only. 1. Ensure that you have performed the “standard” setups for your sources. If not, refer to the “Standard Input Setup” section on page 206 for details. 2. From the Home Menu, press SYSTEM to display the System Menu. 3. Turn the Modify Layers on Program function to On. 4. On the Destination Bus, select your widescreen destination. 5. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, select LAYER A. 6. On the Source Selection Bus, select the first source that you want to set up. 7. Press PIP to display the PIP Adjustment Menu. 8. Ensure that the image’s border and shadow are turned off. Use the Border Menu and Shadow Menu as required. 9. (Recommended) Output a Burst test pattern from the selected source. 10. On the PIP Adjustment Menu, use H Size and V Size to size the PIP such that that it matches the input’s resolution. In this way, there will be no scaling. 11. Press AUTO TRANS to transition the PIP to program. This will ensure that you can make your adjustments with data doubling and edge feathering visible. 12. Using the H Position function, move the PIP into the screen 1 region. 13. Press HOME > INPUT > {SIZING} to display the Sizing Menu for the source. 14. On the Destination line, select the “screen 1” destination. 15. Adjust Clock Phase for the cleanest and brightest image. 16. If required, adjust H Position so that all of the image’s pixels are visible. 17. Press PIP to display the PIP Adjustment Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 209 5. System Setup Input Setup 18. Press {SAVE} to save the input configuration. 19. Move the PIP into the next screen’s region. 20. Repeat steps 13 through 19 for all remaining widescreen destinations. 21. When complete, clear the layer and transition it off program. 22. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, select LAYER B. 23. Repeat the entire procedure from step 6 — for the same source. 24. When you have completed setting up the first source for both layers, repeat the entire procedure from step 5 — for all remaining RGB and YUV sources that you want to set up. Ensure that you set up both layers for each source. `çäçê=_~ä~åÅÉ=^ÇàìëíãÉåíë The following steps are a continuation of the complete widescreen source setup procedure. Use the following steps to set up color balance for widescreen destinations — for all types of analog sources — RGB, YUV, Composite and S-Video. 25. (Recommended) Output a Gray Steps test pattern from the selected source. 26. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, select LAYER A. 27. On the Source Selection Bus, select the first source that you want to set up. 28. Press PIP to display the PIP Adjustment Menu. 29. Scale the source such that it spans all screens in your widescreen configuration. 30. Press AUTO TRANS to transition the PIP to program. This will ensure that you can make your adjustments with data doubling and edge feathering visible. 31. Press HOME > INPUT to display the Input Menu for the source. 32. Visually, find the pair of adjacent destinations that most closely match each other across your widescreen blend regions. Select one of these as your “reference” destination and the other as your first “adjustment” destination. 33. On the Destination line, select the first “adjustment” destination. 34. Adjust the source as follows: a. On the Input Menu, adjust Brightness and Contrast to visually match the “reference” destination. b. On the Color Balance Menu, adjust Red, Green, and Blue values to visually match the “reference” destination. If a Composite or S-Video source was selected, adjust Saturation and Hue. c. Press {SAVE} to save the input configuration. 35. On the Destination line, select the next adjacent destination and repeat step 34 — matching Brightness, Contrast and Color Balance across the blend region. 36. Repeat step 35 for all remaining destinations. 37. When complete, clear the layer and transition it off program. 38. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, select LAYER B. 39. Repeat the entire procedure from step 27 — for the same source. 40. When you have completed adjusting color balance for the first source for both layers, repeat the entire procedure from step 26 — for all remaining RGB, YUV, Composite and S-Video sources that you want to set up. Ensure that you set up both layers for each source. 210 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup DSK Setup Procedure aph=pÉíìé=mêçÅÉÇìêÉ ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 17 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the following menus: 17 ~ DSK Adjustment Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “DSK Adjustment Menu” section on page 178. ~ DSK Input Setup Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “DSK Input Setup Menu” section on page 180. In this procedure, you will set up the system’s DSK. Remember that the DSK can be configured as a live DVI input or as a frame grab. Note In both single and widescreen modes, remember that BG B and the DSK are mutually exclusive. This occurs because the BG/DSK Input B is shared between the DSK and BG B on all individual ScreenPRO-II units. Use the following steps to set up your DSK source: 1. Determine how you would like to configure your background and DSK sources. As a recommendation, the following configuration is typically used: ~ ~ The BG A input is configured as a live DVI source. The BG/DSK Input B is used primarily as the DSK source, and secondarily as a background frame grab source. 2. On the Destination Bus, select the destination whose DSK source you want to configure. 3. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, press DSK to display the DSK Adjustment Menu. 4. Press {INPUT SETUP} to display the DSK Input Setup Menu. 5. To configure a live DVI input as the DSK: 6. 7. a. Ensure that your DVI source (PC) is properly connected to the ScreenPRO-II chassis, and that the PC is turned on. b. Ensure that EDID is properly set. If not, refer to the “Programming EDID” section on page 190 for details. c. Scroll to the Type line and select DVI. d. Press {FORCE ACQUIRE}. e. Press {SAVE}. To configure a frame grab DSK: a. Ensure that you have captured a still frame, either from a live DVI background or from one of the two layers (LAYER A or LAYER B). In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Still Frames” section on page 246 for instructions. b. Scroll to the Type line and select FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3. c. Press {SAVE}. Press {KEY} to return to the DSK Adjustment Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 211 5. System Setup LOGO Setup Procedure 8. On the Key Type line, select the type of key desired (Luma or Color). 9. Adjust key parameters as required: ~ For a Luma Key, adjust Invert Mode, Clip, Gain, Opacity and Fill Source for the optimum visual key. ~ For a color key, pick the desired color, then adjust Red, Green and Blue Color, Threshold, Mask and Opacity. 10. When your DSK is fully adjusted, press {HOME} to return to the Home Menu. 11. Press {SAVE} to save the new system configuration in memory. ildl=pÉíìé=mêçÅÉÇìêÉ ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 18 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the LOGO Menu. In 18 Chapter 4, refer to the “LOGO Menu” section on page 182. In this procedures, you will set up the system’s LOGO. Remember that the LOGO can be configured as black or as a frame grab. Use the following steps to set up the LOGO: 1. On the Destination Bus, select the destination whose LOGO you want to configure. 2. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller console, press LOGO to display the LOGO Menu. 3. To configure a black LOGO: a. 4. 212 Scroll to the Type line and select Black. To configure a frame grab LOGO: a. Ensure that you have captured a still frame, either from a live DVI background or from one of the two layers (LAYER A or LAYER B). In Chapter 6, refer to the “Working with Still Frames” section on page 246 for instructions. b. Scroll to the Type line and select FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 5. System Setup Saving the Setup p~îáåÖ=íÜÉ=pÉíìé ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 19 19 When all system setup procedures have been complete, press {HOME} to display the Home Menu, then press {SAVE}. This action saves the state of the Controller in nonvolatile memory. Once pressed, the Touch Screen menu reads “Saving System Configuration.” If you cycle power, the Controller will return to its state at the time of the “save.” _~Åâìé=íç=cä~ëÜ=jÉãçêó=`~êÇ ScreenPRO-II Controller system setup: Step 20 S Prerequisites — Ensure that you are familiar with the Backup/Restore 20 Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Backup/Restore Menu” section on page 141. In this procedure, you will back up your system configuration to a Flash Memory Card. Note You can only store one system configuration on a Flash Memory Card. Use the following steps to back up your system: 1. Ensure that you have a (customer supplied) Flash Memory Card available. 2. Insert the Flash Memory Card into the Controller’s rear panel Memory Card slot. 3. From the Home Menu, press MISC to display the Miscellaneous Menu. 4. Press {BACKUP RESTORE} to display the Backup/Restore Menu. 5. On the Device line, select Ctrlr+SP to perform a complete “backup.” 6. On the Controller Options line, select All. 7. Press {CHECK CARD} to check for the presence of a Flash Memory Card. 8. Press {BACKUP} to perform a backup operation to the Flash Memory Card using the selected device(s) and options. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 213 5. System Setup Backup to Flash Memory Card 214 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide SK==léÉê~íáçåë få=qÜáë=`Ü~éíÉê This chapter includes operational instructions for all ScreenPRO-II Controller modes and functions. The following topics are discussed: • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Prerequisites Operational Configuration Working with Destinations Working with Layers Working with Layer Functions Using Move Working with Transitions Working with Presets Working with Still Frames Using the DSK Using the LOGO Locking and Unlocking the Controller Working with Tallies Using Backup and Restore ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 215 6. Operations Prerequisites mêÉêÉèìáëáíÉë Prior to using the ScreenPRO-II Controller system, please ensure the following: • All system inputs, backgrounds, the DSK and the LOGO are properly configured. In Chapter 5, refer to the following sections for details: ~ ~ ~ ~ “Input Setup" on page 206. “Background Setup" on page 205. “DSK Setup Procedure" on page 211. “LOGO Setup Procedure" on page 212. • Ensure that you are familiar with all front panel controls. In Chapter 2, refer to the “ScreenPRO-II Controller Front Panel" section on page 34 for details. • Ensure that you are familiar with all system menus, and in particular, the operational menus. In Chapter 4, refer to the following sections for details: ~ Refer to the “PIP Adjustment Menu" section on page 148 for details on all PIP adjustment menu items. ~ Refer to the “Key Menu" section on page 155 for details on all Key adjustment menu items. ~ Refer to the “Source Adjustment Menus" section on page 165 for details on all input source adjustment parameters. Tip As you review each function, it is recommended that you try out (and practice) each feature at the ScreenPRO-II Controller itself — using a fully configured system consisting of Program and Preview monitors, projectors, and all the necessary sources and backgrounds. Note In this chapter, when a sequence of menu selections is required to complete a given procedure, the ">" symbol is used to divide each successive menu pick. S Example: To access the Genlock Menu, press {HOME} > {OUTPUT} > {GLCK}. 216 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Operational Configuration léÉê~íáçå~ä=`çåÑáÖìê~íáçå The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • • • • Monitor Layout Touch Screen Calibration Lookahead Preview Understanding Raster Boxes A Word About LOS Setting User Preferences Understanding Input File Mapping jçåáíçê=i~óçìí Use the following diagram as a recommended layout for your monitors. A sample dualscreen widescreen configuration is shown. Preview – Screen 1 Preview – Screen 2 Program – Screen 1 Program – Screen 2 Figure 6-1. Recommended Monitor Layout For optimum viewing and utility, place your Preview monitors on the left, and your Program monitors on the right. qçìÅÜ=pÅêÉÉå=`~äáÄê~íáçå Touch Screen calibration is an excellent prerequisite to all operating procedures. Use the following steps to calibrate your Touch Screen display: 1. If required, press {HOME} to display the Home Menu. 2. Press MISC to show the Miscellaneous Menu. 3. Press {LCD SETTINGS} to display the first LCD Settings Menu. 4. Press {LCD Cal} to display the first Touch Screen Calibration Menu. 5. Follow directions on screen to complete the calibration procedure. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 217 6. Operations Operational Configuration táÇÉ=pÅêÉÉå=j~êâÉêë If you are using a wide screen configuration, ensure that your Wide Screen Markers are enabled: 1. From the Home Menu, press OUTPUT to display the Output Menu. 2. On the Destination Bus, select your system’s wide screen destination. 3. Press {WIDE SCREEN} to display the Wide Screen Settings Menu. 4. Scroll to the Marker Mode line and enable the system’s wide screen markers, to show the boundaries of active data. In wide screen applications, Wide Screen Markers are thin vertical green lines at the edges of the screens that are used to denote the actual projected image area. Using edge feathering and data doubling, the BlendPRO-II provides perfect and seamless wide screen images. Because of the required overlap, a portion of the original image is unused, and does not get projected. The location of the unused portion depends on your selected justification — left or center. With each type of justification, the Wide Screen Markers accurately denote the unused portion, thus enabling you to properly compose your screens. • Left Justified Markers The figure below illustrates the Wide Screen Marker in a left justified configuration. Images to the left of the green vertical line are projected. Images to the right are not. Preview #1 Preview #2 Preview #1 Preview #2 Wide Screen Marker Figure 6-2. Wide Screen Marker, Left Justification • Center Justified Markers The figure below illustrates the two Wide Screen Markers in a center justified configuration. Images between the two vertical green lines are projected. Images outside of the lines are not. Wide Screen Marker Preview #1 Preview #2 Preview #1 Preview #2 Wide Screen Marker Figure 6-3. Wide Screen Marker, Center Justification 218 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Operational Configuration iççâ~ÜÉ~Ç=mêÉîáÉï The ScreenPRO-II Controller uses a “lookahead” preview system that ensures the accuracy of all your transitions. The “look” or appearance that you create on Preview represents the exact appearance of Program — after you transition the images to Program. S The illustration below represents a simple Preview-to-Program transition. SPLIT mode is on, enabling you to have two PIPs on screen simultaneously: Program Program Background A Background A PIP A PIP A PIP B 3 1 CUT Preview AUTO TRANS 2 Preview 4 Background A Background A PIP A PIP A PIP B PIP B Figure 6-4. Program-to-Preview Transition with Lookahead • • • In frame 1, Program consists of a background and a single PIP. • Frame 4 represents Preview after the transition. Preview will continue to match Program until you modify the preview image, in preparation for the next transition. In frame 2, a second PIP is selected and positioned on Preview. When CUT or AUTO TRANS is pressed, the PIP transitions to Program. Frame 3 represents the Program screen — identical to the Preview “look” in frame 2. With these facts in mind, ensure that you always create the desired “next” look in Preview. In this manner, there won’t be any operational surprises: • By using lookahead, you’ll always know visually what PIPs and keys you want to transition TO Program. • Conversely, you’ll always know what PIPs and keys to you wish to clear — to visually remove elements FROM Program. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 219 6. Operations Operational Configuration råÇÉêëí~åÇáåÖ=o~ëíÉê=_çñÉë With ScreenPRO-II Controller, Raster Boxes are always enabled on Preview, each PIP or Key is surrounded by a thin border that helps you identify the PIP or Key’s original layer. • • The PIP or Key with a red “corner” style raster box is Layer A. The PIP or Key with a red “dashed” raster box is Layer B. PIP B PIP A Figure 6-5. Raster Box Styles (sample) • The "blinking" raster box is always the one enabled for modification, and its corresponding layer button will blink. • Raster boxes that are underneath other layers (such as another PIP, the DSK or the LOGO) are still visible on Preview. PIP A PIP B Figure 6-6. Raster Box Visibility (sample) Remember that Raster Box size can be adjusted: 220 1. From the Home Menu, press OUTPUT to display the Output Menu. 2. On the Destination Bus, select the destination that you want to configure. 3. Press {SETTINGS} to display the Settings Menu. 4. On the Raster Box Size line, set the size of the raster box that appears around PIPs and Keys. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Operational Configuration ^=tçêÇ=^Äçìí=ilp On rare occasion, you can experience LOS (loss of signal) — typically due to a poor video, graphics or computer connection. In these cases, the ScreenPRO-II Controller obeys a precise set of rules for how to handle the signals: • Scaler LOS — If there is a LOS for a video signal inside a scaler (PIP or KEY), the video switches to black, but the scaler remains in its current size and position. • Background LOS — If there is a LOS for a background DVI input, the video switches to the background’s selected matte color. • DSK LOS — If there is a LOS for the DSK, the system switches the DSK Off (specifically, selecting "none" as the type). In each case, when the video signal recovers, the system re-enables it as before. pÉííáåÖ=rëÉê=mêÉÑÉêÉåÅÉë Prior to operations, be sure to set user preferences as desired: 1. From the Miscellaneous Menu, press {USER PREF} to display the User Preference Menu. 2. On the Black Invalid Video line, select the method by which the scaler “loading” procedure is shown on Preview, when you change inputs: ~ Select ON to show black when scalers are loaded. In addition, Black will be shown when a background channel (BG) becomes invalid, and the DSK will be turned off when source video becomes invalid. ~ Select OFF to show the full scaler loading procedure, which can temporarily include non-sync and non-stable video. råÇÉêëí~åÇáåÖ=fåéìí=cáäÉ=j~ééáåÖ This section provides information on how the ScreenPRO-II Controller system stores the characteristics of each input in files, and how those files are used during operations. During the input setup procedure, after adjusting each input parameter, pressing the {SAVE} button saves those characteristics in a file. The file stores all definitions for that source alone, along with the associated destination. From that point forward, each time you press that source button and assign it to a PIP or a Key, the stored file is recalled and the image appears on Preview (typically after a brief delay). The delay occurs as each input is instantly re-scaled per the file’s instructions, and the scaler is instantly re-programmed with the file’s data. With regards to router connections, an input file is independent of the physical connector. Even though only certain sources can be connected to specific connectors (e.g., Analog or SDI), once a connector is selected (on the Input Menu) and an input file is created for the source, that file can be recalled on any of the same type of connectors in the system, provided that a router is properly connected and assigned. This in no way forces all of the other connectors to only accept that particular kind of source signal. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 221 6. Operations Working with Destinations tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=aÉëíáå~íáçåë Destinations can be configured as single screens, multiple screens (in wide screen applications), auxiliary router outputs, ImagePRO Aux destinations and PresentationPRO-II Aux destinations. • When single and wide screen (Projector) destinations are activated, Program output is routed to the selected projectors. • When Aux destinations are activated, selected inputs (sources) can be routed to the selected router outputs, or to external devices (such as ImagePRO and PresentationPRO-II). For destination setup instructions, refer to the following sections in Chapter 5: • • • “Standard Destination Setup," page 192. “Router Setup," page 193. “AUX Destination Setup," page 195. The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • Activating Destinations Clearing Destinations Routing Sources to Destinations ^Åíáî~íáåÖ=aÉëíáå~íáçåë Use the following steps to activate and deactivate destinations: DEST AUX 1 1. To activate a single Standard Destination, turn DEST AUX off, then press the desired button on the Destination Bus. All other destinations will turn off. 2. To activate multiple Standard Destinations, turn DEST AUX off, then simultaneously press the desired buttons on the Destination Bus. Any other active destinations will turn off. 3. To activate a single Aux Destination, turn DEST AUX on, then press the desired button on the Destination Bus. All other Aux destinations will turn off. 4. To activate multiple Aux Destinations, turn DEST AUX off, then simultaneously press the desired buttons on the Destination Bus. Any other active Aux destinations will turn off. All In each case, please note: 222 • • Remember that destination buttons are not toggles. • When you press a single button or a group of buttons, your selection is mutually exclusive with all other active destinations. • Press the All button to turn all destinations on. The selected buttons light when activated. Any combination of active destination buttons can be selected. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Destinations `äÉ~êáåÖ=aÉëíáå~íáçåë Use the following steps to clear destinations: All 1. To clear all destinations, double-punch the All button. 2. To clear a single destination (or multiple destinations) from an active group, turn DEST AUX on or off as desired, then simultaneously press the destinations that you want to remain on. S Destinations 1, 2 and 3 are active. To clear destination 2, simultaneously press destinations 1 and 3. oçìíáåÖ=pçìêÅÉë=íç=aÉëíáå~íáçåë When routing sources to both standard and Aux destinations, please note: • Remember that the Destination/Aux Bus is one bus — it is not two separate and independent buses. • Any source that you select will apply to all enabled buses — even if that bus is not currently visible (due to the state of the DEST AUX button). • Any transition that you perform will apply to all enabled buses — even if that bus is not currently visible (due to the state of the DEST AUX button). Use the following steps to route a source to a destination (or multiple destinations): 1. On the Destination/Aux Bus, enable or disable the DEST AUX button as desired. 2. Enable only the destination button(s) on which you want to pend a route. 3. For "standard" destinations, select the desired layer (LAYER A or LAYER B). This step is not required for an Aux bus route. 4. On the Source Selection Bus, select the source that you want to route to the selected destination(s). Note At this point, the route is pending on Preview. You are free to manipulate the source (e.g., PIP and Key), but the route will not occur until the destination is enabled, and the next transition is performed. 5. Repeat steps 1 through 3 for additional source-to-destination combinations. 6. Enable all destinations that you want to transition. 7. Perform the desired transition in the normal manner. Once performed, the pending route is completed. Note ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide If you want to clear the pending route prior to performing it, simply clear the lit Aux destination(s). 223 6. Operations Working with Destinations Following are several simple examples of source-to-destination routing: S Single source to single destination Route Source 1 to Destination 1: a. Turn DEST AUX off. b. Press Destination 1. c. Press LAYER A. d. Select Source 1. e. Press AUTO TRANS. S Single source to single Aux destination Route Source 2 to Aux Destination 2: a. Turn DEST AUX on. b. Press Destination 2. c. Select Source 1. d. Press AUTO TRANS. S Single source to multiple destinations Route Source 8 to Destinations 1, 2 and 3: a. Turn DEST AUX off. b. Press Destinations 1, 2 and 3 simultaneously. c. Press LAYER A. d. Select Source 8. e. Press AUTO TRANS. S Multiple sources to multiple standard destinations Route Source 2 to Destination 1, and Source 3 to Destination 2: a. Turn DEST AUX off. b. Press Destination 1. c. Press LAYER A. d. Select Source 2. e. Press Destination 2. f. Press LAYER A. g. Select Source 3. h. Press Destinations 1 and 2 simultaneously. i. Press AUTO TRANS. S Single source to multiple Aux and standard destinations Route Source 3 to Destinations 1 and 2, and Aux Destinations 1 and 2: 224 a. Turn DEST AUX off. b. Press Destinations 1 and 2 simultaneously. c. Press LAYER A. d. Turn DEST AUX on. e. Press Destinations 1 and 2 simultaneously. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Destinations f. Select Source 3. g. Press AUTO TRANS. S Multiple sources to multiple Aux and standard destinations Route Source 5 to Destinations 1 and 2, and Source 7 to Aux Destinations 3 and 4: a. Turn DEST AUX off. b. Press Destinations 1 and 2 simultaneously. c. Press LAYER A. d. Select Source 5. e. Double-punch the ALL button to clear all destinations. f. Turn DEST AUX on. g. Press Destinations 3 and 4 simultaneously. h. Select Source 7. i. Turn DEST AUX off. j. Press Destinations 1 and 2 simultaneously. k. Press AUTO TRANS. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 225 6. Operations Working with Layers tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=i~óÉêë The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • • • • • • • • • Switching Sources Background Transitions Understanding Split and Mix Modes Working with PIPs in Split Mode Working with PIPs in Mix Mode Modifying PIPs Working with Keys in Split Mode Working with Keys in Mix Mode Using Cut & Fill Modifying Keys Clearing Layers from Program Modifying Layers On Program pïáíÅÜáåÖ=pçìêÅÉë The Source Selection Bus allows you to choose the sources that are routed into PIPs and keys. Please note: • • Use the SHIFT button to access sources 9 through 16. The SDI 1 and SDI 2 buttons are only active when a ScreenPRO-II is configured to use internal routing. The buttons are disabled when external routing is used. Use the following steps to switch sources into a PIP or a Key: 1. Press LAYER A or LAYER B in the Layer Control Section. Note: ~ ~ ~ 2. The button blinks to indicate that it is available for modification. The associated layer’s raster box blinks on Preview. If a PIP or Key is assigned to the layer, its source can now be changed. Press the desired button on the Source Selection Bus to assign that source to the PIP or Key. The button blinks to indicate that it is active for modification. Please note the following important points regarding sources: 226 • When the Red LED above a source button is lit, the source is on Program — provided that its associated Destination button is active. • When a source button is lit solid, the source is on Preview — but it is not active for manipulation. Only blinking source buttons are active for modification. • When the Red LED above a source button is blinking, the mixer is set to Mix Mode (the Split button is off). The blinking Red LED indicates the layer that is on Program, and the alternate layer is enabled for modification. • Multiple sources can appear on Program and Preview simultaneously, but only one button can be blinking and active for modification on Preview. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Layers • If you select a layer in the Layer Control Section that is lit (but not blinking), it blinks — and the corresponding “assigned” source on the Source Selection Bus blinks. This method also allows you to quickly verify layer/source selections. _~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=qê~åëáíáçåë Use the following steps to perform a transition from one background to another: 1. BG A Press and light the background button to which you want to transition. The button blinks to indicate it is active for modification on Preview. Please note: ~ If the background is already on Program, the Background Input Setup Menu appears, but changes cannot be made. ~ If the background is not on Program, the Background Input Setup Menu appears and the background "type" can be changed. Note 2. 3. 4. If you select Background B and a pop-up window alerts you to a resource conflict, the DSK is in use on Program. The DSK must be cleared from Program before Background B can be used. With the background button blinking and active for modification, select the type of background to which you want to transition. Scroll to the Type line: ~ Select DVI to use an unscaled full-screen graphic. Ensure that the DVI source is properly set up. ~ Select MATTE to use a solid color. Press {MATTE} to display the Background Matte Menu, and adjust the color as required. In Chapter 4, refer to the "BG Matte Menu" section on page 174 for details. ~ Select FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3 to use a captured still frame as the background source. Refer to the "Working with Still Frames" section on page 246 for details. Set the background toggle mode. In the Layer Functions Section: ~ Enable the Toggle button to toggle between the last two selected backgrounds on each transition. ~ Disable the Toggle button to retain the last selected background on the next transition. Perform the desired transition. Please note the following important points regarding background transitions: • If BG A is on Program and BG A is selected in Preview, there will be no change of backgrounds on the next transition. The similar situation is true for BG B. • If BG A is on Program and BG B is selected in Preview, BG A will transition to BG B on the next transition. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 227 6. Operations Working with Layers råÇÉêëí~åÇáåÖ=péäáí=~åÇ=jáñ=jçÇÉë The ScreenPRO-II Controller provides two different modes with which you can transition PIPs and Keys: • • Split Mode Mix Mode péäáí=jçÇÉ With the Split button lit, the mixer’s two layers operate independently. You can size, position, manipulate and transition the following combinations of effects: Split • • • One or two PIPs One or two Keys One PIP and one Key jáñ=jçÇÉ With the Split button off, the mixer’s layers are ganged together, and two mutuallyexclusive sub-modes now determine the mixer’s function: Mix Source and Swap. • With Mix Source mode enabled, both of the mixer’s PIPs or Keys are perfectly co-located. Layer A and Layer B are exactly the same size — in exactly the same position — with exactly the same border and shadow. This mode is ideal for transitioning images inside a static PIP. Even though two identical PIPs are used, they visually appear as one. • With Swap mode enabled, both of the mixer’s PIPs or Keys can be located independently, with different positions, sizes, borders and shadows. Layer A and Layer B can be positioned and sized as desired — but only one can be on Program at a time. Mix Source Swap With both Mix Source and Swap modes, one additional “transition” function can be used without restriction. • With Toggle mode enabled, sources toggle back and forth with each transition. When a PIP or Key source is selected in Preview and a transition is performed, the Program source “flip-flops” to Preview. Subsequent transitions simply alternate between sources. Any new source can be selected in Preview, and as long as Toggle is on, the last two selected sources will alternate. • With Toggle off, the source selected in Preview stays in Preview, once the transition is complete. In this mode, you must change Preview sources manually. Toggle Please note the following important points regarding Mix Mode: • In Mix Mode, there is always a layer available In Preview for a new source to be selected and taken to Program. • Four transition combinations are possible: ~ ~ ~ ~ 228 Mix Source with Toggle On Mix Source with Toggle Off Swap with Toggle On Swap with Toggle Off ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Layers tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=mfmë=áå=péäáí=jçÇÉ In Split Mode, the mixer’s two layers operate independently. Note Even though this mode allows you to display two PIPs (or Keys) on air, it is more restrictive. Once both layers are on Program, you must transition them off Program, make changes — and then transition them back on. Use the following steps to work with PIPs in Split Mode. Layer A 1. In the Layer Control Section, ensure that the Split button is On. 2. Press the desired layer button (A or B). Please note: ~ ~ ~ 3. The layer button blinks to indicate that it is active for modification. In the Source Selection Bus, the source assigned to the layer blinks. On Preview, the raster box for the selected layer blinks (even if it is hidden under another layer). In the Layer Functions Section, ensure that the PIP button is lit and the PIP Adjustment Menu is visible. If the menu is not visible, press PIP. Note Even if the layer is on Program, the PIP Adjustment Menu appears, but parameters can not be adjusted. 4. On the Source Selection Bus, press the button for the desired (new) source. The button blinks to indicate that it is selected, and the source appears within the PIP on Preview. 5. Adjust the PIP’s size, position, border, shadow, source image, cropping and special effects. Refer to the “Modifying PIPs" section on page 230 for details. 6. Prior to the transition, you can set up an additional layer if desired in Split Mode: ~ To set up an additional “Split Mode” PIP in Preview, repeat the procedure from step 2. ~ To set up a Key in Preview, refer to the “Working with Keys in Split Mode" section on page 231. 7. Press CUT or AUTO TRANS to transition the look to program. Refer to the “Working with Transitions" section on page 241 for details. 8. Repeat the procedure from step 1 for the next transition. tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=mfmë=áå=jáñ=jçÇÉ In Mix Mode, the mixer’s layers are ganged together. Both PIPs can be perfectly colocated on screen (Mix Source mode), or both can operate independently (Swap mode), but only one PIP can be on Program at a time. Use the following steps to work with PIPs in Mix Mode. 1. In the Layer Control Section, ensure that the Split button is Off. 2. Press the desired layer button (A or B). Please note: ~ ~ The layer button blinks to indicate that it is active for modification. In the Source Selection Bus, the source assigned to the layer blinks. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 229 6. Operations Working with Layers ~ On Preview, the raster box for the selected layer blinks (even if it is hidden under the DSK). 3. In the Layer Functions Section, ensure that the PIP button is lit and the PIP Adjustment Menu is visible. If the menu is not visible, press PIP. 4. Set the desired Mix Mode: ~ ~ ~ To co-locate the mixer’s PIPs, enable the Mix Source button. To locate the mixer’s PIPs independently, enable the Swap button. To toggle sources, enable the Toggle button. 5. On the Source Selection Bus, press the button for the desired (new) source. The button blinks to indicate that it is selected, and the source appears within the PIP on Preview. 6. Adjust the PIP’s size, position, border, shadow, source image, cropping and special effects. Refer to the “Modifying PIPs" section on page 230 for details. 7. Press CUT or AUTO TRANS to transition the new look to program. Refer to the “Working with Transitions" section on page 241 for details. 8. Repeat the procedure from step 1 for the next transition. jçÇáÑóáåÖ=mfmë Use the following steps to modify a PIP: 1. Ensure that the PIP is selected in the Layer Control Section, and active for modification on Preview. 2. If the PIP Adjustment Menu is not visible, press PIP. 3. Size and Position — Use the Size and Position controls in the PIP Adjustment Menu to manipulate the PIP on Preview. In Chapter 4, refer to the "PIP Adjustment Menu Description" section on page 149 for details. 4. Source Size — Press Source (in the Joystick Section) to display the Input Source Adjustment Menu. Use the Size and Position controls to manipulate the source image within the PIP. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Source Adjustment Menu Description" section on page 167 for details. 5. Crop — Press Crop (in the Joystick Section) to display the Crop Adjustment Menu. Select the type of crop, the aspect ratio, and the image’s H and V size. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Crop Menu" section on page 164 for details. 6. Border — From the PIP, Shadow or Effects menus, press {BORDR} to display the Border Menu. Select the border’s style, color and size. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Border Menu" section on page 151 for menu details. 7. Shadow — From the PIP, Border or Effects menus, press {SHDOW} to display the Shadow Menu. Choose the shadow’s size, position and transparency. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Shadow Menu" section on page 152 for details. 8. Special Effects — From the PIP, Shadow or Border menus, press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Select the desired effect such as monochrome, invert, hue and strobe. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Image Effects Menu" section on page 153 for details. 9. Global Functions — Remember that the following global functions are always available: ~ 230 Press Reset (in the Joystick Section) to reset the current effect (e.g., PIP, Key, crop, etc.) to a nominal default value. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Layers ~ Press Full Screen to bring the PIP to full screen, using the source’s height as the defining factor. ~ Press Freeze to freeze the PIP (on both Program and Preview). Press again to unfreeze. 10. Transition — Transition the new look to program with a CUT or AUTO TRANS. Refer to the “Working with Transitions" section on page 241 for details. tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=hÉóë=áå=péäáí=jçÇÉ In Split Mode, the mixer’s two layers operate independently. Note Even though this mode allows you to display two PIPs (or Keys) on air, it is more restrictive. Once both layers are on Program, you must transition them off Program, make changes — and then transition them back on. Use the following steps to work with Keys in Split Mode. 1. In the Layer Control Section, ensure that the Split button is On. 2. Press the desired layer button (A or B). Please note: ~ ~ ~ 3. The layer button blinks to indicate that it is active for modification. In the Source Selection Bus, the source assigned to the layer blinks. On Preview, the raster box for the selected layer blinks (even if it is hidden under another layer). In the Layer Functions Section, ensure that the KEY button is lit and the Key Menu is visible. If the menu is not visible, press KEY. Note Even if the layer is on Program, the Key Menu appears, but parameters can not be adjusted. 4. On the Source Selection Bus, select the desired (new) key source. The button blinks to indicate that it is selected, and the source appears on Preview. 5. Adjust the Key’s type, clip, gain, opacity, fill, size, position, source image and cropping. Refer to the “Modifying Keys" section on page 233 for details. 6. Prior to the transition, you can set up an additional effect if desired in Split Mode: ~ To set up an additional “Split Mode” Key in Preview, repeat the procedure from step 2. ~ To set up a PIP in Preview, refer to the “Working with PIPs in Split Mode" section on page 229. 7. Press CUT or AUTO TRANS to transition the look to Program. Refer to the “Working with Transitions" section on page 241 for details. 8. Repeat the procedure from step 1 for the next transition. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 231 6. Operations Working with Layers tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=hÉóë=áå=jáñ=jçÇÉ In Mix Mode, the mixer’s layers are ganged together. Both Keys can be perfectly colocated on screen (Mix Source mode), or both can operate independently (Swap mode), but only one Key can be on Program at a time. Use the following steps to work with Keys in Mix Mode. 1. In the Layer Control Section, ensure that the Split button is Off. 2. Press the desired layer button (A or B). Please note: ~ ~ ~ The layer button blinks to indicate that it is active for modification. In the Source Selection Bus, the source assigned to the layer blinks. On Preview, the raster box for the selected layer blinks (even if it is hidden under the DSK). 3. In the Layer Functions Section, ensure that the KEY button is lit and the Key Menu is visible. If the menu is not visible, press KEY. 4. Set the desired Mix Mode: ~ ~ ~ To co-locate the mixer’s Keys, enable the Mix Source button. To locate the mixer’s Keys independently, enable the SWAP button. To toggle sources, enable Toggle. 5. On the Source Selection Bus, select the desired (new) key source. The button blinks to indicate that it is selected, and the source appears on Preview. 6. Adjust the Key’s mode, clip, gain, opacity, fill, size, position, source image and cropping. Refer to the “Modifying Keys" section on page 233 for details. 7. Transition the new look to Program with a CUT or AUTO TRANS. Refer to the “Working with Transitions" section on page 241 for details. 8. Repeat the procedure from step 1 for the next transition. rëáåÖ=`ìí=C=cáää A Cut + Fill key is one in which the hole-cutting information is provided by a Key on Layer B, while the fill information is provided by an effect on Layer A (either a PIP or a Key). Note Cut + Fill keys can only be selected on Layer B when the Split Mode is enabled. Use the following steps to create a Cut & Fill Key: 232 1. In the Layer Control Section, ensure that the Split button is On. 2. Press the Layer A button, and configure your "fill" video as either a PIP or a Key in the normal manner. This is the video that will appear "inside" the key. (Typically, the fill video is a PIP.) 3. Press the Layer B button and select Key. 4. On the Key Type line, select Cut + Fill. 5. Use the Clip, Gain and Opacity controls to set the appearance of the fill video as desired. 6. Alternate between selecting Layer A and Layer B, and use each layer’s Size and Position controls to position the fill within the key as desired. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Layers 7. 8. Many creative options are available with Cut + Fill keys. You can ... ~ Use the "Join" mode to link the cut and fill layers together, such that they move together as one. Refer to the "Using Join Mode" section on page 237 for details. ~ Program a "Move" with the combined Cut + Fill effect. Refer to the "Using Move" section on page 238 for details. ~ Program a "Move" with only the key signal — such that the moving key travels over a static fill, revealing portions of the fill as the move progresses from point to point. Transition the new look to Program with a CUT or AUTO TRANS. Refer to the “Working with Transitions" section on page 241 for details. jçÇáÑóáåÖ=hÉóë Use the following steps to modify a Key: 1. Ensure that the Key is selected in the Layer Control Section, and active for modification on Preview. 2. If the Key Menu is not visible, press KEY in the Layer Functions Section. 3. Key Type — Use the controls in the Key Menu to select the desired key type — Luma, Color, or Cut + Fill. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Key Menu Functions" section on page 156 for menu details. Note Remember that Cut + Fill keys can only be selected on Layer B when the Split Mode is enabled. 4. Clip, Gain, Mode, Opacity — Use the controls in the Key Menu to adjust the Key’s clip, gain, invert mode and opacity on Preview. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Key Menu Functions" section on page 156 for menu details. 5. Fill Source — Use the controls in the Key Menu to select a self or matte fill key. If Matte is selected, press {MATTE} to display the Matte Menu, with which you can choose the matte fill color. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Matte Menu" section on page 159 for menu details. 6. Size and Position — From the Key Menu, press {SIZE & POS} to display the Key Adjustment Menu. Use the controls to manipulate the Key on Preview. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Key Adjustment Menu" section on page 160 for details. 7. Crop — Press Crop (in the Joystick Section) to display the Crop Adjustment Menu. Select the type of crop, the aspect ratio, and the image’s H and V size. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Crop Menu" section on page 164 for details. 8. Source Size — Press Source (in the Joystick Section) to display the Key Source Adjustment Menu. Adjust the source image’s size and position within the Key. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Source Adjustment Menu Description" section on page 167 for menu details. 9. Special Effects — From the Key, Key Adjustment, Key Source Adjustment or Matte Menu, press {EFX} to display the Image Effects Menu. Select the desired effect, including monochrome, chroma and hue, invert and strobe. In Chapter 4, refer to the "Image Effects Menu" section on page 153 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 233 6. Operations Working with Layers 10. Global Functions — Remember that the following global functions are always available to you: ~ Press Reset to reset the current effect (e.g., PIP, Key, crop, etc.) to a nominal default value. ~ Press Full Screen to bring the Key to full screen, using the source’s height as the defining factor. ~ Press Freeze to freeze the Key (on both Program and Preview). Press again to unfreeze. 11. Transition — Transition the new look to program with a CUT or AUTO TRANS. Refer to the “Working with Transitions" section on page 241 for details. `äÉ~êáåÖ=i~óÉêë=Ñêçã=mêçÖê~ã The clear layer procedure enables you to remove layers from Program — including backgrounds, layers, the DSK and the LOGO. In this mode, always remember to take advantage of the system’s Lookahead Preview function. Refer to the "Lookahead Preview" section on page 219 for additional details. Use the following steps to clear a layer from Program: Clear Layer 1. Check (and compare) the Program and Preview monitors, and note the layer(s) that you wish to clear. In the Layer Control Section, Red LEDs above the buttons indicate the layers that are on Program. 2. If the button for the layer that you wish to clear is not lit, press to light it — and ensure the button is blinking. 3. In the Layer Control Section, press Clear Layer. This action turns off the selected layer button and visually clears the layer from Preview. This step is valid for all buttons in the Layer Control Section. 4. Prior to transition, if you want to clear additional layers, repeat steps 2 and 3. 5. Transition the new "look" to program with a CUT or AUTO TRANS. The selected layer(s) will transition off of Program. jçÇáÑóáåÖ=i~óÉêë=lå=mêçÖê~ã The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to modify layers directly on Program, without first setting up a "look" on Preview. The mode is typically used for creating and viewing a "look" on Program (especially in conjunction with a large screen projector) when the Preview monitor may be too small to realize the desired result. Use the following steps to modify layers directly on Program: 1. From the Home Menu, press SYSTEM to access the System Menu. 2. Scroll to the Modify Layers On Program line and turn the mode ON. You can now change PIPs and Keys directly on Program. Please note: 234 • When you switch sources directly on Program, you may notice a glitch in the image as the scalers recall the source’s file. • If you use camera inputs in this mode, it is recommended that you use an external Genlock signal. Refer to the "Understanding Input File Mapping" section on page 221 for details on source files. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Layer Functions tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=i~óÉê=cìåÅíáçåë The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • • • • Changing the Layer Mode Using Full Screen Using Clone Using Swap Z-Order Using Freeze Using Reset Using Join Mode `Ü~åÖáåÖ=íÜÉ=i~óÉê=jçÇÉ Use the following steps to change the layer mode: 1. Ensure that the PIP or Key that you wish to change is selected in the Layer Control Section, and active for modification. 2. In the Layer Functions Section: ~ ~ Press PIP to change a Key to a PIP, or ... Press Key to change a PIP to a Key. rëáåÖ=cìää=pÅêÉÉå Use the following steps to take the active PIP or Key to full screen: Full Screen 1. Ensure that the PIP or Key is selected in the Layer Control Section, and active for modification in Preview. 2. In the Layer Functions Section, press Full Screen. The source’s height will be used as the parameter that define’s the full screen size. If borders are ON, they will be taken into account so that they are visible. Shadows will not be taken into account for the full screen size. rëáåÖ=`äçåÉ Clone The Clone mode is designed for widescreen configurations only. It enables you to make an exact copy of a layer onto the opposite screen. All parameters of the PIP or Key are cloned, including the shadow, key effects, border and size. Once cloned, you can select between a “mirror” or an “offset” clone. Use the following steps to clone a layer: 1. Ensure that a PIP or Key is selected in the Layer Control Section, and active for modification in Preview. 2. Ensure that the PIP or Key is positioned fully within the boundaries of an outside destination’s screen. If the PIP or Key straddles the widescreen overlap region, the mode cannot be enabled. 3. Press Clone to display the Clone Setup Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 235 6. Operations Working with Layer Functions 4. Select the desired clone type — Mirror or Offset. 5. If Offset is selected, adjust the offset (in pixels) as desired. 6. If desired, clone the other layer by repeating the procedure from step 1. 7. Press CUT or AUTO TRANS to transition the effect to Program. Note You can set up and perform a Move in conjunction with a cloned image. rëáåÖ=pï~é=wJlêÇÉê Use the following steps to swap the Z-Order (priority) of two layers within the same Swap Z-order mixer. The function works with two Keys, two PIPs, or one of each. 1. Ensure that you have two layers visible on Preview, with one layer visually overlapping the other. 2. In the Layer Functions Section, press Swap Z-Order. The visual priority (on Preview) of the two layers changes. Note that the layers remain at their current locations — only the priority changes. 3. Transition the new "look" to program with a CUT or AUTO TRANS. rëáåÖ=cêÉÉòÉ Use the following steps to freeze a layer’s motion on both Program and Preview. This function is useful for PIPs and Keys that use video and animated graphics. Freeze 1. In the Layer Control Section, activate the layer that you wish to freeze. The button blinks to indicate it is active. 2. In the Layer Functions Section, press Freeze to freeze the layer on both Preview and Program (if applicable). The button lights to indicate that a “freeze” is associated with the current layer. Note 3. The lit Freeze button indicates the association between the selected layer and the “freeze.” If you select a different layer that does not have an associated freeze, the button turns off. If you return to the associated layer, the button lights again. With the layer selected, turn off the Freeze button to restore source motion. Please note: 236 • If a source is on Program, selecting its layer and pressing Freeze will freeze the image on Program. • You can also use Freeze if the PIP or Key is only on Preview, and then transition the frozen image to Program. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Layer Functions rëáåÖ=oÉëÉí The Reset function is context sensitive. It is used to reset the current effect to a nominal default value on Preview. Reset Use the following steps to reset a specific PIP or Key parameter: 1. In the Layer Control Section, activate the layer that you wish to reset. The layer button blinks to indicate that it is active. 2. Ensure that the layer is on Preview. Typically, you cannot reset functions on Program. Note In some situations (such as size and position), a parameter on Program can be reset — provided that Modify Layers on Program is enabled. 3. Ensure that Freeze is off. Frozen PIPs or Keys cannot be reset. 4. If required, access the "menu" whose specific function you want to reset (e.g., borders, shadows, special effect, size, etc.). 5. In the Joystick Section, press Reset to reset the current effect. rëáåÖ=gçáå=jçÇÉ The "Join" mode enables you to lock Layer A and Layer B together, such that they move as one. You can program "moves" when the two layers are joined, and the mode is particularly effective when using Cut + Fill keys. The following rules apply: • • The Split mode must be enabled in order to enter the Join mode. • When the two layers are joined, the Size and Position controls on either layer enable you to move both layers as one. The relationship of the two layers (at the time of the joining) is maintained proportionally. • When the two layers are joined, the effects (e.g., border, shadow, clip) on each layer are locked — and cannot be changed until the "join" is cancelled. • You can only enter and exit the mode when the "join" is on Preview. Any Layer A and Layer B effect can be joined, including PIPs and all types of Keys. You can join two PIPs, two Keys, or one PIP and one Key. Use the following steps to join Layer A and Layer B: 1. In the Layer Control Section, ensure that Split mode is enabled. 2. On Preview, create a Key or PIP on Layer A in the normal manner. 3. Create a Key or PIP on Layer B in the normal manner. 4. Press and hold the Split button, then press either of the two layer buttons. This action enables the "Join" mode, and causes both layer buttons to blink. 5. Use either layer’s Size and Position controls to modify the joined layers, or to program a "move." Note that the two layers move and size as one. 6. Transition the new "look" to program with a CUT or AUTO TRANS. 7. To exit the mode, transition the effect off Program and back to Preview. 8. Press and hold the Split button, then press either of the two layer buttons. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 237 6. Operations Using Move rëáåÖ=jçîÉ The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • Programming Moves Pending and Triggering Moves Move Notes mêçÖê~ããáåÖ=jçîÉë Move Setup The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to move a PIP or a Key (or both) smoothly from one screen location to another at a predefined rate, while the layer(s) are on-air. All moves are two-keyframe effects, with a starting location and an ending (destination) location. There are two ways to program a move — on Preview or on Program. Move • • Program a Move on Preview Program a Move on Program mêçÖê~ã=~=jçîÉ=çå=mêÉîáÉï This mode enables you to program a move with the layer on Preview only — before it has transitioned to Program. Use the following steps to program a move on Preview: 1. In the Layer Control Section, select the layer that you want to move (LAYER A or LAYER B). The button blinks to indicate that it is active for modification. 2. In the Layer Functions Section, select Key or PIP as desired. 3. Size and position the PIP or Key in its “starting” location on Preview. Adjust all border, shadow and source parameters in the normal way. 4. In the Layer Functions Section, press Move Setup. The button blinks to indicate that you are now actively defining the properties of the move. 5. Move the PIP or Key to its “ending” size and location (on or off screen). 6. To define the rate at which the PIP or Key moves, adjust the Move Rate parameter. The rate can be adjusted in 0.1 second increments. 7. Press Move Setup again to complete the programming. The button remains lit, and the PIP or Key returns to its starting location on Preview. Note 8. The lit Move Setup button indicates an association between the selected layer and a programmed “move.” If you select a different layer that does not have an associated move, the button turns off. If you return to the “associated” layer, the button lights again. To set up an additional move on the other layer (provided that you are in Split Layer mode), repeat the procedure from step 1. To pend and trigger the move, refer to the "Pending and Triggering Moves" section on page 239. 238 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Using Move mêçÖê~ã=~=jçîÉ=çå=mêçÖê~ã This mode enables you to program a move with the layer on both Program and Preview — after the layer has transitioned to Program. Use the following steps to program a move on Program: 1. In the Layer Control Section, select the layer (on Program) that you want to move (LAYER A or LAYER B). The button blinks to indicate that it is active for modification. Note that its current position is the move’s "starting" location. 2. In the Layer Functions Section, press Move Setup. The button blinks to indicate that you are now actively defining the properties of the move. 3. Size and position the PIP or Key to its “ending” location. Note that on Preview, only the raster box moves. 4. Press Move Setup again to complete the programming. The button remains lit, and the raster box returns to its starting location on Preview. 5. To set up an additional move on the other layer (provided that you are in Split Layer mode), repeat the procedure from step 1. To pend and trigger the move, refer to the "Pending and Triggering Moves" section. mÉåÇáåÖ=~åÇ=qêáÖÖÉêáåÖ=jçîÉë For each layer on which you have programmed an associated move, you can “pend” and "trigger" the move in one of two ways — on Preview or on Program. • • Pend on Preview Pend on Program mÉåÇ=çå=mêÉîáÉï This "pend" method enables you to move the PIP or Key automatically on the next transition. Use the following steps to pend a move on Preview: 1. With the move properly programmed, ensure that the layer containing a move is selected and blinking. 2. To pend the move, press Move in the Layer Functions Section. The button lights to indicate the pending move. On Preview, the raster box blinks at the "destination" location — not the PIP or Key’s current location. 3. Perform a CUT or AUTO TRANS. The transition takes the Preview image to air, and the move begins immediately on both Program and Preview. 4. To move the layer back to keyframe 1, press Move. The button lights and on Preview, the raster box blinks at the "starting" location. 5. Perform a CUT or AUTO TRANS. In this "ping-pong" manner, you can continue to transit back and forth between keyframes 1 and 2. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 239 6. Operations Using Move mÉåÇ=çå=mêçÖê~ã This "pend" method enables you to trigger the move manually, once the layer is already on Program. Use the following steps to pend a move on Program: 1. With the move properly programmed, ensure that the layer containing a move is selected and blinking. 2. Perform a CUT or AUTO TRANS. The transition takes the Preview layer(s) to Program. 3. To pend the move, press Move in the Layer Functions Section. The button lights to indicate the pending move, and on Preview, the raster box blinks at the "destination" location — not the PIP or Key’s current location. 4. Perform a CUT or AUTO TRANS. The move begins when the button is pressed. 5. To move the layer back to keyframe 1, press Move. The button lights and on Preview, the raster box blinks at the "starting" location. 6. Perform a CUT or AUTO TRANS. In this "ping-pong" manner, you can continue to transit back and forth between keyframes 1 and 2. jçîÉ=kçíÉë Please note the following important points regarding the Move mode: • Clearing moves — To clear a move (and remove the association between a layer and a move), press Move Setup twice. • On screen, off screen — The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to move a PIP or Key from an off-screen location to an on-screen location, and vice-versa. Remember that Move behaves differently, depending on the selected mode: • In Split mode, two PIPs or Keys can be programmed and triggered independently (or simultaneously). You can pend LAYER A, LAYER B, or both — and then transition, as desired. • In Mix Source mode, both PIPs or keys are perfectly co-located on screen. The move you program applies to both layers. After a move is programmed, the Move Setup button lights when either layer A or B is pressed. • ~ If Toggle is On, each time you transition, the source inside the PIP or Key changes automatically. ~ If Toggle is Off, you must change sources manually (if desired) before each transition. ~ "Ping-pong" transitions can be performed. In Swap mode, both layers can operate independently but only one PIP or key can be on screen at a time, and the system alternates between each layer on each transition. ~ ~ ~ 240 Each layer can have its own programmed move. The "toggle" mode applies in the normal manner. "Ping-pong" transitions cannot be performed. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Transitions tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=qê~åëáíáçåë This section provides instructions for perform a variety of transitions. The following topics are discussed: • • • • • Cut Mix Wipe Manual Transitions Transition Notes `ìí Cuts can be performed on both single screen and widescreen destinations. Use the following steps to perform a Cut: CUT 1. Set up the desired “look” in Preview. 2. In the Transition Section, press CUT to instantly cut the setup to Program. jáñ A Mix (or Dissolve) can be performed on both single screen and widescreen destinations. Use the following steps to perform a Mix: MIX 1. Set up the desired “look” in Preview. 2. Preset the desired transition rate: a. Press {HOME} > {EFFECTS} to display the Effects Menu. b. Adjust the Transition Rate field for the desired rate, in 0.1 second increments. 3. In the Transition Section, press MIX. 4. Press AUTO TRANS to dissolve the setup to Program. táéÉ All types of wipes can be performed on single screen destinations. On widescreen destinations, you can perform a Wipe Up or Wipe Down. Use the following steps to perform a Wipe: WIPE 1. Set up the desired “look” in Preview. 2. Preset the desired transition rate, wipe effect and wipe edge: a. Press {HOME} > {EFFECTS} to display the Effects Menu. b. Adjust the Transition Rate field for the desired rate, in 0.1 second increments. c. Adjust the Transition Wipe field for the desired wipe pattern. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 241 6. Operations Working with Transitions d. Adjust the Transition Edge field for the desired wipe edge. Note Key Frame effects are fixed as LINEAR, and cannot be changed. 3. In the Transition Section, press WIPE. 4. Press AUTO TRANS to wipe the setup to Program. j~åì~ä=qê~åëáíáçåë Any of the transitions outlined above can be performed manually with the T-Bar. Use the following steps to perform a manual transition: 1. Set up the desired “look” in Preview. 2. Select WIPE or MIX as desired. Remember that wipes can only be performed on single screen destinations 3. In the Transition Section, move the T-Bar to manually dissolve (or wipe) the images on Preview to Program. qê~åëáíáçå=kçíÉë Using the Effects Menu, transitions performed on the ScreenPRO-II Controller are destination-based. Two examples are provided below. S Select destinations 1 and 3, then press WIPE. Next, select destination 2 only and press MIX. Finally, select all three destinations and press AUTO TRANS to simultaneously perform a wipe on destinations 1 and 3, and a dissolve on destination 2. Note In the above example, both the WIPE and MIX buttons would be lit when all three destinations are selected. S If destinations 1, 2 and 3 are lit, and both the WIPE and MIX buttons are lit, pressing MIX changes all three destinations to MIX. 242 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Presets tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=mêÉëÉíë This section provides detailed instructions for working with Presets. The ScreenPRO-II Controller’s Preset Section enables you to store and recall entire Controller setups. Each preset button represents one “look” of the overall projected image. The Controller has 6 Preset buttons and 6 "page" LEDs, providing a total of 36 Presets that you can store and recall — 6 pages of 6 Presets each. The following topics are discussed: • • • • • • A Word About Resources Storing Presets Recalling Presets Deleting Presets Using Next and Previous Preset Notes ^=tçêÇ=^Äçìí=oÉëçìêÅÉë Resources, as they apply to Presets, are the assigned layers that comprise the Controller’s current “look.” • When you store a Preset, you are not only recording the Controller’s entire look, but you are also recording the priorities (e.g., the layers of PIPs and Keys) that were selected in the Layer Control Section. • When you recall a Preset, you are recalling the entire setup, and all previously stored priorities — PIPs, Keys, Colors, Sources, Moves, etc. 4 Two "resource" examples are provided below: S If you store a Preset that contains LAYER A with SPLIT mode on, you can recall it to Preview only if LAYER A is not already in use — in the current Program setup. S If you store a Preset that contains LAYER A with SPLIT mode off, because there is always an available layer in Mix Mode, you can recall the Preset to Preview at any time. However, note that the system will pick the available layer based on resources (e.g., if you stored the Preset in LAYER A, the system may recall it to LAYER B if LAYER A is in use). With these facts in mind, you may wish to store (and organize) your Presets according to the use of resources: • For example, you could store Presets on Page 1 that only use one PIP, and presets on Page 2 that use two PIPs. • As an alternate method, you may want to plan your presentations such that Presets are always recalled to an “empty” Program setup (with only a background visible). This method avoids all resource issues entirely. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 243 6. Operations Working with Presets píçêáåÖ=mêÉëÉíë Use the following steps to store a preset: 1. Set up the desired “look” on Preview. Remember that one preset equals a single “look” of the Controller, including the current state of all mixers, layers, sources, and the DSK. 2. Select the “page” on which you want to store the preset. In the Preset Section, hold down Page, then press the desired Preset button. The Red LED above the button lights to indicate the current page. 3. To store the preset, press Learn + the desired Preset button. The Touch Screen displays a confirmation message, and the overall look of the Controller is now saved into that register. Page Learn oÉÅ~ääáåÖ=mêÉëÉíë Use the following steps to recall a preset: 1. Check the available resources on Program. If the resources (layers) that you wish to recall are already in use on Program, they must first be cleared before the “recall” is permitted. 2. Select the “page” from which you want to recall the preset. In the Preset Section, hold down Page, then press the desired Preset button. The Red LED above the button lights to indicate the current page. 3. To recall a Preset, simply press the desired Preset button to recall the stored “look” to Preview. aÉäÉíáåÖ=mêÉëÉíë Use the following steps to delete a preset: Delete 1. Select the “page” from which you want to delete a preset. In the Preset Section, hold down Page, then press the desired Preset button. 2. In the Preset Section, hold down Delete, then press the desired Preset button to delete that register from memory. The Touch Screen displays a confirmation message. rëáåÖ=kÉñí=~åÇ=mêÉîáçìë Use the following steps to utilize the Next function: 1. Check the available resources on Program. If the resources (layers) that you wish to recall are already in use on Program, they must first be cleared before the “recall” is permitted. 2. In the Preset Section, press Next to recall the next valid Preset in sequential order. Please note: Next ~ ~ 244 If Preset 2 is lit, pressing Next recalls Preset 3. If Preset 6 is active on page 2, pressing Next advances to Preset 1 on page 3. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Presets ~ If a Preset is undefined, it will be skipped when Next is pressed. Use the following steps to utilize the Previous function: Note 1. The Previous feature is currently not implemented. Information to be provided. Previous mêÉëÉí=kçíÉë Please note the following important points regarding Presets: • • • Active destinations (both standard and Aux) are stored as part of a Preset. Aux source selections are saved and recalled in Presets. If different Presets have different Move definitions stored for the same Layer, when you recall a Preset to a Layer that already has a PIP on Program, the starting location of the recalled Move is ignored. Instead, the PIP’s "current" location will be used as the move’s starting point, and the ending point from the recalled Preset will be used. In this manner, you can effectively recall a series of "end" points — all of which use the end point from the previous Preset as their new starting point. If you recall a Preset with a defined Move to an empty layer, both the starting and ending points of the recalled Move will be used. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 245 6. Operations Working with Still Frames tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=píáää=cê~ãÉë The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • • • Still Frame Capture Overview Capturing Still Frames from a Background Input Capturing Still Frames from a Layer Saving Still Frames in Permanent Memory Naming a Saved Still Frame píáää=cê~ãÉ=`~éíìêÉ=lîÉêîáÉï The ScreenPRO-II Controller enables you to capture still frames into each ScreenPRO-II’s three internal frame stores. The “sources” of the still frames are each ScreenPRO-II’s BG A and BG B inputs, or the scaled inputs (Layer A or B). Please note: • For widescreen destinations, even though you are using the frame stores of multiple ScreenPRO-II units, you are conceptually working with only three frame stores — each of which captures’s its “slice” of the complete widescreen image. • For single screen destinations, you are working with the individual destination’s three frame stores in the normal manner. Regarding captures: • All captures of the background (BG A or BG B) must occur on Preview — the desired full screen source to capture must be visible on Preview. You will get an error message if you attempt to capture while the source is on Program. • All captures of the layers (LAYER A or LAYER B) can occur on either Preview or Program. The system only captures the active layer in its current size and position, with no borders, and with black as the background. Note The "Preview" capture ensures that the Program output does not glitch when a live image is momentarily frozen and placed in temporary memory. Please note the following important prerequisites to all frame grab procedures: 246 • Ensure that you are familiar with the Background Input Setup Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Background Input Setup Menu" section on page 170. • Ensure that you are familiar with the Frame Grab Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Frame Grab Menu" section on page 142 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Still Frames `~éíìêáåÖ=píáää=cê~ãÉë=Ñêçã=~=_~ÅâÖêçìåÇ=fåéìí Use the following steps to capture a still frame from a background input: 1. Ensure that the background input from which you want to capture a still is properly set up as a DVI input. In Chapter 5, refer to the "Background Setup" section on page 205 for instructions. 2. Ensure that BG A, BG B or the DSK are not on Program. If they are, you will get a pop-up prompt. Transition these layers off Program in the normal manner. 3. If you want to capture from BG B, ensure that the DSK is not in use. 4. In the Layer Control Section, select the background from which you want to capture a still. The button blinks, the source appears on Preview, and the selected Background Input Setup Menu appears. 5. Press {HOME} > {FRAME GRAB} to display the Frame Grab Menu. 6. On the Frame Number line, select the temporary frame store into which the still will be captured (FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3). 7. Press {CAPTURE}. Once pressed, the screen will indicate that the frame is being captured. A pop-up message confirms the procedure. 8. Repeat the procedure from step 4 to capture additional stills from a background input. Remember that you can always overwrite FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3. Please note: • The captured still(s) can now be assigned as the input “type” for BG A, BG B, the DSK or the LOGO. In Chapter 5, refer to the following sections for instructions: ~ ~ ~ • "Background Setup," page 205. "DSK Setup Procedure," page 211. "LOGO Setup Procedure," page 212. Captured stills reside in temporary memory. If the system is powered down or reset, the stills will be lost. To save stills in permanent memory, refer to the "Saving Still Frames in Permanent Memory" section on page 248. Note Only "saved" still frames can be named. `~éíìêáåÖ=píáää=cê~ãÉë=Ñêçã=~=i~óÉê Use the following steps to capture a still frame from a layer. 1. Ensure that BG A, BG B or the DSK are not on Program. If they are, you will get a pop-up prompt. Transition these layers off Program in the normal manner. 2. In the Layer Control Section, select the layer from which you want to capture a still. The button blinks indicating that it is "selected." Note The layer can be on Program or Preview. 3. Select PIP or Key in the normal manner. The selected PIP or Key Adjustment Menu appears. 4. Adjust the PIP or Key’s size and position. Remember that: ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 247 6. Operations Working with Still Frames ~ The system will capture the "selected" layer in its current size and position, with no borders, and with black as the background. ~ If you have two layers on Preview, only the active (selected) layer will be captured, regardless of image priority. 5. Press {HOME} > {FRAME GRAB} to display the Frame Grab Menu. 6. On the Frame Number line, select the temporary frame store into which the still will be captured (FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3). 7. Press {CAPTURE}. Once pressed, the screen will indicate that the frame is being captured. A pop-up message confirms the procedure. 8. Repeat the procedure from step 1 to capture additional stills from a layer. Remember that you can always overwrite FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3. Please note: • The captured still(s) can now be assigned as the input “type” for BG A, BG B, the DSK or the LOGO. In Chapter 5, refer to the following sections for instructions: ~ ~ ~ • "Background Setup," page 205. "DSK Setup Procedure," page 211. "LOGO Setup Procedure," page 212. Captured stills reside in temporary memory. If the system is powered down or reset, the stills will be lost. To save stills in permanent memory, refer to the "Saving Still Frames in Permanent Memory" section on page 248. Note Only "saved" still frames can be named. p~îáåÖ=píáää=cê~ãÉë=áå=mÉêã~åÉåí=jÉãçêó Use the following steps to save a captured still into permanent memory. 1. Capture a still as outlined in the previous two sections. ~ ~ "Capturing Still Frames from a Background Input" on page 247. "Capturing Still Frames from a Layer" on page 247. Warning 2. On the Frame Grab Menu, use the Frame Number line to select the frame that you wish to save. 3. Press {SAVE} to save the captured frame into the selected storage register (FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3). Once pressed, the screen displays an important warning: 4. 248 Do not execute the next step during live production. All controls will be locked during the "save" process. It is recommended that you save your stills during pre-production as a "setup" procedure. ~ Press YES to save the frame. All front panel controls will be locked for up to three minutes. ~ Press NO to cancel the procedure. If required, press {DELETE} to delete the selected frame from permanent storage. This button only appears when frames are stored in permanent memory. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Still Frames k~ãáåÖ=~=p~îÉÇ=píáää=cê~ãÉ Use the following steps to name a saved still frame. 1. Ensure that the still you wish to name has been saved in permanent memory. If not, refer to the "Saving Still Frames in Permanent Memory" section on page 248. 2. Ensure that the Tally option is physically installed, and that a PS-2 keyboard is connected to the rear-panel Keyboard connector. 3. On the Frame Grab Menu, press {NAME} to display the Frame Grab Name Menu. 4. On the Saved Location line, select the frame that you wish to name. 5. Using the keyboard, enter the desired name. As you type, characters will appear in the menu’s New Name field. 6. Press Enter (on the PS-2 keyboard) to save the name. Once saved, the system "attaches" the name to the still in permanent memory. 7. Press {BACK} to return to the Frame Grab Menu. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 249 6. Operations Using the DSK rëáåÖ=íÜÉ=aph Use the following steps to perform a downstream key: DSK 1. Ensure that the DSK is properly set up. In Chapter 5, refer to the "DSK Setup Procedure" section on page 211 for instructions. 2. Ensure that BG B is not in use. Note In both single and widescreen modes, remember that BG B and the DSK are mutually exclusive. This occurs because the BG/DSK Input B is shared between the DSK and BG B on all individual ScreenPRO-II units. 3. In the Layer Control Section, press DSK to display the DSK Adjustment Menu. 4. Press {INPUT SETUP} to display the DSK Input Setup Menu. 5. On the ID line, select the ID of the ScreenPRO-II with which you want to perform the DSK. 6. On the Type line, selects the desired DSK source — None, DVI or a captured still frame (FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3). 7. Press {KEY} to return to the DSK Adjustment Menu. 8. Adjust DSK parameters as desired, including key type, invert, clip, gain, opacity and fill source. Refer to the "Modifying Keys" section on page 233 for details. Note 9. Not all parameters listed in the "Modifying Keys" section apply to a DSK. Perform a CUT or AUTO TRANS. 10. Clear the DSK from Program in the normal manner — by clearing its layer from Preview and then transitioning. 250 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Using the LOGO rëáåÖ=íÜÉ=ildl Use the following steps to transition the LOGO to Program: LOGO 1. Ensure that the LOGO is properly set up. In Chapter 5, refer to the "LOGO Setup Procedure" section on page 212 for instructions. 2. In the Layer Control Section, press LOGO to display the LOGO Menu. 3. On the Type line, selects the desired LOGO source — Black, or a captured still frame (FG_1, FG_2 or FG_3). 4. Perform a CUT or AUTO TRANS. 5. Clear the LOGO from Program in the normal manner — by clearing its layer from Preview and then transitioning. Please note: • In addition to its use as a full screen downstream graphic (with the highest visual layer priority), the LOGO layer can also be used as a convenient “black preview” function. This enables you to fade to black at any time, from any simple or complex setup, without affecting the underlying "look." • After a transition, the LOGO layer is automatically cleared from Preview. In this way the next transition will always fade up from black to your previous setup. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 251 6. Operations Locking and Unlocking the Controller içÅâáåÖ=~åÇ=råäçÅâáåÖ=íÜÉ=`çåíêçääÉê This section provides instructions for locking and unlocking the Controller. S Prerequisite: ~ Ensure that you are familiar with the Lockout Code Menu and its associated submenu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Lockout Code Menu” section on page 136. Use the following steps to lock the Controller: 1. On the Lockout Code Menu, select the type of lockout code you wish to use — once the panel is unlocked: Default or Custom. 2. If Custom is selected, use the Change Lockout Code Menu to enter the desired code. Make a note of the selected code. 3. To lock the Controller, press and hold the PAGE button (in the Presets Section), then press the ALL button (in the Destination/Aux Bus). The message "KEYBOARD LOCKED" appears on the menu. Use the following steps to unlock the Controller: 1. Press and hold the PAGE button, then press the ALL button. The Enter Lockout Code menu appears. 2. Use the eight numbered buttons on the Source Selection Bus to enter the code. ~ If the correct code has been entered, the message "Unlocking Controller" appears on the display, and the Controller is ready for use. ~ If the incorrect code has been entered, the Controller remains locked. Important 252 If you have selected a Custom lockout code, but you have forgotten the code, a Master Code is available. Refer to the ScreenPRO-II Controller system’s most current "Whatsnew_ScreenPRO-II Controller.txt" document for details. This document is bundled with every software download. Note that the Master Code changes with each software version. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 6. Operations Working with Tallies tçêâáåÖ=ïáíÜ=q~ääáÉë The "Tally" function can be enabled or disabled as required. Use the following steps to enable or disable tallies: 1. Ensure that your tallies are properly set up. In Chapter 5, refer to the "Input Patching" section on page 198 for instructions. 2. Press {HOME} > SYSTEM to display the System Menu. 3. On the Tally Mode line: ~ ~ Select On to enable all assigned tally relay closures. Select Off to disable all assigned tally relay closures. Please note: • Remember that tallies are mapped to inputs. When Tally Mode is On, if a "mapped" tally goes to Program, one of the associated eight tally circuits will be turned on. • When the "mapped" input is removed from Program, the associated tally will turn Off. • Tally functionality can be tested. Press {HOME} > SYSTEM > {DIAG} > {TALLY} to initiate the test. rëáåÖ=_~Åâìé=~åÇ=oÉëíçêÉ The ScreenPRO-II Controller system enables you to backup and restore the complete system setup including all Presets, using a customer supplied flash memory card. The following topics are discussed: • • System Backup System Restore póëíÉã=_~Åâìé This procedure enables you to back up your entire system configuration. Please note the following important points: • • You can only store one system configuration on a Flash Memory Card. Customer supplied Flash Memory Cards must be equal to or greater than 512MB. Use the following steps to back up your system: 1. Ensure that you have a (customer supplied) Flash Memory Card available. 2. Insert the Flash Memory Card into the Controller’s rear panel Memory Card slot. 3. From the Home Menu, press MISC to display the Miscellaneous Menu. 4. Press {BACKUP RESTORE} to display the Backup/Restore Menu. 5. On the Device line, select Ctrlr+SP to perform a complete backup, or select a subset as desired. 6. On the Controller Options line, select All, or select a subset as desired. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 253 6. Operations Using Backup and Restore 7. Press {CHECK CARD} to check for the presence of a Flash Memory Card. 8. Press {BACKUP} to perform a backup operation to the Flash Memory Card using the selected device(s) and options. póëíÉã=oÉëíçêÉ Please note the following important points regarding the "restore" function: • When restoring, you must have the same version of software installed in the Controller as was used to perform the backup. • Conversion between versions can only be done with the Barco Backup and Restore utility. Note The Barco Backup and Restore utility can be found in the ScreenPRO-II Controller software bundle — available via download from the website. Use the following steps to restore from the flash memory card: Please note the following important points: 1. Ensure that your flash memory card is properly inserted in the Controller’s MEMORY CARD slot on the rear panel. 2. On the Home Menu, press MISC to access the Miscellaneous Menu. 3. Press {BACKUP RESTORE} to display the Backup/Restore Menu. 4. Press {CHECK CARD} to ensure that the Controller recognizes the card. 5. On the Device line, select Ctrlr+SP to perform a complete restore, or select a subset as desired. 6. On the Controller Options line, select All, or select a subset as desired. 7. On the SP to Restore line, select All, or select a subset as desired. 8. Press {RESTORE} to restore the selected system configuration. At the conclusion of this procedure, your system is completely set up — exactly the way that you left it when you performed a complete system “backup.” 254 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë få=qÜáë=^ééÉåÇáñ This appendix provides detailed technical specifications for the ScreenPRO-II Controller. The following topics are provided: • • • • • • • • ScreenPRO-II Input Specifications ScreenPRO-II Output Specifications User Control Widescreen Functions Physical and Electrical Specifications Communications Specifications Pinouts ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 255 ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë ScreenPRO-II Input Specifications pÅêÉÉåmolJff=fåéìí=péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë= The table below lists input specifications for individual ScreenPRO-II units. Table A-1. ScreenPRO-II Input Specifications Parameter Scaled Channel Inputs Specification Analog inputs (8) — RGBHV / RGBS / RGsB computer video, YPbPr video (SD or HD), S-video, or composite video on 15-pin HD connector SD and HD-SDI Input (2 optional) — Per SMPTE 259M-C (NTSC / PAL resolution) SMPTE 292M (HDTV) on BNC connector Scaler Input Resolutions 480i Computer resolutions VGA (640 x 480) through UXGA (1600 x 1200) HDTV resolutions up to 1920 x 1080 (720p, 1080i, 1080p) 2048 x 1080p (Digital Cinema format) Plasma display resolutions Un-scaled Background / DSK Channel Inputs DVI Inputs (2) — Digital DVI per DDWG 1.0 on DVI-I connector Background / DSK Input Resolutions Computer resolutions: VGA (640 x 480) through UXGA (1600 x 1200) HDTV resolutions, progressive up to 1920 x 1080 (1080p) 2048 x 1080p (Digital Cinema format) Plasma display resolutions 256 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë ScreenPRO-II Output Specifications pÅêÉÉåmolJff=lìíéìí=péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë= The table below lists output specifications for individual ScreenPRO-II units. Table A-2. ScreenPRO-II Output Specifications Parameter Analog Outputs Specification RGBHV / RGBS / RGsB (non-interlaced only) on 15-pin HD connectors Preview and two Program monitor / projector outputs Digital Outputs Digital DVI per DDWG 1.0 on DVI-I connector (Program output) Output Resolutions Computer resolutions VGA (640 x 480) through UXGA (1600 x 1200) HDTV resolutions, progressive up to 1920 x 1080 (1080p) 2048 x 1080p (Digital Cinema format) Plasma display resolutions rëÉê=`çåíêçä= The table below lists ScreenPRO-II Controller user control specifications. Table A-3. ScreenPRO-II Controller User Control Specifications Parameter Specification LCD Touchscreen 3.8”, 320 x 240 pixel resolution Soft keys 8 Rotary Encoders 2 LED Pushbuttons 58, color coded ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 257 ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë Widescreen Functions táÇÉëÅêÉÉå=cìåÅíáçåë The table below lists ScreenPRO-II Controller widescreen functions. Table A-4. ScreenPRO-II Controller Widescreen Functions Parameter Specification Maximum widescreen width 4 screens Maximum widescreen destinations 1 (1 BlendPRO-II) * Widescreen operation Same as Encore 1 x ME system Transitions Transitioning background plus 1 transitioning widescreen PIP (same as Encore 1 x ME system) Clone Mode Same as Encore Note * Additional BlendPRO-II units connected to the ScreenPROII Controller system will not be recognized. mÜóëáÅ~ä=~åÇ=bäÉÅíêáÅ~ä=péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë= The table below lists ScreenPRO-II Controller physical and electrical specifications. Table A-5. ScreenPRO-II Controller Physical and Electrical Specifications Parameter Specification Power 120-240 VAC - 50/60 Hz., Auto-selecting 1.0A maximum Console Light XLR connector Mechanical H: 5.95 inches (15.13 cm) W: 17.00 inches (43.18 cm) D: 10.00 inches (25.40 cm) See below for additional dimensions 258 Weight 17 lbs (13.11 kg) Estimated Temperature 0-40 degrees C Humidity 0-95% non-condensing ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë Communications Specifications Please note the following additional mechanical specifications: 4.57" (11.60 cm) 12° 6.72" (17.06 cm) 4.82" (12.24 cm) 2.12" (5.38 cm) 1.22" (3.09 cm) 0.25" (0.63 cm) 11.50" (29.21 cm) 12.72" (32.30 cm) Figure A-1. ScreenPRO-II Controller Side View `çããìåáÅ~íáçåë=péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë= The table below lists ScreenPRO-II Controller communications specifications. Table A-6. ScreenPRO-II Controller Communications Specifications Parameter Specification Ethernet RJ-45, 10/100 Mbps Autosense RS-232 Console: DB-9 Female, DCE, 115k Baud EXT Comm: DB-9 Female, DCE, 115k Baud Flash Memory Card Type 1 compliant Tally (Optional) DB-25 male, Dry-contact relay closures 1 Amp at 30 VDC 0.5 Amps at 125 VDC ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 259 ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë Pinouts máåçìíë= The following topics are discussed in this section: • • • Ethernet Connector Serial Connector Tally Connector bíÜÉêåÉí=`çååÉÅíçê The figure below illustrates the ScreenPRO-II Controller Ethernet connector: 1 8 Figure A-2. Ethernet Connector The table below lists Ethernet connector pinouts. Table A-7. Ethernet Connector Pinouts Pin Wire Color 1 TX Data + White / Orange 2 TX Data - Orange 3 RX Data + White / Green 4 Blue 5 White / Blue 6 260 Signal RX Data - Green 7 White / Brown 8 Brown ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë Pinouts pÉêá~ä=`çååÉÅíçê The figure below illustrates the ScreenPRO-II Controller serial connector, which is used for both the Ext Comm and Console Port connections. 5 1 9 6 Figure A-3. Serial Connector The table below lists Serial connector pinouts. Table A-8. Serial Connector Pinouts Pin RS-232 Signal Description 1 CD Carrier Detect 2 RXD Received Data 3 TXD Transmitted Data 4 DTR Data Terminal Ready 5 GND Signal Ground 6 DSR Data Set Ready 7 RTS Request To Send 8 CTS Clear To Send 9 RI Unused Please note: • • The port is configured as a DCE, 115K Baud, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, no parity bits. The serial port can be connected to a standard PC serial port with a straight through DB-9 to DB-9 cable. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 261 ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë Pinouts q~ääó=`çååÉÅíçê One 25-pin D connector is provided for issuing tally “relay closure” commands to external devices. Eight tally circuits are provided. Please note: • Tally outputs provide dry-contact relay closures between signal pairs or contact closures to ground, whenever the corresponding input source is selected for display on a Program output. • • • Tally outputs may be used to signal when input devices (cameras) are “live.” Each contact has a rating of 1 Amp at 30 VDC, and 0.5 Amps at 125 VDC. A mating connector is required — see the diagrams below. 1 13 14 1 14 13 25 25 Figure A-4. Tally Connector and Circuit The table below lists Tally Connector pinouts: Table A-9. Tally Connector Pinouts Pin 262 Signal Pin Signal 1 Tally 1 contact closure 14 Tally 8 contact closure 2 Tally 1 contact closure 15 Tally 2 contact closure 3 Tally 2 grounding closure 16 Tally 2 contact closure 4 Tally 3 contact closure 17 Tally 3 grounding closure 5 Tally 3 contact closure 18 Tally 4 contact closure 6 Tally 4 grounding closure 19 Tally 4 contact closure 7 Tally 5 contact closure 20 Tally 5 grounding closure 8 Tally 5 contact closure 21 Tally 6 contact closure 9 Tally 6 grounding closure 22 Tally 6 contact closure 10 Tally 7 contact closure 23 Tally 7 grounding closure 11 Tally 7 contact closure 24 Tally 8 contact closure 12 Tally 8 grounding closure 25 Tally 8 contact closure 13 Signal ground ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions pÅêÉÉåmolJff=fåéìí=~åÇ=lìíéìí=oÉëçäìíáçåë This section provides a comprehensive list of available input and output resolutions on the individual ScreenPRO-II units. These resolutions can be assigned to the selected input on the Input Menu, and as the system’s output format on the Output Menu. In Chapter 4, refer to the “Input Menu Description” and “Output Menu Description” sections for details. Note Please contact Barco Technical Support if you would like to request the addition of a new resolution. Input and output resolutions are listed below. Each entry lists Format @Fv (Hz). Important • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • ScreenPRO-II Controller does not support interlaced output resolutions. All interlaced video formats listed below are supported as inputs only, and noted as such in red. NTSC (480i) (Input Only) 720x480p PAL (576i) (Input Only) 720x575p 640x480 @59.94 640x480 @60 640x480 @72 640x480 @75 640x480 @85 800x600 @50 800x600 @56 800x600 @59.94 800x600 @60 800x600 @72 800x600 @75 800x600 @85 1024x768 @47.95 1024x768 @48 1024x768 @50 1024x768 @59.94 1024x768 @60 1024x768 @70 1024x768 @71.93 1024x768 @72 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 263 ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • 264 1024x768 @75 1024x768 @85 1152x864 @75 1280x768 @47.95 1280x768 @48 1280x768 @50 1280x768 @59.94 1280x768 @75 1280x960 @50 1280x960 @59.94 1280x960 @60 1280x960 @85 1280x1024 @47.95 1280x1024 @48 1280x1024 @50 1280x1024 @59.94 1280x1024 @60 1280x1024 @71.93 1280x1024 @72 1280x1024 @75 1280x1024 @85 1364x768 @47.95 1364x768 @48 1364x768 @50 1364x768 @59.94 1364x768 @75 1364x1024 @47.95 1364x1024 @48 1364x1024 @50 1364x1024 @59.94 1364x1024 @75 1400x1050 @48 1400x1050 @50 1400x1050 @59.94 1400x1050 @60 1400x1050 @75 1680x1050 @60 1600x1200 @47.95 1600x1200 @48 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • 1600x1200 @50 1600x1200 @59.94 1600x1200 @60 1280x720p @50 1280x720p @59.94 1280x720p @60 1920x1080p @23.98 1920x1080p @24 1920x1080p @25 1920x1080p @29.97 1920x1080p @30 1920x1080p @50 1920x1080p @59.94 1920x1080p @60 1920x1080sF @23.98 1920x1080sF @24 1920x1080i @50 (Input Only) 1920x1080i @59.94 (Input Only) 1920x1080i @60 (Input Only) 2048x1080p @50 2048x1080p @59.94 2048x1080p @60 1920x1200p @60 Apple 1200p @60 875p ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 265 ^K==péÉÅáÑáÅ~íáçåë ScreenPRO-II Input and Output Resolutions 266 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide _K==`çåí~Åí=fåÑçêã~íáçå få=qÜáë=^ééÉåÇáñ The following topics are discussed in this Appendix: • • • Warranty Return Material Authorization (RMA) Contact Information t~êê~åíó All video products are designed and tested to the highest quality standards and are backed by a full 3-year parts and labor warranty. Warranties are effective upon delivery date to customer and are non-transferable. Barco warranties are only valid to the original purchaser/owner. Warranty related repairs include parts and labor, but do not include faults resulting from user negligence, special modifications, lightning strikes, abuse (drop/crush), and/or other unusual damages. The customer shall pay shipping charges when unit is returned for repair. Barco will cover shipping charges for return shipments to customers. oÉíìêå=j~íÉêá~ä=^ìíÜçêáò~íáçå=Eoj^F In the unlikely event that a product is required to return for repair, please call the Technical Support / Customer Service direct line, and ask to receive a Return Merchandise Authorization number (RMA). • (866) 374-7878 RMA Conditions are listed below: a. Prior to returning any item, you must receive a Return Merchandise Authorization (RMA) number. b. All RMA numbers must appear on their return-shipping label. c. RMA numbers are valid for ten (10) days from issue date. d. All shipping and insurance charges on all RMAs must be prepaid by the customer ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 267 _K==`çåí~Åí=fåÑçêã~íáçå Contact Information `çåí~Åí=fåÑçêã~íáçå Barco Media and Entertainment 11101 Trade Center Drive Rancho Cordova, California 95670 USA • • • Phone: (916) 859-2500 Fax: (916) 859-2515 Websites: ~ ~ www.folsom.com www.events.barco.com Sales Contact Information • • • Direct: (916) 859-2505 Toll Free: (888) 414-7226 E-mail: folsomsales@barco.com Barco N.V. Noordlaan 5 8520 Kuurne BELGIUM • • • Phone: +32 56.36.82.11 Fax: +32 56.35.16.51 Website: www.events.barco.com Technical Support / Customer Service Information • • 268 Tech Line: (866) 374-7878 — 24 hours per day, 7 days per week E-mail: folsomsupport@barco.com ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide `K==réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ få=qÜáë=^ééÉåÇáñ The following topics are discussed in this Appendix: • • • • • • Software Upgrade Overview Hardware Requirements Software Requirements Downloading Software Serial Upgrade Method Ethernet Upgrade Method ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 269 `K==réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ Software Upgrade Overview pçÑíï~êÉ=réÖê~ÇÉ=lîÉêîáÉï Firmware files for the ScreenPRO-II Controller system are loaded into the hardware at power-up. These files are stored in the unit’s onboard flash memory, which can be upgraded using a serial or Ethernet connection to a PC (or laptop). The desired connection is made through the Console or Ethernet port on the ScreenPROII Controller’s rear panel, in conjunction with the “Flash Loader” utility supplied with each upgrade. The Flash Loader enables you to update the Flash memory with the latest software revision. The utility should be run from a PC’s hard drive (recommended). e~êÇï~êÉ=oÉèìáêÉãÉåíë The following hardware items are required to upgrade the ScreenPRO-II Controller: • IBM compatible computer with an available COM port or Ethernet port. If you elect to connect serially, a serial cable conforming to EIA RS-232 specifications (e.g., standard modem cable) is required. The cable should have a DB-9 male connector on one end (for connection to the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s Console port), and the appropriate connector on the other end for connection to your PC (typically, a DB-9). pçÑíï~êÉ=oÉèìáêÉãÉåíë The following list outlines software requirements for upgrading the ScreenPRO-II Controller: • Ensure that your PC (or laptop) uses the Windows® 2000 or XP operating systems. • Software files: ~ Flash File Loader. (This software enables the PC to send commands to the ScreenPRO-II Controller.) ~ ~ ScreenPRO-II Controller software Note What’s New File All software files listed above (and more) are contained in the file that you will download. Software files can be downloaded from either the Folsom FTP site or the Barco Folsom website, as described in the following “Downloading Software” section on page 271. 270 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide `K==réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ Downloading Software açïåäç~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ Two different methods can be used to download ScreenPRO-II Controller software and the Flash File Loader utility: • • Via FTP Site Via Web Site sá~=cqm=páíÉ Barco Folsom's FTP site address is: ftp.folsom.com To download from the FTP site: 1. Create a target folder on your PC (e.g., ScreenPRO-II Controller). 2. If you are using an FTP client, logon to our site as follows: ~ ~ User name: anonymous Password: your email address S Example: johndoe@somecompany.com If you are using a web browser to access our FTP site, point the browser to: ftp://ftp.folsom.com 3. Once logged on, navigate to the following directory: ftp://ftp.folsom.com/Products/Video/ScreenPROII_Controller/ 4. Transfer the following file to the target folder on your PC: ScreenProController_Rev#.##.EXE 5. As required, please continue with the “Serial Upgrade Method” section on page 272, or the “Ethernet Upgrade Method” section on page 274. sá~=tÉÄ=páíÉ Barco Folsom's web site address is: http://www.folsom.com To download from the web site: 1. Create a target folder on your PC (e.g., ScreenPRO-II Controller). 2. On the web, navigate to http://video.folsom.com. 3. Click “Downloads” to access the Downloads Page. 4. Using the “Select Video Product” pull-down menu, click ScreenPRO-II Controller. 5. In the “Software” section, click the Download button for the latest version of system software. 6. When the File Download Dialog appears, click Save to save the file to your computer. 7. When the Save As Dialog appears, navigate to the target folder and click Save. 8. As required, please continue with the “Serial Upgrade Method” section on page 272, or the “Ethernet Upgrade Method” section on page 274. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 271 `K==réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ Serial Upgrade Method pÉêá~ä=réÖê~ÇÉ=jÉíÜçÇ Use the following steps to upgrade ScreenPRO-II Controller software using a serial connection to your PC: 1. With the download complete, navigate to the target folder and double-click the EXE to launch the installation shield. 2. Follow the prompts to install the upgrade package. At the conclusion of the procedure, a new path will be created under Start > Programs > Barco Folsom. 3. Connect the Console port on the back of the ScreenPRO-II Controller to the COM 1 port on your PC. 4. Power-up the ScreenPRO-II Controller. 5. On the PC, click Start > Programs > Barco Folsom > ScreenPRO-II Controller Software #.## > Flash Loader to launch the Flash Loader utility. Figure C-1. Flash Loader Utility Note 272 If you have not used the COM 1 port on your PC, an error message will be shown at the bottom of the Flash Loader. 6. Click Communication > RS232 Config > Baud, and select 115200. 7. Click Communication > RS232 Config > COM Port, and select the COM port on your PC to which ScreenPRO-II Controller is connected. If no other programs are using the port, the “Established communications” message appears at the bottom of the Flash Loader. 8. To verify communications between the PC and ScreenPRO-II Controller: a. In the Flash Loader, click in the black terminal window area. b. Note the condition of the status lights: DCD and CTS should be red. • TXD and RXD should be green. They will flash if Enter is • pressed. c. Press Enter a few times to display the system prompt “#” on screen. d. If the prompt does not appear, continue with step 9 (troubleshooting). e. If the prompt appears, continue with step 10 (uploading files). ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide `K==réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ Serial Upgrade Method 9. To troubleshoot the serial connection: a. If the DCD and CTS status lights are green, re-check the communication settings in the loader, and verify that the COM port and Baud Rate settings are correct. b. To verify ScreenPRO-II Controller communication settings, press {HOME} > MISC > {CONSL} to display the Console Port Setup Menu. c. Verify the following settings: • Baud rate = 115200 • Data Bits = 8 • Parity = None • Stop Bits = 1 d. Repeat steps 7 and 8 above, then re-check the status lights. e. With communication status OK, continue with step 10. 10. To upload files to ScreenPRO-II Controller, click "Open script file to read and upload." 11. In the dialog, select "Complete_Load.sld" and click Open. The ScreenPRO-II Controller menu should immediately display the "System in LOADER MODE" message. 12. It takes several minutes to load the flash memory. When complete, the Flash Loader utility displays the “Upload Complete” message. Click OK to continue. 13. Cycle power on the ScreenPRO-II Controller, and exit the Flash Loader utility. 14. On ScreenPRO-II Controller, perform a factory reset. In Chapter 5, refer to the “Return to Factory Default” section on page 189 for instructions. 15. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller, verify that the new software has been loaded correctly. Press {HOME} > SYSTEM > {SW VER} to display the Software Version Menu. This completes the software upgrade procedure via serial communications. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 273 `K==réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ Ethernet Upgrade Method bíÜÉêåÉí=réÖê~ÇÉ=jÉíÜçÇ Use the following steps to upgrade ScreenPRO-II Controller software using an Ethernet connection to your PC: Note The default IP address is 192.168.0.2. 1. Ensure that your PC (or laptop) uses the Windows® 2000 or XP operating systems. 2. Connect the ScreenPRO-II Controller’s Ethernet port to a Hub or Switch. 3. Connect the Ethernet Hub or Switch to your PC. Remember that a totally “local” network is recommended, without IP connections to the outside world. 4. Power-up the ScreenPRO-II Controller. 5. On the PC, click Start > Programs > Barco Folsom > ScreenPRO-II Controller Software #.## > Flash Loader to launch the Flash Loader utility. Figure C-2. Flash Loader Utility 6. Click Communication > Ethernet > Connect to display the Ethernet Connection Dialog. Figure C-3. Ethernet Connection Dialog (sample) Note 7. 274 If the Ethernet menu pick is grayed out, set the COM port to None. In the dialog, enter ScreenPRO-II Controller’s IP address (192.168.0.2), and enter the default port number: 3000. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide `K==réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ Ethernet Upgrade Method 8. Click the Connect button. If the connection is successfully, the message “Connect via Ethernet successful” appears in the Flash Loader’s Status Bar. If you cannot connect, refer to the “Troubleshooting Ethernet Communication” section on page 275. 9. To upload files to the ScreenPRO-II Controller, click "Open script file to read and upload." 10. In the dialog, select "Complete_Load.sld" and click Open. The ScreenPRO-II Controller menu should immediately display the "System in LOADER MODE" message. 11. It takes several minutes to load the flash memory. When complete, the Flash Loader utility displays the “Upload Complete” message. Click OK to continue. 12. Cycle power on the ScreenPRO-II Controller, and exit the Flash Loader utility. 13. On ScreenPRO-II Controller, perform a factory reset. In Chapter 5, refer to the “Return to Factory Default” section on page 189 for instructions. 14. On the ScreenPRO-II Controller, verify that the new software has been loaded correctly. Press {HOME} > SYSTEM > {SW VER} to display the Software Version Menu. qêçìÄäÉëÜççíáåÖ=bíÜÉêåÉí=`çããìåáÅ~íáçå Use the following steps to determine the IP address of ScreenPRO-II Controller, and establish proper communications: Note The default IP address is 192.168.0.2. 1. Turn on the ScreenPRO-II Controller. Press {HOME} > SYSTEM > {NETWORK SETUP} to display the Network Setup Menu. 2. Make a note of the IP address. 3. Attempt to ping the ScreenPRO-II Controller as follows: a. Connect ScreenPRO-II Controller’s Ethernet port to a Hub or Switch. b. Connect the Ethernet Hub or Switch to your PC. A totally “local” network is recommended, without IP connections to the outside world. c. Turn on the PC or laptop. d. Open a command prompt window on the PC. Click Start > Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt. e. On the command prompt line, type: ping 192.168.0.2 ... followed by Enter. Note f. Use the unit’s actual IP address, as determined in step 2 above. If the computer is able to successfully communicate with the ScreenPRO-II Controller, you will see a series of “replies” from the target IP address. Repeat the upgrade procedure as outlined in the “Ethernet Upgrade Method” section on page 274. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide 275 `K==réÖê~ÇáåÖ=pçÑíï~êÉ Ethernet Upgrade Method g. If you see a “Request timed out” message, the PC is unable to locate and communicate with the ScreenPRO-II Controller. If this is the case: • • • 276 Check your network connections and settings as described above, or ... Contact your network administrator, or ... Contact Technical Support. In Appendix B, refer to the “Contact Information” section on page 268 for details. ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide fåÇÉñ ô=jÉåì=_ìííçåë=õ {ADD NEW} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 {ADD PATCH} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126, 132 {ADD} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 {APPLY FORMAT} . . . . . . . . . . .90, 92, 102, 175 {AR} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 {ASPECT RATIO} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 {AUX SETUP} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 {BACK} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86 {BACKUP RESTORE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134, 141 {BACKUP} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 {BLACK} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 174 {BORDER} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 {BORDR} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 {CAPTURE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 {CFG} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92, 93 {CHANGE CODE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 {CHECK CARD} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 {CHECK TERM} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 {COLOR BALANCE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92, 98 {COMM SETUP} . . . . . . . . . .127, 128, 129, 130 {CONSL} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134, 135 {DELETE PATCH} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126, 132 {DELETE ROUTER} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 {DELETE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93, 144 {DEST SETUP} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109, 117 {DIAG} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109, 113 {DISCOVER LTRX} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 {DOWNLOAD CODE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112, 188 {DSK} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 {EDID} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134, 137 {EFX} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150, 153, 161, 169 {ERASE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 {FORCE ACQUIRE} . . . . . . . . . .92, 96, 98, 175 {FORCE DOWNLOAD} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 {GLCK} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102, 103 {GRAB COLOR} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 180 {HOME} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86 {INPUT PATCH} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110, 125 {INPUT SETUP} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179, 180 {KEY DETECT} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113, 116 {KEY} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 161, 169 {LCD CAL} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide {LCD SETTINGS} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134, 139 {LIGHT ADJUST} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134, 138 {LOCK} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134, 136 {MATTE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 161, 169, 173 {MAX} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 174 {MIN} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 174 {NAME} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 {NETWORK SETUP} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109, 124 {NEXT IP QUAD} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 {OUTPUT PATCH} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128, 132 {PICK COLOR} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 180 {PIP} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 {PROGRAM EDID} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137 {RECALL} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 {REMOVE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 {RESET ALL} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 {RESET RGB} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 {RESET} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109, 111, 123 {RESTORE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 {ROTARY ENCODER} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113, 114 {ROUTER SETUP} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110, 127 {SAVE} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92, 93, 96, 97 {SETTINGS} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102, 104 {SHADOW} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 {SHDOW} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150, 152 {SIZE & POS} . . . . . . . . . . . .157, 158, 159, 160 {SIZING} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92, 95 {START LED TEST} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 {STATS} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157, 161, 169, 179 {SW VER} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109, 112 {TALLY} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 {TBAR & JOYSTICK} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113, 115 {TEST COMM} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 {TEST PATTERN} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102, 105 {TRACK RGB} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159 {TRACK SIZE} . . . . . . . . . . . .150, 152, 161, 168 {USER PREF} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134, 140 {WIDE SCREEN} . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102, 106 kìãÉêáÅë 1-1 Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95 1-1 Sizing Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95 277 Index ^ AC connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Acrobat usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 navigating and searching . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 Activate destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222 Adapter information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 Address, company . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 Adjustable feet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Adjustment color balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210 phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209 Alignment Test Pattern . . . . . . . . .106, 107, 204 All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41, 42 test pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 ALL SP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 Analog preview output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 router name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 router output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 Application configurator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 Aspect ratio menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 Auto Trans button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51 Aux destination . . . . . . . . . . . . 41, 117, 120, 195 blank connection chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120, 195, 196 setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 setup overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195 _ Background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48 DVI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 FG_1, FG_2, FG_3 . . . . . . . . . . . .172, 176 format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 input setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170 input setup menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171 LOS (loss of signal) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 matte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 menu functions, DVI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175 menu functions, frame grab . . . . . . . . . .176 menu functions, matte . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173 menu functions, shared . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 setup sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 still frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 Backup and restore utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254 system configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 278 system, flash memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 Backup/Restore controller options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 SP to restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 BG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48 B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48 matte menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174 Black invalid video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140 LOGO source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 Blank connection charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 BlendPRO-II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31 version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 widescreen lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 widescreen lock connection . . . . . . . . . . .77 Blue color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157, 179 contrast and brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 mask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 180 matte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 174 threshold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 180 Border color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 size specified in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 Bottom edge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 right . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43, 164 BPII Program output monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 test pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 Brackets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86 Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 Brite, LCD settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 Burst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 Bus destination/aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35, 40 source selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 Button color, use of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36 source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Index ` Cable information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 Calibration, touch screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 Capture format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 still frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176 still frame from background input . . . . . .247 still frame from layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 still frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143, 246 Card slot, memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Center justified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218 configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 Change history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6 lockout code menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 Chapter structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16 Chart blank connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 blank, Aux destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72 blank, DVI connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70 blank, external routing, analog router I/O .66 blank, external routing, digital router I/O . .67 blank, internal routing, analog inputs . . . .68 blank, internal routing, digital inputs . . . . .69 blank, standard destinations . . . . . . . . . . .71 Charts connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 connection, overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 Check termination status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Checksum Mismatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 Clear destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 layer, button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 layers from program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234 Clip DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Clock Phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 Clone button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 menu parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163 offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 Code, downloading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188 Color balance menu description . . . . . . . . . . . .98 bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 border . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 key functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91, 102 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Color balance adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210 setup, widescreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209 Combinations, system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 Comm setup menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 Communication Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 Communications specifications . . . . . . . . . . .259 Company address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 Composite sources, color balance . . . . . . . . .99 Configuration center justified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 dual destination plus widescreen . . . . . . .25 dual destination system . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 dual destination, dual Aux . . . . . . . . . . . .26 left justified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 monitor layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217 operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217 quadruple destination system . . . . . . . . . .24 save system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213 Configurator application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 Configure ScreenPRO-II outputs . . . . . . . . . .101 Connection BlendPRO-II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 Ethernet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 Genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 serial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 tally . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 widescreen lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77 Connection charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 blank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 sample, external routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 sample, internal routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62 Connector AC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 controller keyboard port . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 controller tally . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Ethernet pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 serial pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261 tally . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262 Console port controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 setup menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 Contact information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268 sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268 Contrast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 LCD settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 adjustable feet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 console port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 ext comm port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 279 Index keyboard port connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 lock and unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 memory card slot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 options, backup/restore . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 tally connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18 Copy down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123 Copyright . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2 Crop background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175 bottom right . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 H Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 top left . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 V Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 Ctrlr IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 Current name, frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Custom lockout code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136, 252 Customer service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268 Cut button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51 transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 Cut + Fill how to use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 key functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 a Data bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 doubling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 Default IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274 lockout code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 router input patch table . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198 router output patch table . . . . . . . . . . . . .194 Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 Delete applies to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 frame from memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 preset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Description joystick section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 layer control section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48 layer functions section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 preset section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 source selection bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 touch screen menu section . . . . . . . . . . .38 transition section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 280 DEST/AUX button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90, 102 activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222 Aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Aux setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 Aux, blank chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72 Aux, ImagePRO Aux, PrePRO-II Aux . . 117 clear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 ImagePRO Aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 ImagePRO aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 PrePRO-II Aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 PresentationPRO-II Aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 route sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 routing examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 setup Aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195, 196 setup overview, Aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195 setup PrePRO-II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196 setup standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192 setup, ImagePRO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196 single screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 standard, blank chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71 status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 wide screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Destination/Aux bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35, 40 buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Destinations activate and deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222 clear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 route standard and aux . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222 Device, reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 DHCP enable/disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186 network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 Diagnostics setup menu description . . . . . . . 113 Dialog, Ethernet connection . . . . . . . . . . . . .274 Direct Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 Display calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 Documentation conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18 symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18 terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18 Download software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271 via FTP site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271 via web site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271 Downloading code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188 DSK adjustment menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 adjustment menu description, color . . . .179 adjustment menu description, luma . . . .178 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 clip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Index color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 DVI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 FG_1, FG_2, FG_3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 fill source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179 gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56, 180 input setup menu description . . . . . . . . .180 invert mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 LOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 luma . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 luma key functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177 none . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 opacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179, 180 priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250 Dual destination dual Aux system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26 plus widescreen system . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 DVI background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 background menu functions . . . . . . . . . .175 connection, blank chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 router name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123 router output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123 DVILink 18x18 Router Support . . . . . . . . . . .128 b Edge butted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 feathering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82 width, transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 Edge blending technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79 content creation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79 high definition image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79 introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79 multi-head graphics boards . . . . . . . . . . .80 video processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 EDID DVI input format menu description . . . . .137 format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137 programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190 EDS200 device server, Lantronix . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 Effect, key frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 EFFECTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Effects combinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27 hue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 invert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide monochrome mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 strobe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 strobe interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 Electrical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258 Equipment list, installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 marking terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 Erase selected frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 Ethernet connection dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274 connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 connector pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 Exclamation Points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86 Ext Comm port settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 port, controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Extended Display Identification Data . . . . . . .137 External routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 blank chart, analog router I/O . . . . . . . . . .66 blank chart, digital router I/O . . . . . . . . . .67 chart, sample analog router I/O . . . . . . . .59 chart, sample digital router I/O . . . . . . . . .59 c Factory default, return to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189 FCC statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2 Feathering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 edge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82 Features, ScreenPRO-II Controller . . . . . . . . .20 Feet, adjustable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 FG_1, FG_2, FG_3, DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 File mapping, understanding . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 Fill matte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 self . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 source, DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179 source, key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Fine adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161 source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169 Firmware files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270 Flash loader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272 memory backup, setup procedure . . . . .213 memory card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32, 141 memory, restore from . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191 Force acquire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175 281 Index EDID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 setup output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199 Formula, total H res . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 FRAME GRAB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Frame grab background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 background menu functions . . . . . . . . . .176 capture format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 current name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 erase selected . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 frame number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 menu functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142 name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 name menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 new name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 save frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 saved location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 single screen destinations . . . . . . . . . . .143 widescreen destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Freeze button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 FTP site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271 Full Screen button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 Fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 d Gain DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Gamma . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91, 104 feathering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 General operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 Genlock connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 loop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201 single screen destinations . . . . . . . . . . .103 source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 termination menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118, 119 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 widescreen destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 widescreen lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 282 Global rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86 Gray Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 Green color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157, 179 contrast and brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 mask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 180 matte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 174 threshold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 179 Grid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 Guarantee and compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2 e H active . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 pos, shadow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 position, key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 position, PIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 position, source adjustment . . . . . . . . . .168 ramp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 size, crop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 size, key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 size, PIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 size, shadow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 size, source adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31 installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53 requirements, upgrading software . . . . .270 High definition image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79 History, change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6 Home menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 How to activate and deactivate destinations . . .222 adjust raster box size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220 back up system to flash memory . .213, 253 calibrate touch screen . . . . . . . . . .189, 217 capture still frame from a layer . . . . . . . .247 capture still from background input . . . .247 change layer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 clear destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 clear layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234 connect BlendPRO-II widescreen lock . . .77 delete presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 download code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188 enable or disable tallies . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 enable widescreen markers . . . . . . . . . .218 install ScreenPRO-II Controller . . . . . . . .73 lock controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 modify keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233 modify layers on program . . . . . . . . . . . .234 modify PIPs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230 name a saved still frame . . . . . . . . . . . .249 patch router inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198 pend move on preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Index pend move on program . . . . . . . . . . . . .240 perform a cut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 perform a mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 perform a wipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 perform background transition . . . . . . . .227 perform background transitions . . . . . . .227 perform DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250 perform manual transition . . . . . . . . . . . .242 power up system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187 program EDID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190 program move on preview . . . . . . . . . . .238 program move on program . . . . . . . . . . .239 recall presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 restore from flash memory . . . . . . . . . . .191 restore system from flash memory . . . . .254 return to factory default . . . . . . . . . . . . .189 route aux and standard destinations . . .223 save setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213 save still frame in permanent memory . .248 set up Aux destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . .196 set up background sources . . . . . . . . . .205 set up DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 set up genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201 set up ID and remote enable . . . . . . . . .186 set up ImagePRO Aux destination . . . . .196 set up LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212 set up output format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199 set up PrePRO-II Aux destination . . . . .196 set up routers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193 set up single screen projectors . . . . . . . .202 set up standard inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 set up sync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200 set up wide screen projectors . . . . . . . . .203 set up widescreen color balance . . . . . .210 set up widescreen phase, YUV, RGB . . .209 set user preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 setup standard destinations . . . . . . . . . .192 store presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 switch sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 troubleshoot Ethernet connection . . . . . .275 unlock controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 upgrade software via Ethernet . . . . . . . .274 upgrade software via serial . . . . . . . . . . .272 use clone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 use cut + fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 use destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222 use freeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 use full screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 use join mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237 use Keys in mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 use Keys in split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231 use LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251 use move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238, 239 use next . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 use PIPs in mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229 use PIPs in split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229 use previous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide use reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237 use swap z-order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 use this guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 work with layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 Hue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 Hyperlinks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 f ID remote enable setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186 system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 Image effects menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 overlap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 ImagePRO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 Aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 Aux destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41, 117, 195 destination setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196 ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 Information cables and adapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 INPUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87, 89 Input background and DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 configuration menu description . . . . . . . .93 connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 default router patch table . . . . . . . . . . . .198 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 menu functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 patch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 patching setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198 resolution specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .263 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 source adjustment menu description . . .167 source patch menu description . . . . . . .125 SP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256 sub menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 sync type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 Installation controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 equipment list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53 safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 site preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 unpacking and inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 283 Index Instructions, connection charts . . . . . . . . . . . .56 Internal routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 blank chart, analog inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 blank chart, digital inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . .69 chart, sample analog inputs . . . . . . . . . . .63 chart, sample digital inputs . . . . . . . . . . . .63 Interval (frames), strobe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 Introduction, edge blending technology . . . . . .79 Invalid video, black . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140 Invert effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 mode, DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 mode, key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 address, default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274 address, router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 port number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 range, from/to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 g Join mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 mode, using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237 Joystick section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 section, description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 h Key 284 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 adjustment menu description . . . . . . . . .160 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 clip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 color functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 cut + fill functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 detect menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 fill source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 FINE ADJUST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161 frame effect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150, 160, 168 functions, luma . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 H Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 H Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 invert mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156 menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155, 166 modifying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233 move rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 opacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157, 158 priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161 source adjustment menu description . . .167 sub menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 switch sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156 using with mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 using with split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231 V Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 V Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 Key Frame Effect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 Keyboard port, controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Keypad backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138 i Lantronix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 model EDS200 Device Server . . . . . . . . .74 setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19, 90 buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 clear from program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234 control section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 control section, description . . . . . . . . . . . .48 functions section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 functions section, description . . . . . . . . . .46 functions, working with . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 how to change mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 how to clear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234 overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 working with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 LCD Brite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 contrast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 settings menu description . . . . . . . . . . . .139 Learn preset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 LED, red . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39, 44, 45 Left edge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 justified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218 justified configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 Leitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 Light adjustment knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 Lock and unlock controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 widescreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75, 119 Lockout code custom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 programmable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 menu functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Index setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212 source black . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251 Lookahead preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48, 219 LOS background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 loss of signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 scaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 Loss of signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 Luma DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 key functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 key functions, DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 j M/E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 MAC Addr, Lantronix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Macrovision copy protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 Manual transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51, 242 Manufacturer, router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 Marker Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 Markers center justified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218 left justified . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218 wide screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218 Master Code, lockout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 MatrixPRO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20, 125 Matte background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 background menu functions . . . . . . . . . .173 Matte menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159 Matte, fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Mechanical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259 Memory card slot, controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 permanent, frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 temporary, frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 1-1 sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95 Aux setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 background input setup . . . . . . . . . . . . .170 BG matte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174 change lockout code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 clone setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 comm setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 description, crop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 download code results . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188 DSK adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 genlock termination . . . . . . . . . . . . 118, 119 shared functions, background . . . . . . . .172 source adjustment, description . . . . . . . .167 tally diagnostic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Menu description aspect ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 backup/restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 border . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 color balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 console port setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 diagnostics setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 DSK adjustment, color . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179 DSK adjustment, luma . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178 DSK input setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180 EDID DVI input format menu . . . . . . . . .137 effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 Ethernet setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 frame grab name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 image effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 input configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 input source adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . .167 input source patch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156 key adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 key detect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 key source adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167 keypad backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138 Lantronix setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 LCD settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 lockout code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 matte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159 miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134 network setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 output patch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 oversample sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 PIP adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 rotary encoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 router specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 RS-232 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 shadow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 sizing menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95 software version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 TBar and Joystick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 test pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 user preference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140 wide screen settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 Menu functions frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 285 Index PIP adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 source adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 Menu tree background input setup . . . . . . . . . . . . .171 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177 frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155, 166 miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 PIP adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 source adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166 system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108 Mirror, clone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163 MISC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Miscellaneous menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134 menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133 Mix button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 mode, operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 mode, understanding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 mode, working with Keys . . . . . . . . . . . .232 mode, working with PIPs . . . . . . . . . . . .229 source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 source, button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 Mixer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 Mode aspect ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 border . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 crop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 feathering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 monochrome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 shadow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 tally . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 Modify layers on program . . . . . . . . . . .109, 234 Monitor layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217 Monochrome mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 Move button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240 pend on preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 pend on program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240 pending and triggering . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 program move on preview . . . . . . . . . . .238 program move on program . . . . . . . . . . .239 setup button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238 Move Rate key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 PIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 source adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 286 Multi-head graphics boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 k Name router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 saved frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 saved still frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249 Network DHCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 setup menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 New Name, frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Next preset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 None, DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 Notes move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240 presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245 router interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 Notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2 Number of inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 of outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 l Offset, clone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 Opacity DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179, 180 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157, 158 Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215 activate and deactivate destinations . . .222 background transitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227 change layer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 clear layers from program . . . . . . . . . . .234 clearing destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217 deleting presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222 general . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 Keys in mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 Keys in split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231 mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 modify PIPs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230 modifying keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233 pend move on preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 pend move on program . . . . . . . . . . . . .240 PIPs in mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229 PIPs in split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229 prerequisites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216 recalling presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 route aux and standard destinations . . .223 split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 storing presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Index understanding split and mix modes . . . .228 using clone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 using cut + fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 using freeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 using full screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 using join mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237 using move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238 using next and previous . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 using presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 using reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237 using swap z-order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 working with layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 working with transitions . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 safety summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 Option, tally . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 Orientation, hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31 OUTPUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Output connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 default router patch table . . . . . . . . . . . .194 format setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 monitor, all . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 monitor, BPII Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 monitor, preview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 monitor, SPII Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 monitor, test pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 patch menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 resolution specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .263 router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257 sub menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 Overlap images . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 Overlapped background format . . . . . . . . . . .107 Oversample . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95 sizing menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 Overview edge blending technology . . . . . . . . . . . .79 layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 ScreenPRO-II Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 software upgrade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270 still frame capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246 system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 m Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 Panel front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Parity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 Patch router inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 table, default router input . . . . . . . . . . . .198 table, default router output . . . . . . . . . . .194 PDF file usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 navigating and searching . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 Pending a move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 Permanent memory, frame grab . . . . . . . . . .143 Phase adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209 clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 setup, widescreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209 Physical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258 Picture-in-Picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 Pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 Ethernet connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 serial connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261 tally connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262 PIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 adjustment menu description . . . . . . . . .149 adjustment menu functions . . . . . . . . . .149 adjustment menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 adjustment sub menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 H Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 H Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 how to modify . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230 Move Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 switch sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 using with mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229 using with split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229 V Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 V Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 controller console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 controller ext comm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Ethernet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Power connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 up, system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187 PrePRO-II Aux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 Aux destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117, 195 destination setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196 ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 Prerequisites operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216 system setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184 PresentationPRO-II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120 Aux destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Preset buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 deleting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 287 Index learn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 next . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245 page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 previous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 recalling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 section, description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Presets resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 using next and previous . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Preview black . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 lookahead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48, 219 output monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 program move on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238 test pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 Previous preset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 Priority background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 PIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 Program clear layers from . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234 modify layers on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234 outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 program move on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 Programmable lockout code . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 Programming a move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238 EDID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190 Projector setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82, 202 total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 Pulldown compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 n Quadruple destination system . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 o Raster Box size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 test pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 understanding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220 Rate, transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 crop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 288 Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Recall presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Red color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157, 179 contrast and brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 LED, blinking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45 LED, solid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 mask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 180 matte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 174 threshold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157, 179 Remote control/DHCP, enable, disable . . . . .186 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 rotary encoders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237 Resolution specifications, input and output . .263 Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 Restore and backup utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254 from flash memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191 system configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 system, from flash memory . . . . . . . . . .254 Return material authorization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267 to factory default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189 RGB color space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 sources, color balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 Right Edge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 RMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267 Rotary encoder menu description . . . . . . . . . . . 114 knobs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 Router default input patch table . . . . . . . . . . . . .198 default output patch table . . . . . . . . . . . .194 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126 interface notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 manufacturer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121, 127 number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 number of inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 number of outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121, 132 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193 specification menu description . . . . . . . .127 type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 Routing external . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Index internal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 mode, internal or external . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 RS-232 setup menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 Rules, global . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86 p Safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 Sales contact information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268 Sample chart external routing, analog router I/O . . . . . .59 external routing, digital router I/O . . . . . . .59 internal routing, analog inputs . . . . . . . . .63 internal routing, digital inputs . . . . . . . . . .63 single screen, Aux destination . . . . . . . . .65 single screen, DVI connection . . . . . . . . .64 single screen, standard destination . . . . .64 widescreen, Aux destination . . . . . . . . . . .61 widescreen, DVI connection . . . . . . . . . . .60 widescreen, standard destination . . . . . . .60 Sample connection charts external routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 internal routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62 Sampling Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 Saturation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 SAVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Save captured frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213 still frame in permanent memory . . . . . .248 system configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213 Scaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 LOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 ScreenPRO-II genlock termination menu . . . . . . . 118, 119 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126 ScreenPRO-II Controller effect combinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27 features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 how to install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 SDI Router name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122 Section joystick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 layer control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 layer functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 preset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 touch screen menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Self, fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Sequence, system setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185 Serial connection via Lantronix EDS200 . . . . . .74 connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 connector pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261 software upgrade method . . . . . . . . . . . .272 Set user preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 Settings menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 Setup Aux destination . . . . . . . . . . . .120, 195, 196 Aux destination, overview . . . . . . . . . . . .195 background sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 backup to flash memory . . . . . . . . . . . . .213 downloading code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201 ID and remote enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186 ImagePRO destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196 input patching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198 inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212 move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 output format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199 PrePRO-II destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196 prerequisites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184 programming EDID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190 projector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82 projectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202 restore from flash memory card . . . . . . .191 return to factory default . . . . . . . . . . . . .189 router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193 save . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213 save system configuration . . . . . . . . . . .213 sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185 single screen projectors . . . . . . . . . . . . .202 standard destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192 sync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200 system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183 system power up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187 touch screen calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . .189 wide screen projectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203 widescreen color balance . . . . . . . . . . . .209 widescreen phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209 Shadow H Pos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 H Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 transparency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 V Pos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 V Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 Shared functions, background menu . . . . . . .172 Sharpness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 Shift button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45 Sierra . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 video systems router support . . . . . . . . .128 289 Index Single screen destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 destinations, frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 destinations, genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 sample Aux destination chart . . . . . . . . . .65 sample DVI connection chart . . . . . . . . . .64 sample standard destination chart . . . . . .64 Site preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 Size border . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 specified in, border . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 Sizing menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95 SMPTE color space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 Softkeys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38 Software downloading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271 requirements, upgrading . . . . . . . . . . . . .270 upgrade overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270 upgrade via Ethernet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274 version menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 version mismatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 SOG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 Source adjustment menu description . . . . . . . . .167 adjustment menu functions . . . . . . . . . .168 adjustment, H Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 adjustment, H size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 adjustment, menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166 adjustment, move rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 adjustment, V Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 adjustment, V size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43, 44 connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 fine adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169 genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169 route destinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 routing examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224 selection bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 selection bus, description . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 setup background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 switching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 SP input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 to add . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 to remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 to restore, backup/restore . . . . . . . . . . .141 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255 communications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259 electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256 input and output resolutions . . . . . . . . . .263 mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257 290 physical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258 pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 user control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257 widescreen functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258 SPII Program output monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 test pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 Split button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 mode, operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 mode, understanding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 mode, working with Keys . . . . . . . . . . . .231 mode, working with PIPs . . . . . . . . . . . .229 Standard destination blank chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192 STATUS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Status destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Still frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143, 176 background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246 capture from background input . . . . . . . .247 capture from layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 capture overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246 name a saved . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249 save in permanent memory . . . . . . . . . .248 Stop Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 Store presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Strobe effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 Style, border . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 Sub menus input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 PIP adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 Support, technical information . . . . . . . . . . . .268 S-Video, sources, color balance . . . . . . . . . . .99 Swap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 Z-order button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 Z-order, using . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 Switch sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18 Sync out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200 slice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 back up configuration to flash memory . .213 backup to flash memory . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 combinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide Index configuration, backup and restore . . . . .253 dual destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 dual destination plus widescreen . . . . . . .25 dual destination, dual Aux . . . . . . . . . . . .26 ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108 overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 power up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187 quadruple destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 restore from flash memory . . . . . . . . . . .254 setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183 setup prerequisites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184 setup sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185 q Table default router input patch . . . . . . . . . . . .198 default router output patch . . . . . . . . . . .194 Tally connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 connector pinouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262 connector, controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 diagnostic menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126 option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 optional board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 working with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 T-Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35, 51 & Joystick menu description . . . . . . . . . . 115 Technical support information . . . . . . . . . . . .268 Temporary memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Termination genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76, 103 status check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78 Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18, 19 equipment marking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 Test pattern alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106, 107 menu description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 Toggle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 Top edge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 left, button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 left, crop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 Total H Res, formula . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 projectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 V Res . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 Touch screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19, 38 calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76, 189, 217 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide menu section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 menu section, description . . . . . . . . . . . . .38 Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 Transition cut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 edge width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51, 242 mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 perform background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227 rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 section, description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 wipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146, 241 working with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 Transparency, shadow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 Triggering a move . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239 Troubleshoot Ethernet connection . . . . . . . . .275 Type background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 clone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156 LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182 test pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 r UDS100, UDS200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 Understanding file mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 raster boxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220 split and mix modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 Unlock controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252 Unpacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 Upgrade software via Ethernet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274 software via serial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272 Use of color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36 User control, specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257 preference menu description . . . . . . . . .140 preferences, set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221 Using backup and restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 cut + fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 DSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250 LOGO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251 291 Index PIPs in split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229 presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243 still frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246 tallies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 transitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 Utility, backup and restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254 s V active . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 pos, shadow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 position, key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 position, PIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 position, source adjustment . . . . . . . . . .168 size, crop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164 size, key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160 size, PIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 size, shadow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 size, source adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 Version BlendPRO-II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Video invalid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140 processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 processing, edge feathering . . . . . . . . . . .82 processing, image overlap . . . . . . . . . . . .81 processing, projector setup . . . . . . . . . . .82 u X-Axis Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 XLR Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 v Y-Axis Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 YPbPr sources, color balance . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 w Z-Axis Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 t Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267 Web site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271 Wide Screen Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Widescreen color balance setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209 destinations, frame grab . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 destinations, genlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 functions, specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .258 justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75, 119 lock, connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77 markers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218 phase setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209 sample Aux destination chart . . . . . . . . . .61 sample DVI connection chart . . . . . . . . . .60 sample standard destination chart . . . . . .60 settings menu description . . . . . . . . . . . .106 WIPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146 Wipe button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146, 241 Working with Keys in mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232 Keys in split mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231 PIPs in mix mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229 292 ScreenPRO-II Controller • User’s Guide